[gdb/testsuite] Fix DUPLICATEs in gdb.dwarf2/implptr-64bit.exp
[binutils-gdb.git] / ld / ld.texi
1 \input texinfo
2 @setfilename ld.info
3 @c Copyright (C) 1991-2021 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
4 @syncodeindex ky cp
5 @c man begin INCLUDE
6 @include configdoc.texi
7 @c (configdoc.texi is generated by the Makefile)
8 @include bfdver.texi
9 @c man end
10
11 @c @smallbook
12
13 @macro gcctabopt{body}
14 @code{\body\}
15 @end macro
16
17 @c man begin NAME
18 @ifset man
19 @c Configure for the generation of man pages
20 @set UsesEnvVars
21 @set GENERIC
22 @set ARM
23 @set C6X
24 @set CSKY
25 @set H8300
26 @set HPPA
27 @set M68HC11
28 @set M68K
29 @set MIPS
30 @set MMIX
31 @set MSP430
32 @set NDS32
33 @set NIOSII
34 @set PDP11
35 @set POWERPC
36 @set POWERPC64
37 @set Renesas
38 @set S/390
39 @set SPU
40 @set TICOFF
41 @set WIN32
42 @set XTENSA
43 @end ifset
44 @c man end
45
46 @ifnottex
47 @dircategory Software development
48 @direntry
49 * Ld: (ld). The GNU linker.
50 @end direntry
51 @end ifnottex
52
53 @copying
54 This file documents the @sc{gnu} linker LD
55 @ifset VERSION_PACKAGE
56 @value{VERSION_PACKAGE}
57 @end ifset
58 version @value{VERSION}.
59
60 Copyright @copyright{} 1991-2021 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
61
62 Permission is granted to copy, distribute and/or modify this document
63 under the terms of the GNU Free Documentation License, Version 1.3
64 or any later version published by the Free Software Foundation;
65 with no Invariant Sections, with no Front-Cover Texts, and with no
66 Back-Cover Texts. A copy of the license is included in the
67 section entitled ``GNU Free Documentation License''.
68 @end copying
69 @iftex
70 @finalout
71 @setchapternewpage odd
72 @settitle The GNU linker
73 @titlepage
74 @title The GNU linker
75 @sp 1
76 @subtitle @code{ld}
77 @ifset VERSION_PACKAGE
78 @subtitle @value{VERSION_PACKAGE}
79 @end ifset
80 @subtitle Version @value{VERSION}
81 @author Steve Chamberlain
82 @author Ian Lance Taylor
83 @page
84
85 @tex
86 {\parskip=0pt
87 \hfill Red Hat Inc\par
88 \hfill nickc\@credhat.com, doc\@redhat.com\par
89 \hfill {\it The GNU linker}\par
90 \hfill Edited by Jeffrey Osier (jeffrey\@cygnus.com)\par
91 }
92 \global\parindent=0pt % Steve likes it this way.
93 @end tex
94
95 @vskip 0pt plus 1filll
96 @c man begin COPYRIGHT
97 Copyright @copyright{} 1991-2021 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
98
99 Permission is granted to copy, distribute and/or modify this document
100 under the terms of the GNU Free Documentation License, Version 1.3
101 or any later version published by the Free Software Foundation;
102 with no Invariant Sections, with no Front-Cover Texts, and with no
103 Back-Cover Texts. A copy of the license is included in the
104 section entitled ``GNU Free Documentation License''.
105 @c man end
106
107 @end titlepage
108 @end iftex
109 @contents
110 @c FIXME: Talk about importance of *order* of args, cmds to linker!
111
112 @ifnottex
113 @node Top
114 @top LD
115 This file documents the @sc{gnu} linker ld
116 @ifset VERSION_PACKAGE
117 @value{VERSION_PACKAGE}
118 @end ifset
119 version @value{VERSION}.
120
121 This document is distributed under the terms of the GNU Free
122 Documentation License version 1.3. A copy of the license is included
123 in the section entitled ``GNU Free Documentation License''.
124
125 @menu
126 * Overview:: Overview
127 * Invocation:: Invocation
128 * Scripts:: Linker Scripts
129 * Plugins:: Linker Plugins
130 @ifset GENERIC
131 * Machine Dependent:: Machine Dependent Features
132 @end ifset
133 @ifclear GENERIC
134 @ifset H8300
135 * H8/300:: ld and the H8/300
136 @end ifset
137 @ifset Renesas
138 * Renesas:: ld and other Renesas micros
139 @end ifset
140 @ifset ARM
141 * ARM:: ld and the ARM family
142 @end ifset
143 @ifset M68HC11
144 * M68HC11/68HC12:: ld and the Motorola 68HC11 and 68HC12 families
145 @end ifset
146 @ifset HPPA
147 * HPPA ELF32:: ld and HPPA 32-bit ELF
148 @end ifset
149 @ifset M68K
150 * M68K:: ld and Motorola 68K family
151 @end ifset
152 @ifset MIPS
153 * MIPS:: ld and MIPS family
154 @end ifset
155 @ifset POWERPC
156 * PowerPC ELF32:: ld and PowerPC 32-bit ELF Support
157 @end ifset
158 @ifset POWERPC64
159 * PowerPC64 ELF64:: ld and PowerPC64 64-bit ELF Support
160 @end ifset
161 @ifset S/390
162 * S/390 ELF:: ld and S/390 ELF Support
163 @end ifset
164 @ifset SPU
165 * SPU ELF:: ld and SPU ELF Support
166 @end ifset
167 @ifset TICOFF
168 * TI COFF:: ld and the TI COFF
169 @end ifset
170 @ifset WIN32
171 * Win32:: ld and WIN32 (cygwin/mingw)
172 @end ifset
173 @ifset XTENSA
174 * Xtensa:: ld and Xtensa Processors
175 @end ifset
176 @end ifclear
177 @ifclear SingleFormat
178 * BFD:: BFD
179 @end ifclear
180 @c Following blank line required for remaining bug in makeinfo conds/menus
181
182 * Reporting Bugs:: Reporting Bugs
183 * MRI:: MRI Compatible Script Files
184 * GNU Free Documentation License:: GNU Free Documentation License
185 * LD Index:: LD Index
186 @end menu
187 @end ifnottex
188
189 @node Overview
190 @chapter Overview
191
192 @cindex @sc{gnu} linker
193 @cindex what is this?
194
195 @ifset man
196 @c man begin SYNOPSIS
197 ld [@b{options}] @var{objfile} @dots{}
198 @c man end
199
200 @c man begin SEEALSO
201 ar(1), nm(1), objcopy(1), objdump(1), readelf(1) and
202 the Info entries for @file{binutils} and
203 @file{ld}.
204 @c man end
205 @end ifset
206
207 @c man begin DESCRIPTION
208
209 @command{ld} combines a number of object and archive files, relocates
210 their data and ties up symbol references. Usually the last step in
211 compiling a program is to run @command{ld}.
212
213 @command{ld} accepts Linker Command Language files written in
214 a superset of AT&T's Link Editor Command Language syntax,
215 to provide explicit and total control over the linking process.
216
217 @ifset man
218 @c For the man only
219 This man page does not describe the command language; see the
220 @command{ld} entry in @code{info} for full details on the command
221 language and on other aspects of the GNU linker.
222 @end ifset
223
224 @ifclear SingleFormat
225 This version of @command{ld} uses the general purpose BFD libraries
226 to operate on object files. This allows @command{ld} to read, combine, and
227 write object files in many different formats---for example, COFF or
228 @code{a.out}. Different formats may be linked together to produce any
229 available kind of object file. @xref{BFD}, for more information.
230 @end ifclear
231
232 Aside from its flexibility, the @sc{gnu} linker is more helpful than other
233 linkers in providing diagnostic information. Many linkers abandon
234 execution immediately upon encountering an error; whenever possible,
235 @command{ld} continues executing, allowing you to identify other errors
236 (or, in some cases, to get an output file in spite of the error).
237
238 @c man end
239
240 @node Invocation
241 @chapter Invocation
242
243 @c man begin DESCRIPTION
244
245 The @sc{gnu} linker @command{ld} is meant to cover a broad range of situations,
246 and to be as compatible as possible with other linkers. As a result,
247 you have many choices to control its behavior.
248
249 @c man end
250
251 @ifset UsesEnvVars
252 @menu
253 * Options:: Command-line Options
254 * Environment:: Environment Variables
255 @end menu
256
257 @node Options
258 @section Command-line Options
259 @end ifset
260
261 @cindex command line
262 @cindex options
263
264 @c man begin OPTIONS
265
266 The linker supports a plethora of command-line options, but in actual
267 practice few of them are used in any particular context.
268 @cindex standard Unix system
269 For instance, a frequent use of @command{ld} is to link standard Unix
270 object files on a standard, supported Unix system. On such a system, to
271 link a file @code{hello.o}:
272
273 @smallexample
274 ld -o @var{output} /lib/crt0.o hello.o -lc
275 @end smallexample
276
277 This tells @command{ld} to produce a file called @var{output} as the
278 result of linking the file @code{/lib/crt0.o} with @code{hello.o} and
279 the library @code{libc.a}, which will come from the standard search
280 directories. (See the discussion of the @samp{-l} option below.)
281
282 Some of the command-line options to @command{ld} may be specified at any
283 point in the command line. However, options which refer to files, such
284 as @samp{-l} or @samp{-T}, cause the file to be read at the point at
285 which the option appears in the command line, relative to the object
286 files and other file options. Repeating non-file options with a
287 different argument will either have no further effect, or override prior
288 occurrences (those further to the left on the command line) of that
289 option. Options which may be meaningfully specified more than once are
290 noted in the descriptions below.
291
292 @cindex object files
293 Non-option arguments are object files or archives which are to be linked
294 together. They may follow, precede, or be mixed in with command-line
295 options, except that an object file argument may not be placed between
296 an option and its argument.
297
298 Usually the linker is invoked with at least one object file, but you can
299 specify other forms of binary input files using @samp{-l}, @samp{-R},
300 and the script command language. If @emph{no} binary input files at all
301 are specified, the linker does not produce any output, and issues the
302 message @samp{No input files}.
303
304 If the linker cannot recognize the format of an object file, it will
305 assume that it is a linker script. A script specified in this way
306 augments the main linker script used for the link (either the default
307 linker script or the one specified by using @samp{-T}). This feature
308 permits the linker to link against a file which appears to be an object
309 or an archive, but actually merely defines some symbol values, or uses
310 @code{INPUT} or @code{GROUP} to load other objects. Specifying a
311 script in this way merely augments the main linker script, with the
312 extra commands placed after the main script; use the @samp{-T} option
313 to replace the default linker script entirely, but note the effect of
314 the @code{INSERT} command. @xref{Scripts}.
315
316 For options whose names are a single letter,
317 option arguments must either follow the option letter without intervening
318 whitespace, or be given as separate arguments immediately following the
319 option that requires them.
320
321 For options whose names are multiple letters, either one dash or two can
322 precede the option name; for example, @samp{-trace-symbol} and
323 @samp{--trace-symbol} are equivalent. Note---there is one exception to
324 this rule. Multiple letter options that start with a lower case 'o' can
325 only be preceded by two dashes. This is to reduce confusion with the
326 @samp{-o} option. So for example @samp{-omagic} sets the output file
327 name to @samp{magic} whereas @samp{--omagic} sets the NMAGIC flag on the
328 output.
329
330 Arguments to multiple-letter options must either be separated from the
331 option name by an equals sign, or be given as separate arguments
332 immediately following the option that requires them. For example,
333 @samp{--trace-symbol foo} and @samp{--trace-symbol=foo} are equivalent.
334 Unique abbreviations of the names of multiple-letter options are
335 accepted.
336
337 Note---if the linker is being invoked indirectly, via a compiler driver
338 (e.g. @samp{gcc}) then all the linker command-line options should be
339 prefixed by @samp{-Wl,} (or whatever is appropriate for the particular
340 compiler driver) like this:
341
342 @smallexample
343 gcc -Wl,--start-group foo.o bar.o -Wl,--end-group
344 @end smallexample
345
346 This is important, because otherwise the compiler driver program may
347 silently drop the linker options, resulting in a bad link. Confusion
348 may also arise when passing options that require values through a
349 driver, as the use of a space between option and argument acts as
350 a separator, and causes the driver to pass only the option to the linker
351 and the argument to the compiler. In this case, it is simplest to use
352 the joined forms of both single- and multiple-letter options, such as:
353
354 @smallexample
355 gcc foo.o bar.o -Wl,-eENTRY -Wl,-Map=a.map
356 @end smallexample
357
358 Here is a table of the generic command-line switches accepted by the GNU
359 linker:
360
361 @table @gcctabopt
362 @include at-file.texi
363
364 @kindex -a @var{keyword}
365 @item -a @var{keyword}
366 This option is supported for HP/UX compatibility. The @var{keyword}
367 argument must be one of the strings @samp{archive}, @samp{shared}, or
368 @samp{default}. @samp{-aarchive} is functionally equivalent to
369 @samp{-Bstatic}, and the other two keywords are functionally equivalent
370 to @samp{-Bdynamic}. This option may be used any number of times.
371
372 @kindex --audit @var{AUDITLIB}
373 @item --audit @var{AUDITLIB}
374 Adds @var{AUDITLIB} to the @code{DT_AUDIT} entry of the dynamic section.
375 @var{AUDITLIB} is not checked for existence, nor will it use the DT_SONAME
376 specified in the library. If specified multiple times @code{DT_AUDIT}
377 will contain a colon separated list of audit interfaces to use. If the linker
378 finds an object with an audit entry while searching for shared libraries,
379 it will add a corresponding @code{DT_DEPAUDIT} entry in the output file.
380 This option is only meaningful on ELF platforms supporting the rtld-audit
381 interface.
382
383 @ifclear SingleFormat
384 @cindex binary input format
385 @kindex -b @var{format}
386 @kindex --format=@var{format}
387 @cindex input format
388 @cindex input format
389 @item -b @var{input-format}
390 @itemx --format=@var{input-format}
391 @command{ld} may be configured to support more than one kind of object
392 file. If your @command{ld} is configured this way, you can use the
393 @samp{-b} option to specify the binary format for input object files
394 that follow this option on the command line. Even when @command{ld} is
395 configured to support alternative object formats, you don't usually need
396 to specify this, as @command{ld} should be configured to expect as a
397 default input format the most usual format on each machine.
398 @var{input-format} is a text string, the name of a particular format
399 supported by the BFD libraries. (You can list the available binary
400 formats with @samp{objdump -i}.)
401 @xref{BFD}.
402
403 You may want to use this option if you are linking files with an unusual
404 binary format. You can also use @samp{-b} to switch formats explicitly (when
405 linking object files of different formats), by including
406 @samp{-b @var{input-format}} before each group of object files in a
407 particular format.
408
409 The default format is taken from the environment variable
410 @code{GNUTARGET}.
411 @ifset UsesEnvVars
412 @xref{Environment}.
413 @end ifset
414 You can also define the input format from a script, using the command
415 @code{TARGET};
416 @ifclear man
417 see @ref{Format Commands}.
418 @end ifclear
419 @end ifclear
420
421 @kindex -c @var{MRI-cmdfile}
422 @kindex --mri-script=@var{MRI-cmdfile}
423 @cindex compatibility, MRI
424 @item -c @var{MRI-commandfile}
425 @itemx --mri-script=@var{MRI-commandfile}
426 For compatibility with linkers produced by MRI, @command{ld} accepts script
427 files written in an alternate, restricted command language, described in
428 @ifclear man
429 @ref{MRI,,MRI Compatible Script Files}.
430 @end ifclear
431 @ifset man
432 the MRI Compatible Script Files section of GNU ld documentation.
433 @end ifset
434 Introduce MRI script files with
435 the option @samp{-c}; use the @samp{-T} option to run linker
436 scripts written in the general-purpose @command{ld} scripting language.
437 If @var{MRI-cmdfile} does not exist, @command{ld} looks for it in the directories
438 specified by any @samp{-L} options.
439
440 @cindex common allocation
441 @kindex -d
442 @kindex -dc
443 @kindex -dp
444 @item -d
445 @itemx -dc
446 @itemx -dp
447 These three options are equivalent; multiple forms are supported for
448 compatibility with other linkers. They assign space to common symbols
449 even if a relocatable output file is specified (with @samp{-r}). The
450 script command @code{FORCE_COMMON_ALLOCATION} has the same effect.
451 @xref{Miscellaneous Commands}.
452
453 @kindex --depaudit @var{AUDITLIB}
454 @kindex -P @var{AUDITLIB}
455 @item --depaudit @var{AUDITLIB}
456 @itemx -P @var{AUDITLIB}
457 Adds @var{AUDITLIB} to the @code{DT_DEPAUDIT} entry of the dynamic section.
458 @var{AUDITLIB} is not checked for existence, nor will it use the DT_SONAME
459 specified in the library. If specified multiple times @code{DT_DEPAUDIT}
460 will contain a colon separated list of audit interfaces to use. This
461 option is only meaningful on ELF platforms supporting the rtld-audit interface.
462 The -P option is provided for Solaris compatibility.
463
464 @kindex --enable-non-contiguous-regions
465 @item --enable-non-contiguous-regions
466 This option avoids generating an error if an input section does not
467 fit a matching output section. The linker tries to allocate the input
468 section to subseque nt matching output sections, and generates an
469 error only if no output section is large enough. This is useful when
470 several non-contiguous memory regions are available and the input
471 section does not require a particular one. The order in which input
472 sections are evaluated does not change, for instance:
473
474 @smallexample
475 MEMORY @{
476 MEM1 (rwx) : ORIGIN : 0x1000, LENGTH = 0x14
477 MEM2 (rwx) : ORIGIN : 0x1000, LENGTH = 0x40
478 MEM3 (rwx) : ORIGIN : 0x2000, LENGTH = 0x40
479 @}
480 SECTIONS @{
481 mem1 : @{ *(.data.*); @} > MEM1
482 mem2 : @{ *(.data.*); @} > MEM2
483 mem3 : @{ *(.data.*); @} > MEM2
484 @}
485
486 with input sections:
487 .data.1: size 8
488 .data.2: size 0x10
489 .data.3: size 4
490
491 results in .data.1 affected to mem1, and .data.2 and .data.3
492 affected to mem2, even though .data.3 would fit in mem3.
493 @end smallexample
494
495 This option is incompatible with INSERT statements because it changes
496 the way input sections are mapped to output sections.
497
498 @kindex --enable-non-contiguous-regions-warnings
499 @item --enable-non-contiguous-regions-warnings
500 This option enables warnings when
501 @code{--enable-non-contiguous-regions} allows possibly unexpected
502 matches in sections mapping, potentially leading to silently
503 discarding a section instead of failing because it does not fit any
504 output region.
505
506 @cindex entry point, from command line
507 @kindex -e @var{entry}
508 @kindex --entry=@var{entry}
509 @item -e @var{entry}
510 @itemx --entry=@var{entry}
511 Use @var{entry} as the explicit symbol for beginning execution of your
512 program, rather than the default entry point. If there is no symbol
513 named @var{entry}, the linker will try to parse @var{entry} as a number,
514 and use that as the entry address (the number will be interpreted in
515 base 10; you may use a leading @samp{0x} for base 16, or a leading
516 @samp{0} for base 8). @xref{Entry Point}, for a discussion of defaults
517 and other ways of specifying the entry point.
518
519 @kindex --exclude-libs
520 @item --exclude-libs @var{lib},@var{lib},...
521 Specifies a list of archive libraries from which symbols should not be automatically
522 exported. The library names may be delimited by commas or colons. Specifying
523 @code{--exclude-libs ALL} excludes symbols in all archive libraries from
524 automatic export. This option is available only for the i386 PE targeted
525 port of the linker and for ELF targeted ports. For i386 PE, symbols
526 explicitly listed in a .def file are still exported, regardless of this
527 option. For ELF targeted ports, symbols affected by this option will
528 be treated as hidden.
529
530 @kindex --exclude-modules-for-implib
531 @item --exclude-modules-for-implib @var{module},@var{module},...
532 Specifies a list of object files or archive members, from which symbols
533 should not be automatically exported, but which should be copied wholesale
534 into the import library being generated during the link. The module names
535 may be delimited by commas or colons, and must match exactly the filenames
536 used by @command{ld} to open the files; for archive members, this is simply
537 the member name, but for object files the name listed must include and
538 match precisely any path used to specify the input file on the linker's
539 command-line. This option is available only for the i386 PE targeted port
540 of the linker. Symbols explicitly listed in a .def file are still exported,
541 regardless of this option.
542
543 @cindex dynamic symbol table
544 @kindex -E
545 @kindex --export-dynamic
546 @kindex --no-export-dynamic
547 @item -E
548 @itemx --export-dynamic
549 @itemx --no-export-dynamic
550 When creating a dynamically linked executable, using the @option{-E}
551 option or the @option{--export-dynamic} option causes the linker to add
552 all symbols to the dynamic symbol table. The dynamic symbol table is the
553 set of symbols which are visible from dynamic objects at run time.
554
555 If you do not use either of these options (or use the
556 @option{--no-export-dynamic} option to restore the default behavior), the
557 dynamic symbol table will normally contain only those symbols which are
558 referenced by some dynamic object mentioned in the link.
559
560 If you use @code{dlopen} to load a dynamic object which needs to refer
561 back to the symbols defined by the program, rather than some other
562 dynamic object, then you will probably need to use this option when
563 linking the program itself.
564
565 You can also use the dynamic list to control what symbols should
566 be added to the dynamic symbol table if the output format supports it.
567 See the description of @samp{--dynamic-list}.
568
569 Note that this option is specific to ELF targeted ports. PE targets
570 support a similar function to export all symbols from a DLL or EXE; see
571 the description of @samp{--export-all-symbols} below.
572
573 @kindex --export-dynamic-symbol=@var{glob}
574 @cindex export dynamic symbol
575 @item --export-dynamic-symbol=@var{glob}
576 When creating a dynamically linked executable, symbols matching
577 @var{glob} will be added to the dynamic symbol table. When creating a
578 shared library, references to symbols matching @var{glob} will not be
579 bound to the definitions within the shared library. This option is a
580 no-op when creating a shared library and @samp{-Bsymbolic} or
581 @samp{--dynamic-list} are not specified. This option is only meaningful
582 on ELF platforms which support shared libraries.
583
584 @kindex --export-dynamic-symbol-list=@var{file}
585 @cindex export dynamic symbol list
586 @item --export-dynamic-symbol-list=@var{file}
587 Specify a @samp{--export-dynamic-symbol} for each pattern in the file.
588 The format of the file is the same as the version node without
589 scope and node name. See @ref{VERSION} for more information.
590
591 @ifclear SingleFormat
592 @cindex big-endian objects
593 @cindex endianness
594 @kindex -EB
595 @item -EB
596 Link big-endian objects. This affects the default output format.
597
598 @cindex little-endian objects
599 @kindex -EL
600 @item -EL
601 Link little-endian objects. This affects the default output format.
602 @end ifclear
603
604 @kindex -f @var{name}
605 @kindex --auxiliary=@var{name}
606 @item -f @var{name}
607 @itemx --auxiliary=@var{name}
608 When creating an ELF shared object, set the internal DT_AUXILIARY field
609 to the specified name. This tells the dynamic linker that the symbol
610 table of the shared object should be used as an auxiliary filter on the
611 symbol table of the shared object @var{name}.
612
613 If you later link a program against this filter object, then, when you
614 run the program, the dynamic linker will see the DT_AUXILIARY field. If
615 the dynamic linker resolves any symbols from the filter object, it will
616 first check whether there is a definition in the shared object
617 @var{name}. If there is one, it will be used instead of the definition
618 in the filter object. The shared object @var{name} need not exist.
619 Thus the shared object @var{name} may be used to provide an alternative
620 implementation of certain functions, perhaps for debugging or for
621 machine-specific performance.
622
623 This option may be specified more than once. The DT_AUXILIARY entries
624 will be created in the order in which they appear on the command line.
625
626 @kindex -F @var{name}
627 @kindex --filter=@var{name}
628 @item -F @var{name}
629 @itemx --filter=@var{name}
630 When creating an ELF shared object, set the internal DT_FILTER field to
631 the specified name. This tells the dynamic linker that the symbol table
632 of the shared object which is being created should be used as a filter
633 on the symbol table of the shared object @var{name}.
634
635 If you later link a program against this filter object, then, when you
636 run the program, the dynamic linker will see the DT_FILTER field. The
637 dynamic linker will resolve symbols according to the symbol table of the
638 filter object as usual, but it will actually link to the definitions
639 found in the shared object @var{name}. Thus the filter object can be
640 used to select a subset of the symbols provided by the object
641 @var{name}.
642
643 Some older linkers used the @option{-F} option throughout a compilation
644 toolchain for specifying object-file format for both input and output
645 object files.
646 @ifclear SingleFormat
647 The @sc{gnu} linker uses other mechanisms for this purpose: the
648 @option{-b}, @option{--format}, @option{--oformat} options, the
649 @code{TARGET} command in linker scripts, and the @code{GNUTARGET}
650 environment variable.
651 @end ifclear
652 The @sc{gnu} linker will ignore the @option{-F} option when not
653 creating an ELF shared object.
654
655 @cindex finalization function
656 @kindex -fini=@var{name}
657 @item -fini=@var{name}
658 When creating an ELF executable or shared object, call NAME when the
659 executable or shared object is unloaded, by setting DT_FINI to the
660 address of the function. By default, the linker uses @code{_fini} as
661 the function to call.
662
663 @kindex -g
664 @item -g
665 Ignored. Provided for compatibility with other tools.
666
667 @kindex -G @var{value}
668 @kindex --gpsize=@var{value}
669 @cindex object size
670 @item -G @var{value}
671 @itemx --gpsize=@var{value}
672 Set the maximum size of objects to be optimized using the GP register to
673 @var{size}. This is only meaningful for object file formats such as
674 MIPS ELF that support putting large and small objects into different
675 sections. This is ignored for other object file formats.
676
677 @cindex runtime library name
678 @kindex -h @var{name}
679 @kindex -soname=@var{name}
680 @item -h @var{name}
681 @itemx -soname=@var{name}
682 When creating an ELF shared object, set the internal DT_SONAME field to
683 the specified name. When an executable is linked with a shared object
684 which has a DT_SONAME field, then when the executable is run the dynamic
685 linker will attempt to load the shared object specified by the DT_SONAME
686 field rather than using the file name given to the linker.
687
688 @kindex -i
689 @cindex incremental link
690 @item -i
691 Perform an incremental link (same as option @samp{-r}).
692
693 @cindex initialization function
694 @kindex -init=@var{name}
695 @item -init=@var{name}
696 When creating an ELF executable or shared object, call NAME when the
697 executable or shared object is loaded, by setting DT_INIT to the address
698 of the function. By default, the linker uses @code{_init} as the
699 function to call.
700
701 @cindex archive files, from cmd line
702 @kindex -l @var{namespec}
703 @kindex --library=@var{namespec}
704 @item -l @var{namespec}
705 @itemx --library=@var{namespec}
706 Add the archive or object file specified by @var{namespec} to the
707 list of files to link. This option may be used any number of times.
708 If @var{namespec} is of the form @file{:@var{filename}}, @command{ld}
709 will search the library path for a file called @var{filename}, otherwise it
710 will search the library path for a file called @file{lib@var{namespec}.a}.
711
712 On systems which support shared libraries, @command{ld} may also search for
713 files other than @file{lib@var{namespec}.a}. Specifically, on ELF
714 and SunOS systems, @command{ld} will search a directory for a library
715 called @file{lib@var{namespec}.so} before searching for one called
716 @file{lib@var{namespec}.a}. (By convention, a @code{.so} extension
717 indicates a shared library.) Note that this behavior does not apply
718 to @file{:@var{filename}}, which always specifies a file called
719 @var{filename}.
720
721 The linker will search an archive only once, at the location where it is
722 specified on the command line. If the archive defines a symbol which
723 was undefined in some object which appeared before the archive on the
724 command line, the linker will include the appropriate file(s) from the
725 archive. However, an undefined symbol in an object appearing later on
726 the command line will not cause the linker to search the archive again.
727
728 See the @option{-(} option for a way to force the linker to search
729 archives multiple times.
730
731 You may list the same archive multiple times on the command line.
732
733 @ifset GENERIC
734 This type of archive searching is standard for Unix linkers. However,
735 if you are using @command{ld} on AIX, note that it is different from the
736 behaviour of the AIX linker.
737 @end ifset
738
739 @cindex search directory, from cmd line
740 @kindex -L @var{dir}
741 @kindex --library-path=@var{dir}
742 @item -L @var{searchdir}
743 @itemx --library-path=@var{searchdir}
744 Add path @var{searchdir} to the list of paths that @command{ld} will search
745 for archive libraries and @command{ld} control scripts. You may use this
746 option any number of times. The directories are searched in the order
747 in which they are specified on the command line. Directories specified
748 on the command line are searched before the default directories. All
749 @option{-L} options apply to all @option{-l} options, regardless of the
750 order in which the options appear. @option{-L} options do not affect
751 how @command{ld} searches for a linker script unless @option{-T}
752 option is specified.
753
754 If @var{searchdir} begins with @code{=} or @code{$SYSROOT}, then this
755 prefix will be replaced by the @dfn{sysroot prefix}, controlled by the
756 @samp{--sysroot} option, or specified when the linker is configured.
757
758 @ifset UsesEnvVars
759 The default set of paths searched (without being specified with
760 @samp{-L}) depends on which emulation mode @command{ld} is using, and in
761 some cases also on how it was configured. @xref{Environment}.
762 @end ifset
763
764 The paths can also be specified in a link script with the
765 @code{SEARCH_DIR} command. Directories specified this way are searched
766 at the point in which the linker script appears in the command line.
767
768 @cindex emulation
769 @kindex -m @var{emulation}
770 @item -m @var{emulation}
771 Emulate the @var{emulation} linker. You can list the available
772 emulations with the @samp{--verbose} or @samp{-V} options.
773
774 If the @samp{-m} option is not used, the emulation is taken from the
775 @code{LDEMULATION} environment variable, if that is defined.
776
777 Otherwise, the default emulation depends upon how the linker was
778 configured.
779
780 @cindex link map
781 @kindex -M
782 @kindex --print-map
783 @item -M
784 @itemx --print-map
785 Print a link map to the standard output. A link map provides
786 information about the link, including the following:
787
788 @itemize @bullet
789 @item
790 Where object files are mapped into memory.
791 @item
792 How common symbols are allocated.
793 @item
794 All archive members included in the link, with a mention of the symbol
795 which caused the archive member to be brought in.
796 @item
797 The values assigned to symbols.
798
799 Note - symbols whose values are computed by an expression which
800 involves a reference to a previous value of the same symbol may not
801 have correct result displayed in the link map. This is because the
802 linker discards intermediate results and only retains the final value
803 of an expression. Under such circumstances the linker will display
804 the final value enclosed by square brackets. Thus for example a
805 linker script containing:
806
807 @smallexample
808 foo = 1
809 foo = foo * 4
810 foo = foo + 8
811 @end smallexample
812
813 will produce the following output in the link map if the @option{-M}
814 option is used:
815
816 @smallexample
817 0x00000001 foo = 0x1
818 [0x0000000c] foo = (foo * 0x4)
819 [0x0000000c] foo = (foo + 0x8)
820 @end smallexample
821
822 See @ref{Expressions} for more information about expressions in linker
823 scripts.
824
825 @item
826 How GNU properties are merged.
827
828 When the linker merges input .note.gnu.property sections into one output
829 .note.gnu.property section, some properties are removed or updated.
830 These actions are reported in the link map. For example:
831
832 @smallexample
833 Removed property 0xc0000002 to merge foo.o (0x1) and bar.o (not found)
834 @end smallexample
835
836 This indicates that property 0xc0000002 is removed from output when
837 merging properties in @file{foo.o}, whose property 0xc0000002 value
838 is 0x1, and @file{bar.o}, which doesn't have property 0xc0000002.
839
840 @smallexample
841 Updated property 0xc0010001 (0x1) to merge foo.o (0x1) and bar.o (0x1)
842 @end smallexample
843
844 This indicates that property 0xc0010001 value is updated to 0x1 in output
845 when merging properties in @file{foo.o}, whose 0xc0010001 property value
846 is 0x1, and @file{bar.o}, whose 0xc0010001 property value is 0x1.
847 @end itemize
848
849 @cindex link map discarded
850 @kindex --print-map-discarded
851 @kindex --no-print-map-discarded
852 @item --print-map-discarded
853 @itemx --no-print-map-discarded
854 Print (or do not print) the list of discarded and garbage collected sections
855 in the link map. Enabled by default.
856
857 @kindex -n
858 @cindex read-only text
859 @cindex NMAGIC
860 @kindex --nmagic
861 @item -n
862 @itemx --nmagic
863 Turn off page alignment of sections, and disable linking against shared
864 libraries. If the output format supports Unix style magic numbers,
865 mark the output as @code{NMAGIC}.
866
867 @kindex -N
868 @kindex --omagic
869 @cindex read/write from cmd line
870 @cindex OMAGIC
871 @item -N
872 @itemx --omagic
873 Set the text and data sections to be readable and writable. Also, do
874 not page-align the data segment, and disable linking against shared
875 libraries. If the output format supports Unix style magic numbers,
876 mark the output as @code{OMAGIC}. Note: Although a writable text section
877 is allowed for PE-COFF targets, it does not conform to the format
878 specification published by Microsoft.
879
880 @kindex --no-omagic
881 @cindex OMAGIC
882 @item --no-omagic
883 This option negates most of the effects of the @option{-N} option. It
884 sets the text section to be read-only, and forces the data segment to
885 be page-aligned. Note - this option does not enable linking against
886 shared libraries. Use @option{-Bdynamic} for this.
887
888 @kindex -o @var{output}
889 @kindex --output=@var{output}
890 @cindex naming the output file
891 @item -o @var{output}
892 @itemx --output=@var{output}
893 Use @var{output} as the name for the program produced by @command{ld}; if this
894 option is not specified, the name @file{a.out} is used by default. The
895 script command @code{OUTPUT} can also specify the output file name.
896
897 @kindex --dependency-file=@var{depfile}
898 @cindex dependency file
899 @item --dependency-file=@var{depfile}
900 Write a @dfn{dependency file} to @var{depfile}. This file contains a rule
901 suitable for @code{make} describing the output file and all the input files
902 that were read to produce it. The output is similar to the compiler's
903 output with @samp{-M -MP} (@pxref{Preprocessor Options,, Options
904 Controlling the Preprocessor, gcc.info, Using the GNU Compiler
905 Collection}). Note that there is no option like the compiler's @samp{-MM},
906 to exclude ``system files'' (which is not a well-specified concept in the
907 linker, unlike ``system headers'' in the compiler). So the output from
908 @samp{--dependency-file} is always specific to the exact state of the
909 installation where it was produced, and should not be copied into
910 distributed makefiles without careful editing.
911
912 @kindex -O @var{level}
913 @cindex generating optimized output
914 @item -O @var{level}
915 If @var{level} is a numeric values greater than zero @command{ld} optimizes
916 the output. This might take significantly longer and therefore probably
917 should only be enabled for the final binary. At the moment this
918 option only affects ELF shared library generation. Future releases of
919 the linker may make more use of this option. Also currently there is
920 no difference in the linker's behaviour for different non-zero values
921 of this option. Again this may change with future releases.
922
923 @kindex -plugin @var{name}
924 @item -plugin @var{name}
925 Involve a plugin in the linking process. The @var{name} parameter is
926 the absolute filename of the plugin. Usually this parameter is
927 automatically added by the complier, when using link time
928 optimization, but users can also add their own plugins if they so
929 wish.
930
931 Note that the location of the compiler originated plugins is different
932 from the place where the @command{ar}, @command{nm} and
933 @command{ranlib} programs search for their plugins. In order for
934 those commands to make use of a compiler based plugin it must first be
935 copied into the @file{$@{libdir@}/bfd-plugins} directory. All gcc
936 based linker plugins are backward compatible, so it is sufficient to
937 just copy in the newest one.
938
939 @kindex --push-state
940 @cindex push state governing input file handling
941 @item --push-state
942 The @option{--push-state} allows one to preserve the current state of the
943 flags which govern the input file handling so that they can all be
944 restored with one corresponding @option{--pop-state} option.
945
946 The option which are covered are: @option{-Bdynamic}, @option{-Bstatic},
947 @option{-dn}, @option{-dy}, @option{-call_shared}, @option{-non_shared},
948 @option{-static}, @option{-N}, @option{-n}, @option{--whole-archive},
949 @option{--no-whole-archive}, @option{-r}, @option{-Ur},
950 @option{--copy-dt-needed-entries}, @option{--no-copy-dt-needed-entries},
951 @option{--as-needed}, @option{--no-as-needed}, and @option{-a}.
952
953 One target for this option are specifications for @file{pkg-config}. When
954 used with the @option{--libs} option all possibly needed libraries are
955 listed and then possibly linked with all the time. It is better to return
956 something as follows:
957
958 @smallexample
959 -Wl,--push-state,--as-needed -libone -libtwo -Wl,--pop-state
960 @end smallexample
961
962 @kindex --pop-state
963 @cindex pop state governing input file handling
964 @item --pop-state
965 Undoes the effect of --push-state, restores the previous values of the
966 flags governing input file handling.
967
968 @kindex -q
969 @kindex --emit-relocs
970 @cindex retain relocations in final executable
971 @item -q
972 @itemx --emit-relocs
973 Leave relocation sections and contents in fully linked executables.
974 Post link analysis and optimization tools may need this information in
975 order to perform correct modifications of executables. This results
976 in larger executables.
977
978 This option is currently only supported on ELF platforms.
979
980 @kindex --force-dynamic
981 @cindex forcing the creation of dynamic sections
982 @item --force-dynamic
983 Force the output file to have dynamic sections. This option is specific
984 to VxWorks targets.
985
986 @cindex partial link
987 @cindex relocatable output
988 @kindex -r
989 @kindex --relocatable
990 @item -r
991 @itemx --relocatable
992 Generate relocatable output---i.e., generate an output file that can in
993 turn serve as input to @command{ld}. This is often called @dfn{partial
994 linking}. As a side effect, in environments that support standard Unix
995 magic numbers, this option also sets the output file's magic number to
996 @code{OMAGIC}.
997 @c ; see @option{-N}.
998 If this option is not specified, an absolute file is produced. When
999 linking C++ programs, this option @emph{will not} resolve references to
1000 constructors; to do that, use @samp{-Ur}.
1001
1002 When an input file does not have the same format as the output file,
1003 partial linking is only supported if that input file does not contain any
1004 relocations. Different output formats can have further restrictions; for
1005 example some @code{a.out}-based formats do not support partial linking
1006 with input files in other formats at all.
1007
1008 This option does the same thing as @samp{-i}.
1009
1010 @kindex -R @var{file}
1011 @kindex --just-symbols=@var{file}
1012 @cindex symbol-only input
1013 @item -R @var{filename}
1014 @itemx --just-symbols=@var{filename}
1015 Read symbol names and their addresses from @var{filename}, but do not
1016 relocate it or include it in the output. This allows your output file
1017 to refer symbolically to absolute locations of memory defined in other
1018 programs. You may use this option more than once.
1019
1020 For compatibility with other ELF linkers, if the @option{-R} option is
1021 followed by a directory name, rather than a file name, it is treated as
1022 the @option{-rpath} option.
1023
1024 @kindex -s
1025 @kindex --strip-all
1026 @cindex strip all symbols
1027 @item -s
1028 @itemx --strip-all
1029 Omit all symbol information from the output file.
1030
1031 @kindex -S
1032 @kindex --strip-debug
1033 @cindex strip debugger symbols
1034 @item -S
1035 @itemx --strip-debug
1036 Omit debugger symbol information (but not all symbols) from the output file.
1037
1038 @kindex --strip-discarded
1039 @kindex --no-strip-discarded
1040 @item --strip-discarded
1041 @itemx --no-strip-discarded
1042 Omit (or do not omit) global symbols defined in discarded sections.
1043 Enabled by default.
1044
1045 @kindex -t
1046 @kindex --trace
1047 @cindex input files, displaying
1048 @item -t
1049 @itemx --trace
1050 Print the names of the input files as @command{ld} processes them. If
1051 @samp{-t} is given twice then members within archives are also printed.
1052 @samp{-t} output is useful to generate a list of all the object files
1053 and scripts involved in linking, for example, when packaging files for
1054 a linker bug report.
1055
1056 @kindex -T @var{script}
1057 @kindex --script=@var{script}
1058 @cindex script files
1059 @item -T @var{scriptfile}
1060 @itemx --script=@var{scriptfile}
1061 Use @var{scriptfile} as the linker script. This script replaces
1062 @command{ld}'s default linker script (rather than adding to it), so
1063 @var{commandfile} must specify everything necessary to describe the
1064 output file. @xref{Scripts}. If @var{scriptfile} does not exist in
1065 the current directory, @code{ld} looks for it in the directories
1066 specified by any preceding @samp{-L} options. Multiple @samp{-T}
1067 options accumulate.
1068
1069 @kindex -dT @var{script}
1070 @kindex --default-script=@var{script}
1071 @cindex script files
1072 @item -dT @var{scriptfile}
1073 @itemx --default-script=@var{scriptfile}
1074 Use @var{scriptfile} as the default linker script. @xref{Scripts}.
1075
1076 This option is similar to the @option{--script} option except that
1077 processing of the script is delayed until after the rest of the
1078 command line has been processed. This allows options placed after the
1079 @option{--default-script} option on the command line to affect the
1080 behaviour of the linker script, which can be important when the linker
1081 command line cannot be directly controlled by the user. (eg because
1082 the command line is being constructed by another tool, such as
1083 @samp{gcc}).
1084
1085 @kindex -u @var{symbol}
1086 @kindex --undefined=@var{symbol}
1087 @cindex undefined symbol
1088 @item -u @var{symbol}
1089 @itemx --undefined=@var{symbol}
1090 Force @var{symbol} to be entered in the output file as an undefined
1091 symbol. Doing this may, for example, trigger linking of additional
1092 modules from standard libraries. @samp{-u} may be repeated with
1093 different option arguments to enter additional undefined symbols. This
1094 option is equivalent to the @code{EXTERN} linker script command.
1095
1096 If this option is being used to force additional modules to be pulled
1097 into the link, and if it is an error for the symbol to remain
1098 undefined, then the option @option{--require-defined} should be used
1099 instead.
1100
1101 @kindex --require-defined=@var{symbol}
1102 @cindex symbols, require defined
1103 @cindex defined symbol
1104 @item --require-defined=@var{symbol}
1105 Require that @var{symbol} is defined in the output file. This option
1106 is the same as option @option{--undefined} except that if @var{symbol}
1107 is not defined in the output file then the linker will issue an error
1108 and exit. The same effect can be achieved in a linker script by using
1109 @code{EXTERN}, @code{ASSERT} and @code{DEFINED} together. This option
1110 can be used multiple times to require additional symbols.
1111
1112 @kindex -Ur
1113 @cindex constructors
1114 @item -Ur
1115 For anything other than C++ programs, this option is equivalent to
1116 @samp{-r}: it generates relocatable output---i.e., an output file that can in
1117 turn serve as input to @command{ld}. When linking C++ programs, @samp{-Ur}
1118 @emph{does} resolve references to constructors, unlike @samp{-r}.
1119 It does not work to use @samp{-Ur} on files that were themselves linked
1120 with @samp{-Ur}; once the constructor table has been built, it cannot
1121 be added to. Use @samp{-Ur} only for the last partial link, and
1122 @samp{-r} for the others.
1123
1124 @kindex --orphan-handling=@var{MODE}
1125 @cindex orphan sections
1126 @cindex sections, orphan
1127 @item --orphan-handling=@var{MODE}
1128 Control how orphan sections are handled. An orphan section is one not
1129 specifically mentioned in a linker script. @xref{Orphan Sections}.
1130
1131 @var{MODE} can have any of the following values:
1132
1133 @table @code
1134 @item place
1135 Orphan sections are placed into a suitable output section following
1136 the strategy described in @ref{Orphan Sections}. The option
1137 @samp{--unique} also affects how sections are placed.
1138
1139 @item discard
1140 All orphan sections are discarded, by placing them in the
1141 @samp{/DISCARD/} section (@pxref{Output Section Discarding}).
1142
1143 @item warn
1144 The linker will place the orphan section as for @code{place} and also
1145 issue a warning.
1146
1147 @item error
1148 The linker will exit with an error if any orphan section is found.
1149 @end table
1150
1151 The default if @samp{--orphan-handling} is not given is @code{place}.
1152
1153 @kindex --unique[=@var{SECTION}]
1154 @item --unique[=@var{SECTION}]
1155 Creates a separate output section for every input section matching
1156 @var{SECTION}, or if the optional wildcard @var{SECTION} argument is
1157 missing, for every orphan input section. An orphan section is one not
1158 specifically mentioned in a linker script. You may use this option
1159 multiple times on the command line; It prevents the normal merging of
1160 input sections with the same name, overriding output section assignments
1161 in a linker script.
1162
1163 @kindex -v
1164 @kindex -V
1165 @kindex --version
1166 @cindex version
1167 @item -v
1168 @itemx --version
1169 @itemx -V
1170 Display the version number for @command{ld}. The @option{-V} option also
1171 lists the supported emulations.
1172
1173 @kindex -x
1174 @kindex --discard-all
1175 @cindex deleting local symbols
1176 @item -x
1177 @itemx --discard-all
1178 Delete all local symbols.
1179
1180 @kindex -X
1181 @kindex --discard-locals
1182 @cindex local symbols, deleting
1183 @item -X
1184 @itemx --discard-locals
1185 Delete all temporary local symbols. (These symbols start with
1186 system-specific local label prefixes, typically @samp{.L} for ELF systems
1187 or @samp{L} for traditional a.out systems.)
1188
1189 @kindex -y @var{symbol}
1190 @kindex --trace-symbol=@var{symbol}
1191 @cindex symbol tracing
1192 @item -y @var{symbol}
1193 @itemx --trace-symbol=@var{symbol}
1194 Print the name of each linked file in which @var{symbol} appears. This
1195 option may be given any number of times. On many systems it is necessary
1196 to prepend an underscore.
1197
1198 This option is useful when you have an undefined symbol in your link but
1199 don't know where the reference is coming from.
1200
1201 @kindex -Y @var{path}
1202 @item -Y @var{path}
1203 Add @var{path} to the default library search path. This option exists
1204 for Solaris compatibility.
1205
1206 @kindex -z @var{keyword}
1207 @item -z @var{keyword}
1208 The recognized keywords are:
1209 @table @samp
1210
1211 @item bndplt
1212 Always generate BND prefix in PLT entries. Supported for Linux/x86_64.
1213
1214 @item call-nop=prefix-addr
1215 @itemx call-nop=suffix-nop
1216 @itemx call-nop=prefix-@var{byte}
1217 @itemx call-nop=suffix-@var{byte}
1218 Specify the 1-byte @code{NOP} padding when transforming indirect call
1219 to a locally defined function, foo, via its GOT slot.
1220 @option{call-nop=prefix-addr} generates @code{0x67 call foo}.
1221 @option{call-nop=suffix-nop} generates @code{call foo 0x90}.
1222 @option{call-nop=prefix-@var{byte}} generates @code{@var{byte} call foo}.
1223 @option{call-nop=suffix-@var{byte}} generates @code{call foo @var{byte}}.
1224 Supported for i386 and x86_64.
1225
1226 @item cet-report=none
1227 @itemx cet-report=warning
1228 @itemx cet-report=error
1229 Specify how to report the missing GNU_PROPERTY_X86_FEATURE_1_IBT and
1230 GNU_PROPERTY_X86_FEATURE_1_SHSTK properties in input .note.gnu.property
1231 section. @option{cet-report=none}, which is the default, will make the
1232 linker not report missing properties in input files.
1233 @option{cet-report=warning} will make the linker issue a warning for
1234 missing properties in input files. @option{cet-report=error} will make
1235 the linker issue an error for missing properties in input files.
1236 Note that @option{ibt} will turn off the missing
1237 GNU_PROPERTY_X86_FEATURE_1_IBT property report and @option{shstk} will
1238 turn off the missing GNU_PROPERTY_X86_FEATURE_1_SHSTK property report.
1239 Supported for Linux/i386 and Linux/x86_64.
1240
1241 @item combreloc
1242 @itemx nocombreloc
1243 Combine multiple dynamic relocation sections and sort to improve
1244 dynamic symbol lookup caching. Do not do this if @samp{nocombreloc}.
1245
1246 @item common
1247 @itemx nocommon
1248 Generate common symbols with STT_COMMON type during a relocatable
1249 link. Use STT_OBJECT type if @samp{nocommon}.
1250
1251 @item common-page-size=@var{value}
1252 Set the page size most commonly used to @var{value}. Memory image
1253 layout will be optimized to minimize memory pages if the system is
1254 using pages of this size.
1255
1256 @item defs
1257 Report unresolved symbol references from regular object files. This
1258 is done even if the linker is creating a non-symbolic shared library.
1259 This option is the inverse of @samp{-z undefs}.
1260
1261 @item dynamic-undefined-weak
1262 @itemx nodynamic-undefined-weak
1263 Make undefined weak symbols dynamic when building a dynamic object,
1264 if they are referenced from a regular object file and not forced local
1265 by symbol visibility or versioning. Do not make them dynamic if
1266 @samp{nodynamic-undefined-weak}. If neither option is given, a target
1267 may default to either option being in force, or make some other
1268 selection of undefined weak symbols dynamic. Not all targets support
1269 these options.
1270
1271 @item execstack
1272 Marks the object as requiring executable stack.
1273
1274 @item global
1275 This option is only meaningful when building a shared object. It makes
1276 the symbols defined by this shared object available for symbol resolution
1277 of subsequently loaded libraries.
1278
1279 @item globalaudit
1280 This option is only meaningful when building a dynamic executable.
1281 This option marks the executable as requiring global auditing by
1282 setting the @code{DF_1_GLOBAUDIT} bit in the @code{DT_FLAGS_1} dynamic
1283 tag. Global auditing requires that any auditing library defined via
1284 the @option{--depaudit} or @option{-P} command-line options be run for
1285 all dynamic objects loaded by the application.
1286
1287 @item ibtplt
1288 Generate Intel Indirect Branch Tracking (IBT) enabled PLT entries.
1289 Supported for Linux/i386 and Linux/x86_64.
1290
1291 @item ibt
1292 Generate GNU_PROPERTY_X86_FEATURE_1_IBT in .note.gnu.property section
1293 to indicate compatibility with IBT. This also implies @option{ibtplt}.
1294 Supported for Linux/i386 and Linux/x86_64.
1295
1296 @item indirect-extern-access
1297 @itemx noindirect-extern-access
1298 Generate GNU_PROPERTY_1_NEEDED_INDIRECT_EXTERN_ACCESS in
1299 .note.gnu.property section to indicate that object file requires
1300 canonical function pointers and cannot be used with copy relocation.
1301 This option also implies @option{noextern-protected-data} and
1302 @option{nocopyreloc}. Supported for i386 and x86-64.
1303
1304 @option{noindirect-extern-access} removes
1305 GNU_PROPERTY_1_NEEDED_INDIRECT_EXTERN_ACCESS from .note.gnu.property
1306 section.
1307
1308 @item initfirst
1309 This option is only meaningful when building a shared object.
1310 It marks the object so that its runtime initialization will occur
1311 before the runtime initialization of any other objects brought into
1312 the process at the same time. Similarly the runtime finalization of
1313 the object will occur after the runtime finalization of any other
1314 objects.
1315
1316 @item interpose
1317 Specify that the dynamic loader should modify its symbol search order
1318 so that symbols in this shared library interpose all other shared
1319 libraries not so marked.
1320
1321 @item unique
1322 @itemx nounique
1323 When generating a shared library or other dynamically loadable ELF
1324 object mark it as one that should (by default) only ever be loaded once,
1325 and only in the main namespace (when using @code{dlmopen}). This is
1326 primarily used to mark fundamental libraries such as libc, libpthread et
1327 al which do not usually function correctly unless they are the sole instances
1328 of themselves. This behaviour can be overridden by the @code{dlmopen} caller
1329 and does not apply to certain loading mechanisms (such as audit libraries).
1330
1331 @item lam-u48
1332 Generate GNU_PROPERTY_X86_FEATURE_1_LAM_U48 in .note.gnu.property section
1333 to indicate compatibility with Intel LAM_U48. Supported for Linux/x86_64.
1334
1335 @item lam-u57
1336 Generate GNU_PROPERTY_X86_FEATURE_1_LAM_U57 in .note.gnu.property section
1337 to indicate compatibility with Intel LAM_U57. Supported for Linux/x86_64.
1338
1339 @item lam-u48-report=none
1340 @itemx lam-u48-report=warning
1341 @itemx lam-u48-report=error
1342 Specify how to report the missing GNU_PROPERTY_X86_FEATURE_1_LAM_U48
1343 property in input .note.gnu.property section.
1344 @option{lam-u48-report=none}, which is the default, will make the
1345 linker not report missing properties in input files.
1346 @option{lam-u48-report=warning} will make the linker issue a warning for
1347 missing properties in input files. @option{lam-u48-report=error} will
1348 make the linker issue an error for missing properties in input files.
1349 Supported for Linux/x86_64.
1350
1351 @item lam-u57-report=none
1352 @itemx lam-u57-report=warning
1353 @itemx lam-u57-report=error
1354 Specify how to report the missing GNU_PROPERTY_X86_FEATURE_1_LAM_U57
1355 property in input .note.gnu.property section.
1356 @option{lam-u57-report=none}, which is the default, will make the
1357 linker not report missing properties in input files.
1358 @option{lam-u57-report=warning} will make the linker issue a warning for
1359 missing properties in input files. @option{lam-u57-report=error} will
1360 make the linker issue an error for missing properties in input files.
1361 Supported for Linux/x86_64.
1362
1363 @item lam-report=none
1364 @itemx lam-report=warning
1365 @itemx lam-report=error
1366 Specify how to report the missing GNU_PROPERTY_X86_FEATURE_1_LAM_U48 and
1367 GNU_PROPERTY_X86_FEATURE_1_LAM_U57 properties in input .note.gnu.property
1368 section. @option{lam-report=none}, which is the default, will make the
1369 linker not report missing properties in input files.
1370 @option{lam-report=warning} will make the linker issue a warning for
1371 missing properties in input files. @option{lam-report=error} will make
1372 the linker issue an error for missing properties in input files.
1373 Supported for Linux/x86_64.
1374
1375 @item lazy
1376 When generating an executable or shared library, mark it to tell the
1377 dynamic linker to defer function call resolution to the point when
1378 the function is called (lazy binding), rather than at load time.
1379 Lazy binding is the default.
1380
1381 @item loadfltr
1382 Specify that the object's filters be processed immediately at runtime.
1383
1384 @item max-page-size=@var{value}
1385 Set the maximum memory page size supported to @var{value}.
1386
1387 @item muldefs
1388 Allow multiple definitions.
1389
1390 @item nocopyreloc
1391 Disable linker generated .dynbss variables used in place of variables
1392 defined in shared libraries. May result in dynamic text relocations.
1393
1394 @item nodefaultlib
1395 Specify that the dynamic loader search for dependencies of this object
1396 should ignore any default library search paths.
1397
1398 @item nodelete
1399 Specify that the object shouldn't be unloaded at runtime.
1400
1401 @item nodlopen
1402 Specify that the object is not available to @code{dlopen}.
1403
1404 @item nodump
1405 Specify that the object can not be dumped by @code{dldump}.
1406
1407 @item noexecstack
1408 Marks the object as not requiring executable stack.
1409
1410 @item noextern-protected-data
1411 Don't treat protected data symbols as external when building a shared
1412 library. This option overrides the linker backend default. It can be
1413 used to work around incorrect relocations against protected data symbols
1414 generated by compiler. Updates on protected data symbols by another
1415 module aren't visible to the resulting shared library. Supported for
1416 i386 and x86-64.
1417
1418 @item noreloc-overflow
1419 Disable relocation overflow check. This can be used to disable
1420 relocation overflow check if there will be no dynamic relocation
1421 overflow at run-time. Supported for x86_64.
1422
1423 @item now
1424 When generating an executable or shared library, mark it to tell the
1425 dynamic linker to resolve all symbols when the program is started, or
1426 when the shared library is loaded by dlopen, instead of deferring
1427 function call resolution to the point when the function is first
1428 called.
1429
1430 @item origin
1431 Specify that the object requires @samp{$ORIGIN} handling in paths.
1432
1433 @item relro
1434 @itemx norelro
1435 Create an ELF @code{PT_GNU_RELRO} segment header in the object. This
1436 specifies a memory segment that should be made read-only after
1437 relocation, if supported. Specifying @samp{common-page-size} smaller
1438 than the system page size will render this protection ineffective.
1439 Don't create an ELF @code{PT_GNU_RELRO} segment if @samp{norelro}.
1440
1441 @item report-relative-reloc
1442 Report dynamic relative relocations generated by linker. Supported for
1443 Linux/i386 and Linux/x86_64.
1444
1445 @item separate-code
1446 @itemx noseparate-code
1447 Create separate code @code{PT_LOAD} segment header in the object. This
1448 specifies a memory segment that should contain only instructions and must
1449 be in wholly disjoint pages from any other data. Don't create separate
1450 code @code{PT_LOAD} segment if @samp{noseparate-code} is used.
1451
1452 @item shstk
1453 Generate GNU_PROPERTY_X86_FEATURE_1_SHSTK in .note.gnu.property section
1454 to indicate compatibility with Intel Shadow Stack. Supported for
1455 Linux/i386 and Linux/x86_64.
1456
1457 @item stack-size=@var{value}
1458 Specify a stack size for an ELF @code{PT_GNU_STACK} segment.
1459 Specifying zero will override any default non-zero sized
1460 @code{PT_GNU_STACK} segment creation.
1461
1462 @item start-stop-gc
1463 @itemx nostart-stop-gc
1464 @cindex start-stop-gc
1465 When @samp{--gc-sections} is in effect, a reference from a retained
1466 section to @code{__start_SECNAME} or @code{__stop_SECNAME} causes all
1467 input sections named @code{SECNAME} to also be retained, if
1468 @code{SECNAME} is representable as a C identifier and either
1469 @code{__start_SECNAME} or @code{__stop_SECNAME} is synthesized by the
1470 linker. @samp{-z start-stop-gc} disables this effect, allowing
1471 sections to be garbage collected as if the special synthesized symbols
1472 were not defined. @samp{-z start-stop-gc} has no effect on a
1473 definition of @code{__start_SECNAME} or @code{__stop_SECNAME} in an
1474 object file or linker script. Such a definition will prevent the
1475 linker providing a synthesized @code{__start_SECNAME} or
1476 @code{__stop_SECNAME} respectively, and therefore the special
1477 treatment by garbage collection for those references.
1478
1479 @item start-stop-visibility=@var{value}
1480 @cindex visibility
1481 @cindex ELF symbol visibility
1482 Specify the ELF symbol visibility for synthesized
1483 @code{__start_SECNAME} and @code{__stop_SECNAME} symbols (@pxref{Input
1484 Section Example}). @var{value} must be exactly @samp{default},
1485 @samp{internal}, @samp{hidden}, or @samp{protected}. If no @samp{-z
1486 start-stop-visibility} option is given, @samp{protected} is used for
1487 compatibility with historical practice. However, it's highly
1488 recommended to use @samp{-z start-stop-visibility=hidden} in new
1489 programs and shared libraries so that these symbols are not exported
1490 between shared objects, which is not usually what's intended.
1491
1492 @item text
1493 @itemx notext
1494 @itemx textoff
1495 Report an error if DT_TEXTREL is set, i.e., if the position-independent
1496 or shared object has dynamic relocations in read-only sections. Don't
1497 report an error if @samp{notext} or @samp{textoff}.
1498
1499 @item undefs
1500 Do not report unresolved symbol references from regular object files,
1501 either when creating an executable, or when creating a shared library.
1502 This option is the inverse of @samp{-z defs}.
1503
1504 @item unique-symbol
1505 @itemx nounique-symbol
1506 Avoid duplicated local symbol names in the symbol string table. Append
1507 ".@code{number}" to duplicated local symbol names if @samp{unique-symbol}
1508 is used. @option{nounique-symbol} is the default.
1509
1510 @item x86-64-baseline
1511 @item x86-64-v2
1512 @item x86-64-v3
1513 @itemx x86-64-v4
1514 Specify the x86-64 ISA level needed in .note.gnu.property section.
1515 @option{x86-64-baseline} generates @code{GNU_PROPERTY_X86_ISA_1_BASELINE}.
1516 @option{x86-64-v2} generates @code{GNU_PROPERTY_X86_ISA_1_V2}.
1517 @option{x86-64-v3} generates @code{GNU_PROPERTY_X86_ISA_1_V3}.
1518 @option{x86-64-v4} generates @code{GNU_PROPERTY_X86_ISA_1_V4}.
1519 Supported for Linux/i386 and Linux/x86_64.
1520
1521 @end table
1522
1523 Other keywords are ignored for Solaris compatibility.
1524
1525 @kindex -(
1526 @cindex groups of archives
1527 @item -( @var{archives} -)
1528 @itemx --start-group @var{archives} --end-group
1529 The @var{archives} should be a list of archive files. They may be
1530 either explicit file names, or @samp{-l} options.
1531
1532 The specified archives are searched repeatedly until no new undefined
1533 references are created. Normally, an archive is searched only once in
1534 the order that it is specified on the command line. If a symbol in that
1535 archive is needed to resolve an undefined symbol referred to by an
1536 object in an archive that appears later on the command line, the linker
1537 would not be able to resolve that reference. By grouping the archives,
1538 they will all be searched repeatedly until all possible references are
1539 resolved.
1540
1541 Using this option has a significant performance cost. It is best to use
1542 it only when there are unavoidable circular references between two or
1543 more archives.
1544
1545 @kindex --accept-unknown-input-arch
1546 @kindex --no-accept-unknown-input-arch
1547 @item --accept-unknown-input-arch
1548 @itemx --no-accept-unknown-input-arch
1549 Tells the linker to accept input files whose architecture cannot be
1550 recognised. The assumption is that the user knows what they are doing
1551 and deliberately wants to link in these unknown input files. This was
1552 the default behaviour of the linker, before release 2.14. The default
1553 behaviour from release 2.14 onwards is to reject such input files, and
1554 so the @samp{--accept-unknown-input-arch} option has been added to
1555 restore the old behaviour.
1556
1557 @kindex --as-needed
1558 @kindex --no-as-needed
1559 @item --as-needed
1560 @itemx --no-as-needed
1561 This option affects ELF DT_NEEDED tags for dynamic libraries mentioned
1562 on the command line after the @option{--as-needed} option. Normally
1563 the linker will add a DT_NEEDED tag for each dynamic library mentioned
1564 on the command line, regardless of whether the library is actually
1565 needed or not. @option{--as-needed} causes a DT_NEEDED tag to only be
1566 emitted for a library that @emph{at that point in the link} satisfies a
1567 non-weak undefined symbol reference from a regular object file or, if
1568 the library is not found in the DT_NEEDED lists of other needed libraries, a
1569 non-weak undefined symbol reference from another needed dynamic library.
1570 Object files or libraries appearing on the command line @emph{after}
1571 the library in question do not affect whether the library is seen as
1572 needed. This is similar to the rules for extraction of object files
1573 from archives. @option{--no-as-needed} restores the default behaviour.
1574
1575 Note: On Linux based systems the @option{--as-needed} option also has
1576 an affect on the behaviour of the @option{--rpath} and
1577 @option{--rpath-link} options. See the description of
1578 @option{--rpath-link} for more details.
1579
1580 @kindex --add-needed
1581 @kindex --no-add-needed
1582 @item --add-needed
1583 @itemx --no-add-needed
1584 These two options have been deprecated because of the similarity of
1585 their names to the @option{--as-needed} and @option{--no-as-needed}
1586 options. They have been replaced by @option{--copy-dt-needed-entries}
1587 and @option{--no-copy-dt-needed-entries}.
1588
1589 @kindex -assert @var{keyword}
1590 @item -assert @var{keyword}
1591 This option is ignored for SunOS compatibility.
1592
1593 @kindex -Bdynamic
1594 @kindex -dy
1595 @kindex -call_shared
1596 @item -Bdynamic
1597 @itemx -dy
1598 @itemx -call_shared
1599 Link against dynamic libraries. This is only meaningful on platforms
1600 for which shared libraries are supported. This option is normally the
1601 default on such platforms. The different variants of this option are
1602 for compatibility with various systems. You may use this option
1603 multiple times on the command line: it affects library searching for
1604 @option{-l} options which follow it.
1605
1606 @kindex -Bgroup
1607 @item -Bgroup
1608 Set the @code{DF_1_GROUP} flag in the @code{DT_FLAGS_1} entry in the dynamic
1609 section. This causes the runtime linker to handle lookups in this
1610 object and its dependencies to be performed only inside the group.
1611 @option{--unresolved-symbols=report-all} is implied. This option is
1612 only meaningful on ELF platforms which support shared libraries.
1613
1614 @kindex -Bstatic
1615 @kindex -dn
1616 @kindex -non_shared
1617 @kindex -static
1618 @item -Bstatic
1619 @itemx -dn
1620 @itemx -non_shared
1621 @itemx -static
1622 Do not link against shared libraries. This is only meaningful on
1623 platforms for which shared libraries are supported. The different
1624 variants of this option are for compatibility with various systems. You
1625 may use this option multiple times on the command line: it affects
1626 library searching for @option{-l} options which follow it. This
1627 option also implies @option{--unresolved-symbols=report-all}. This
1628 option can be used with @option{-shared}. Doing so means that a
1629 shared library is being created but that all of the library's external
1630 references must be resolved by pulling in entries from static
1631 libraries.
1632
1633 @kindex -Bsymbolic
1634 @item -Bsymbolic
1635 When creating a shared library, bind references to global symbols to the
1636 definition within the shared library, if any. Normally, it is possible
1637 for a program linked against a shared library to override the definition
1638 within the shared library. This option is only meaningful on ELF
1639 platforms which support shared libraries.
1640
1641 @kindex -Bsymbolic-functions
1642 @item -Bsymbolic-functions
1643 When creating a shared library, bind references to global function
1644 symbols to the definition within the shared library, if any.
1645 This option is only meaningful on ELF platforms which support shared
1646 libraries.
1647
1648 @kindex -Bno-symbolic
1649 @item -Bno-symbolic
1650 This option can cancel previously specified @samp{-Bsymbolic} and
1651 @samp{-Bsymbolic-functions}.
1652
1653 @kindex --dynamic-list=@var{dynamic-list-file}
1654 @item --dynamic-list=@var{dynamic-list-file}
1655 Specify the name of a dynamic list file to the linker. This is
1656 typically used when creating shared libraries to specify a list of
1657 global symbols whose references shouldn't be bound to the definition
1658 within the shared library, or creating dynamically linked executables
1659 to specify a list of symbols which should be added to the symbol table
1660 in the executable. This option is only meaningful on ELF platforms
1661 which support shared libraries.
1662
1663 The format of the dynamic list is the same as the version node without
1664 scope and node name. See @ref{VERSION} for more information.
1665
1666 @kindex --dynamic-list-data
1667 @item --dynamic-list-data
1668 Include all global data symbols to the dynamic list.
1669
1670 @kindex --dynamic-list-cpp-new
1671 @item --dynamic-list-cpp-new
1672 Provide the builtin dynamic list for C++ operator new and delete. It
1673 is mainly useful for building shared libstdc++.
1674
1675 @kindex --dynamic-list-cpp-typeinfo
1676 @item --dynamic-list-cpp-typeinfo
1677 Provide the builtin dynamic list for C++ runtime type identification.
1678
1679 @kindex --check-sections
1680 @kindex --no-check-sections
1681 @item --check-sections
1682 @itemx --no-check-sections
1683 Asks the linker @emph{not} to check section addresses after they have
1684 been assigned to see if there are any overlaps. Normally the linker will
1685 perform this check, and if it finds any overlaps it will produce
1686 suitable error messages. The linker does know about, and does make
1687 allowances for sections in overlays. The default behaviour can be
1688 restored by using the command-line switch @option{--check-sections}.
1689 Section overlap is not usually checked for relocatable links. You can
1690 force checking in that case by using the @option{--check-sections}
1691 option.
1692
1693 @kindex --copy-dt-needed-entries
1694 @kindex --no-copy-dt-needed-entries
1695 @item --copy-dt-needed-entries
1696 @itemx --no-copy-dt-needed-entries
1697 This option affects the treatment of dynamic libraries referred to
1698 by DT_NEEDED tags @emph{inside} ELF dynamic libraries mentioned on the
1699 command line. Normally the linker won't add a DT_NEEDED tag to the
1700 output binary for each library mentioned in a DT_NEEDED tag in an
1701 input dynamic library. With @option{--copy-dt-needed-entries}
1702 specified on the command line however any dynamic libraries that
1703 follow it will have their DT_NEEDED entries added. The default
1704 behaviour can be restored with @option{--no-copy-dt-needed-entries}.
1705
1706 This option also has an effect on the resolution of symbols in dynamic
1707 libraries. With @option{--copy-dt-needed-entries} dynamic libraries
1708 mentioned on the command line will be recursively searched, following
1709 their DT_NEEDED tags to other libraries, in order to resolve symbols
1710 required by the output binary. With the default setting however
1711 the searching of dynamic libraries that follow it will stop with the
1712 dynamic library itself. No DT_NEEDED links will be traversed to resolve
1713 symbols.
1714
1715 @cindex cross reference table
1716 @kindex --cref
1717 @item --cref
1718 Output a cross reference table. If a linker map file is being
1719 generated, the cross reference table is printed to the map file.
1720 Otherwise, it is printed on the standard output.
1721
1722 The format of the table is intentionally simple, so that it may be
1723 easily processed by a script if necessary. The symbols are printed out,
1724 sorted by name. For each symbol, a list of file names is given. If the
1725 symbol is defined, the first file listed is the location of the
1726 definition. If the symbol is defined as a common value then any files
1727 where this happens appear next. Finally any files that reference the
1728 symbol are listed.
1729
1730 @cindex ctf variables
1731 @kindex --ctf-variables
1732 @kindex --no-ctf-variables
1733 @item --ctf-variables
1734 @item --no-ctf-variables
1735 The CTF debuginfo format supports a section which encodes the names and
1736 types of variables found in the program which do not appear in any symbol
1737 table. These variables clearly cannot be looked up by address by
1738 conventional debuggers, so the space used for their types and names is
1739 usually wasted: the types are usually small but the names are often not.
1740 @option{--ctf-variables} causes the generation of such a section.
1741 The default behaviour can be restored with @option{--no-ctf-variables}.
1742
1743 @cindex ctf type sharing
1744 @kindex --ctf-share-types
1745 @item --ctf-share-types=@var{method}
1746 Adjust the method used to share types between translation units in CTF.
1747
1748 @table @samp
1749 @item share-unconflicted
1750 Put all types that do not have ambiguous definitions into the shared dictionary,
1751 where debuggers can easily access them, even if they only occur in one
1752 translation unit. This is the default.
1753
1754 @item share-duplicated
1755 Put only types that occur in multiple translation units into the shared
1756 dictionary: types with only one definition go into per-translation-unit
1757 dictionaries. Types with ambiguous definitions in multiple translation units
1758 always go into per-translation-unit dictionaries. This tends to make the CTF
1759 larger, but may reduce the amount of CTF in the shared dictionary. For very
1760 large projects this may speed up opening the CTF and save memory in the CTF
1761 consumer at runtime.
1762 @end table
1763
1764 @cindex common allocation
1765 @kindex --no-define-common
1766 @item --no-define-common
1767 This option inhibits the assignment of addresses to common symbols.
1768 The script command @code{INHIBIT_COMMON_ALLOCATION} has the same effect.
1769 @xref{Miscellaneous Commands}.
1770
1771 The @samp{--no-define-common} option allows decoupling
1772 the decision to assign addresses to Common symbols from the choice
1773 of the output file type; otherwise a non-Relocatable output type
1774 forces assigning addresses to Common symbols.
1775 Using @samp{--no-define-common} allows Common symbols that are referenced
1776 from a shared library to be assigned addresses only in the main program.
1777 This eliminates the unused duplicate space in the shared library,
1778 and also prevents any possible confusion over resolving to the wrong
1779 duplicate when there are many dynamic modules with specialized search
1780 paths for runtime symbol resolution.
1781
1782 @cindex group allocation in linker script
1783 @cindex section groups
1784 @cindex COMDAT
1785 @kindex --force-group-allocation
1786 @item --force-group-allocation
1787 This option causes the linker to place section group members like
1788 normal input sections, and to delete the section groups. This is the
1789 default behaviour for a final link but this option can be used to
1790 change the behaviour of a relocatable link (@samp{-r}). The script
1791 command @code{FORCE_GROUP_ALLOCATION} has the same
1792 effect. @xref{Miscellaneous Commands}.
1793
1794 @cindex symbols, from command line
1795 @kindex --defsym=@var{symbol}=@var{exp}
1796 @item --defsym=@var{symbol}=@var{expression}
1797 Create a global symbol in the output file, containing the absolute
1798 address given by @var{expression}. You may use this option as many
1799 times as necessary to define multiple symbols in the command line. A
1800 limited form of arithmetic is supported for the @var{expression} in this
1801 context: you may give a hexadecimal constant or the name of an existing
1802 symbol, or use @code{+} and @code{-} to add or subtract hexadecimal
1803 constants or symbols. If you need more elaborate expressions, consider
1804 using the linker command language from a script (@pxref{Assignments}).
1805 @emph{Note:} there should be no white space between @var{symbol}, the
1806 equals sign (``@key{=}''), and @var{expression}.
1807
1808 The linker processes @samp{--defsym} arguments and @samp{-T} arguments
1809 in order, placing @samp{--defsym} before @samp{-T} will define the
1810 symbol before the linker script from @samp{-T} is processed, while
1811 placing @samp{--defsym} after @samp{-T} will define the symbol after
1812 the linker script has been processed. This difference has
1813 consequences for expressions within the linker script that use the
1814 @samp{--defsym} symbols, which order is correct will depend on what
1815 you are trying to achieve.
1816
1817 @cindex demangling, from command line
1818 @kindex --demangle[=@var{style}]
1819 @kindex --no-demangle
1820 @item --demangle[=@var{style}]
1821 @itemx --no-demangle
1822 These options control whether to demangle symbol names in error messages
1823 and other output. When the linker is told to demangle, it tries to
1824 present symbol names in a readable fashion: it strips leading
1825 underscores if they are used by the object file format, and converts C++
1826 mangled symbol names into user readable names. Different compilers have
1827 different mangling styles. The optional demangling style argument can be used
1828 to choose an appropriate demangling style for your compiler. The linker will
1829 demangle by default unless the environment variable @samp{COLLECT_NO_DEMANGLE}
1830 is set. These options may be used to override the default.
1831
1832 @cindex dynamic linker, from command line
1833 @kindex -I@var{file}
1834 @kindex --dynamic-linker=@var{file}
1835 @item -I@var{file}
1836 @itemx --dynamic-linker=@var{file}
1837 Set the name of the dynamic linker. This is only meaningful when
1838 generating dynamically linked ELF executables. The default dynamic
1839 linker is normally correct; don't use this unless you know what you are
1840 doing.
1841
1842 @kindex --no-dynamic-linker
1843 @item --no-dynamic-linker
1844 When producing an executable file, omit the request for a dynamic
1845 linker to be used at load-time. This is only meaningful for ELF
1846 executables that contain dynamic relocations, and usually requires
1847 entry point code that is capable of processing these relocations.
1848
1849 @kindex --embedded-relocs
1850 @item --embedded-relocs
1851 This option is similar to the @option{--emit-relocs} option except
1852 that the relocs are stored in a target-specific section. This option
1853 is only supported by the @samp{BFIN}, @samp{CR16} and @emph{M68K}
1854 targets.
1855
1856 @kindex --disable-multiple-abs-defs
1857 @item --disable-multiple-abs-defs
1858 Do not allow multiple definitions with symbols included
1859 in filename invoked by -R or --just-symbols
1860
1861 @kindex --fatal-warnings
1862 @kindex --no-fatal-warnings
1863 @item --fatal-warnings
1864 @itemx --no-fatal-warnings
1865 Treat all warnings as errors. The default behaviour can be restored
1866 with the option @option{--no-fatal-warnings}.
1867
1868 @kindex --force-exe-suffix
1869 @item --force-exe-suffix
1870 Make sure that an output file has a .exe suffix.
1871
1872 If a successfully built fully linked output file does not have a
1873 @code{.exe} or @code{.dll} suffix, this option forces the linker to copy
1874 the output file to one of the same name with a @code{.exe} suffix. This
1875 option is useful when using unmodified Unix makefiles on a Microsoft
1876 Windows host, since some versions of Windows won't run an image unless
1877 it ends in a @code{.exe} suffix.
1878
1879 @kindex --gc-sections
1880 @kindex --no-gc-sections
1881 @cindex garbage collection
1882 @item --gc-sections
1883 @itemx --no-gc-sections
1884 Enable garbage collection of unused input sections. It is ignored on
1885 targets that do not support this option. The default behaviour (of not
1886 performing this garbage collection) can be restored by specifying
1887 @samp{--no-gc-sections} on the command line. Note that garbage
1888 collection for COFF and PE format targets is supported, but the
1889 implementation is currently considered to be experimental.
1890
1891 @samp{--gc-sections} decides which input sections are used by
1892 examining symbols and relocations. The section containing the entry
1893 symbol and all sections containing symbols undefined on the
1894 command-line will be kept, as will sections containing symbols
1895 referenced by dynamic objects. Note that when building shared
1896 libraries, the linker must assume that any visible symbol is
1897 referenced. Once this initial set of sections has been determined,
1898 the linker recursively marks as used any section referenced by their
1899 relocations. See @samp{--entry}, @samp{--undefined}, and
1900 @samp{--gc-keep-exported}.
1901
1902 This option can be set when doing a partial link (enabled with option
1903 @samp{-r}). In this case the root of symbols kept must be explicitly
1904 specified either by one of the options @samp{--entry},
1905 @samp{--undefined}, or @samp{--gc-keep-exported} or by a @code{ENTRY}
1906 command in the linker script.
1907
1908 As a GNU extension, ELF input sections marked with the
1909 @code{SHF_GNU_RETAIN} flag will not be garbage collected.
1910
1911 @kindex --print-gc-sections
1912 @kindex --no-print-gc-sections
1913 @cindex garbage collection
1914 @item --print-gc-sections
1915 @itemx --no-print-gc-sections
1916 List all sections removed by garbage collection. The listing is
1917 printed on stderr. This option is only effective if garbage
1918 collection has been enabled via the @samp{--gc-sections}) option. The
1919 default behaviour (of not listing the sections that are removed) can
1920 be restored by specifying @samp{--no-print-gc-sections} on the command
1921 line.
1922
1923 @kindex --gc-keep-exported
1924 @cindex garbage collection
1925 @item --gc-keep-exported
1926 When @samp{--gc-sections} is enabled, this option prevents garbage
1927 collection of unused input sections that contain global symbols having
1928 default or protected visibility. This option is intended to be used for
1929 executables where unreferenced sections would otherwise be garbage
1930 collected regardless of the external visibility of contained symbols.
1931 Note that this option has no effect when linking shared objects since
1932 it is already the default behaviour. This option is only supported for
1933 ELF format targets.
1934
1935 @kindex --print-output-format
1936 @cindex output format
1937 @item --print-output-format
1938 Print the name of the default output format (perhaps influenced by
1939 other command-line options). This is the string that would appear
1940 in an @code{OUTPUT_FORMAT} linker script command (@pxref{File Commands}).
1941
1942 @kindex --print-memory-usage
1943 @cindex memory usage
1944 @item --print-memory-usage
1945 Print used size, total size and used size of memory regions created with
1946 the @ref{MEMORY} command. This is useful on embedded targets to have a
1947 quick view of amount of free memory. The format of the output has one
1948 headline and one line per region. It is both human readable and easily
1949 parsable by tools. Here is an example of an output:
1950
1951 @smallexample
1952 Memory region Used Size Region Size %age Used
1953 ROM: 256 KB 1 MB 25.00%
1954 RAM: 32 B 2 GB 0.00%
1955 @end smallexample
1956
1957 @cindex help
1958 @cindex usage
1959 @kindex --help
1960 @item --help
1961 Print a summary of the command-line options on the standard output and exit.
1962
1963 @kindex --target-help
1964 @item --target-help
1965 Print a summary of all target-specific options on the standard output and exit.
1966
1967 @kindex -Map=@var{mapfile}
1968 @item -Map=@var{mapfile}
1969 Print a link map to the file @var{mapfile}. See the description of the
1970 @option{-M} option, above. If @var{mapfile} is just the character
1971 @code{-} then the map will be written to stdout.
1972
1973 Specifying a directory as @var{mapfile} causes the linker map to be
1974 written as a file inside the directory. Normally name of the file
1975 inside the directory is computed as the basename of the @var{output}
1976 file with @code{.map} appended. If however the special character
1977 @code{%} is used then this will be replaced by the full path of the
1978 output file. Additionally if there are any characters after the
1979 @var{%} symbol then @code{.map} will no longer be appended.
1980
1981 @smallexample
1982 -o foo.exe -Map=bar [Creates ./bar]
1983 -o ../dir/foo.exe -Map=bar [Creates ./bar]
1984 -o foo.exe -Map=../dir [Creates ../dir/foo.exe.map]
1985 -o ../dir2/foo.exe -Map=../dir [Creates ../dir/foo.exe.map]
1986 -o foo.exe -Map=% [Creates ./foo.exe.map]
1987 -o ../dir/foo.exe -Map=% [Creates ../dir/foo.exe.map]
1988 -o foo.exe -Map=%.bar [Creates ./foo.exe.bar]
1989 -o ../dir/foo.exe -Map=%.bar [Creates ../dir/foo.exe.bar]
1990 -o ../dir2/foo.exe -Map=../dir/% [Creates ../dir/../dir2/foo.exe.map]
1991 -o ../dir2/foo.exe -Map=../dir/%.bar [Creates ../dir/../dir2/foo.exe.bar]
1992 @end smallexample
1993
1994 It is an error to specify more than one @code{%} character.
1995
1996 If the map file already exists then it will be overwritten by this
1997 operation.
1998
1999 @cindex memory usage
2000 @kindex --no-keep-memory
2001 @item --no-keep-memory
2002 @command{ld} normally optimizes for speed over memory usage by caching the
2003 symbol tables of input files in memory. This option tells @command{ld} to
2004 instead optimize for memory usage, by rereading the symbol tables as
2005 necessary. This may be required if @command{ld} runs out of memory space
2006 while linking a large executable.
2007
2008 @kindex --no-undefined
2009 @kindex -z defs
2010 @kindex -z undefs
2011 @item --no-undefined
2012 @itemx -z defs
2013 Report unresolved symbol references from regular object files. This
2014 is done even if the linker is creating a non-symbolic shared library.
2015 The switch @option{--[no-]allow-shlib-undefined} controls the
2016 behaviour for reporting unresolved references found in shared
2017 libraries being linked in.
2018
2019 The effects of this option can be reverted by using @code{-z undefs}.
2020
2021 @kindex --allow-multiple-definition
2022 @kindex -z muldefs
2023 @item --allow-multiple-definition
2024 @itemx -z muldefs
2025 Normally when a symbol is defined multiple times, the linker will
2026 report a fatal error. These options allow multiple definitions and the
2027 first definition will be used.
2028
2029 @kindex --allow-shlib-undefined
2030 @kindex --no-allow-shlib-undefined
2031 @item --allow-shlib-undefined
2032 @itemx --no-allow-shlib-undefined
2033 Allows or disallows undefined symbols in shared libraries.
2034 This switch is similar to @option{--no-undefined} except that it
2035 determines the behaviour when the undefined symbols are in a
2036 shared library rather than a regular object file. It does not affect
2037 how undefined symbols in regular object files are handled.
2038
2039 The default behaviour is to report errors for any undefined symbols
2040 referenced in shared libraries if the linker is being used to create
2041 an executable, but to allow them if the linker is being used to create
2042 a shared library.
2043
2044 The reasons for allowing undefined symbol references in shared
2045 libraries specified at link time are that:
2046
2047 @itemize @bullet
2048 @item
2049 A shared library specified at link time may not be the same as the one
2050 that is available at load time, so the symbol might actually be
2051 resolvable at load time.
2052 @item
2053 There are some operating systems, eg BeOS and HPPA, where undefined
2054 symbols in shared libraries are normal.
2055
2056 The BeOS kernel for example patches shared libraries at load time to
2057 select whichever function is most appropriate for the current
2058 architecture. This is used, for example, to dynamically select an
2059 appropriate memset function.
2060 @end itemize
2061
2062 @kindex --error-handling-script=@var{scriptname}
2063 @item --error-handling-script=@var{scriptname}
2064 If this option is provided then the linker will invoke
2065 @var{scriptname} whenever an error is encountered. Currently however
2066 only two kinds of error are supported: missing symbols and missing
2067 libraries. Two arguments will be passed to script: the keyword
2068 ``undefined-symbol'' or `missing-lib'' and the @var{name} of the
2069 undefined symbol or missing library. The intention is that the script
2070 will provide suggestions to the user as to where the symbol or library
2071 might be found. After the script has finished then the normal linker
2072 error message will be displayed.
2073
2074 The availability of this option is controlled by a configure time
2075 switch, so it may not be present in specific implementations.
2076
2077 @kindex --no-undefined-version
2078 @item --no-undefined-version
2079 Normally when a symbol has an undefined version, the linker will ignore
2080 it. This option disallows symbols with undefined version and a fatal error
2081 will be issued instead.
2082
2083 @kindex --default-symver
2084 @item --default-symver
2085 Create and use a default symbol version (the soname) for unversioned
2086 exported symbols.
2087
2088 @kindex --default-imported-symver
2089 @item --default-imported-symver
2090 Create and use a default symbol version (the soname) for unversioned
2091 imported symbols.
2092
2093 @kindex --no-warn-mismatch
2094 @item --no-warn-mismatch
2095 Normally @command{ld} will give an error if you try to link together input
2096 files that are mismatched for some reason, perhaps because they have
2097 been compiled for different processors or for different endiannesses.
2098 This option tells @command{ld} that it should silently permit such possible
2099 errors. This option should only be used with care, in cases when you
2100 have taken some special action that ensures that the linker errors are
2101 inappropriate.
2102
2103 @kindex --no-warn-search-mismatch
2104 @item --no-warn-search-mismatch
2105 Normally @command{ld} will give a warning if it finds an incompatible
2106 library during a library search. This option silences the warning.
2107
2108 @kindex --no-whole-archive
2109 @item --no-whole-archive
2110 Turn off the effect of the @option{--whole-archive} option for subsequent
2111 archive files.
2112
2113 @cindex output file after errors
2114 @kindex --noinhibit-exec
2115 @item --noinhibit-exec
2116 Retain the executable output file whenever it is still usable.
2117 Normally, the linker will not produce an output file if it encounters
2118 errors during the link process; it exits without writing an output file
2119 when it issues any error whatsoever.
2120
2121 @kindex -nostdlib
2122 @item -nostdlib
2123 Only search library directories explicitly specified on the
2124 command line. Library directories specified in linker scripts
2125 (including linker scripts specified on the command line) are ignored.
2126
2127 @ifclear SingleFormat
2128 @kindex --oformat=@var{output-format}
2129 @item --oformat=@var{output-format}
2130 @command{ld} may be configured to support more than one kind of object
2131 file. If your @command{ld} is configured this way, you can use the
2132 @samp{--oformat} option to specify the binary format for the output
2133 object file. Even when @command{ld} is configured to support alternative
2134 object formats, you don't usually need to specify this, as @command{ld}
2135 should be configured to produce as a default output format the most
2136 usual format on each machine. @var{output-format} is a text string, the
2137 name of a particular format supported by the BFD libraries. (You can
2138 list the available binary formats with @samp{objdump -i}.) The script
2139 command @code{OUTPUT_FORMAT} can also specify the output format, but
2140 this option overrides it. @xref{BFD}.
2141 @end ifclear
2142
2143 @kindex --out-implib
2144 @item --out-implib @var{file}
2145 Create an import library in @var{file} corresponding to the executable
2146 the linker is generating (eg. a DLL or ELF program). This import
2147 library (which should be called @code{*.dll.a} or @code{*.a} for DLLs)
2148 may be used to link clients against the generated executable; this
2149 behaviour makes it possible to skip a separate import library creation
2150 step (eg. @code{dlltool} for DLLs). This option is only available for
2151 the i386 PE and ELF targetted ports of the linker.
2152
2153 @kindex -pie
2154 @kindex --pic-executable
2155 @item -pie
2156 @itemx --pic-executable
2157 @cindex position independent executables
2158 Create a position independent executable. This is currently only supported on
2159 ELF platforms. Position independent executables are similar to shared
2160 libraries in that they are relocated by the dynamic linker to the virtual
2161 address the OS chooses for them (which can vary between invocations). Like
2162 normal dynamically linked executables they can be executed and symbols
2163 defined in the executable cannot be overridden by shared libraries.
2164
2165 @kindex -no-pie
2166 @item -no-pie
2167 @cindex position dependent executables
2168 Create a position dependent executable. This is the default.
2169
2170 @kindex -qmagic
2171 @item -qmagic
2172 This option is ignored for Linux compatibility.
2173
2174 @kindex -Qy
2175 @item -Qy
2176 This option is ignored for SVR4 compatibility.
2177
2178 @kindex --relax
2179 @cindex synthesizing linker
2180 @cindex relaxing addressing modes
2181 @cindex --no-relax
2182 @item --relax
2183 @itemx --no-relax
2184 An option with machine dependent effects.
2185 @ifset GENERIC
2186 This option is only supported on a few targets.
2187 @end ifset
2188 @ifset H8300
2189 @xref{H8/300,,@command{ld} and the H8/300}.
2190 @end ifset
2191 @ifset XTENSA
2192 @xref{Xtensa,, @command{ld} and Xtensa Processors}.
2193 @end ifset
2194 @ifset M68HC11
2195 @xref{M68HC11/68HC12,,@command{ld} and the 68HC11 and 68HC12}.
2196 @end ifset
2197 @ifset NIOSII
2198 @xref{Nios II,,@command{ld} and the Altera Nios II}.
2199 @end ifset
2200 @ifset POWERPC
2201 @xref{PowerPC ELF32,,@command{ld} and PowerPC 32-bit ELF Support}.
2202 @end ifset
2203
2204 On some platforms the @option{--relax} option performs target specific,
2205 global optimizations that become possible when the linker resolves
2206 addressing in the program, such as relaxing address modes,
2207 synthesizing new instructions, selecting shorter version of current
2208 instructions, and combining constant values.
2209
2210 On some platforms these link time global optimizations may make symbolic
2211 debugging of the resulting executable impossible.
2212 @ifset GENERIC
2213 This is known to be the case for the Matsushita MN10200 and MN10300
2214 family of processors.
2215 @end ifset
2216
2217 On platforms where the feature is supported, the option
2218 @option{--no-relax} will disable it.
2219
2220 On platforms where the feature is not supported, both @option{--relax}
2221 and @option{--no-relax} are accepted, but ignored.
2222
2223 @cindex retaining specified symbols
2224 @cindex stripping all but some symbols
2225 @cindex symbols, retaining selectively
2226 @kindex --retain-symbols-file=@var{filename}
2227 @item --retain-symbols-file=@var{filename}
2228 Retain @emph{only} the symbols listed in the file @var{filename},
2229 discarding all others. @var{filename} is simply a flat file, with one
2230 symbol name per line. This option is especially useful in environments
2231 @ifset GENERIC
2232 (such as VxWorks)
2233 @end ifset
2234 where a large global symbol table is accumulated gradually, to conserve
2235 run-time memory.
2236
2237 @samp{--retain-symbols-file} does @emph{not} discard undefined symbols,
2238 or symbols needed for relocations.
2239
2240 You may only specify @samp{--retain-symbols-file} once in the command
2241 line. It overrides @samp{-s} and @samp{-S}.
2242
2243 @ifset GENERIC
2244 @item -rpath=@var{dir}
2245 @cindex runtime library search path
2246 @kindex -rpath=@var{dir}
2247 Add a directory to the runtime library search path. This is used when
2248 linking an ELF executable with shared objects. All @option{-rpath}
2249 arguments are concatenated and passed to the runtime linker, which uses
2250 them to locate shared objects at runtime.
2251
2252 The @option{-rpath} option is also used when locating shared objects which
2253 are needed by shared objects explicitly included in the link; see the
2254 description of the @option{-rpath-link} option. Searching @option{-rpath}
2255 in this way is only supported by native linkers and cross linkers which
2256 have been configured with the @option{--with-sysroot} option.
2257
2258 If @option{-rpath} is not used when linking an ELF executable, the
2259 contents of the environment variable @code{LD_RUN_PATH} will be used if it
2260 is defined.
2261
2262 The @option{-rpath} option may also be used on SunOS. By default, on
2263 SunOS, the linker will form a runtime search path out of all the
2264 @option{-L} options it is given. If a @option{-rpath} option is used, the
2265 runtime search path will be formed exclusively using the @option{-rpath}
2266 options, ignoring the @option{-L} options. This can be useful when using
2267 gcc, which adds many @option{-L} options which may be on NFS mounted
2268 file systems.
2269
2270 For compatibility with other ELF linkers, if the @option{-R} option is
2271 followed by a directory name, rather than a file name, it is treated as
2272 the @option{-rpath} option.
2273 @end ifset
2274
2275 @ifset GENERIC
2276 @cindex link-time runtime library search path
2277 @kindex -rpath-link=@var{dir}
2278 @item -rpath-link=@var{dir}
2279 When using ELF or SunOS, one shared library may require another. This
2280 happens when an @code{ld -shared} link includes a shared library as one
2281 of the input files.
2282
2283 When the linker encounters such a dependency when doing a non-shared,
2284 non-relocatable link, it will automatically try to locate the required
2285 shared library and include it in the link, if it is not included
2286 explicitly. In such a case, the @option{-rpath-link} option
2287 specifies the first set of directories to search. The
2288 @option{-rpath-link} option may specify a sequence of directory names
2289 either by specifying a list of names separated by colons, or by
2290 appearing multiple times.
2291
2292 The tokens @var{$ORIGIN} and @var{$LIB} can appear in these search
2293 directories. They will be replaced by the full path to the directory
2294 containing the program or shared object in the case of @var{$ORIGIN}
2295 and either @samp{lib} - for 32-bit binaries - or @samp{lib64} - for
2296 64-bit binaries - in the case of @var{$LIB}.
2297
2298 The alternative form of these tokens - @var{$@{ORIGIN@}} and
2299 @var{$@{LIB@}} can also be used. The token @var{$PLATFORM} is not
2300 supported.
2301
2302 This option should be used with caution as it overrides the search path
2303 that may have been hard compiled into a shared library. In such a case it
2304 is possible to use unintentionally a different search path than the
2305 runtime linker would do.
2306
2307 The linker uses the following search paths to locate required shared
2308 libraries:
2309
2310 @enumerate
2311 @item
2312 Any directories specified by @option{-rpath-link} options.
2313 @item
2314 Any directories specified by @option{-rpath} options. The difference
2315 between @option{-rpath} and @option{-rpath-link} is that directories
2316 specified by @option{-rpath} options are included in the executable and
2317 used at runtime, whereas the @option{-rpath-link} option is only effective
2318 at link time. Searching @option{-rpath} in this way is only supported
2319 by native linkers and cross linkers which have been configured with
2320 the @option{--with-sysroot} option.
2321 @item
2322 On an ELF system, for native linkers, if the @option{-rpath} and
2323 @option{-rpath-link} options were not used, search the contents of the
2324 environment variable @code{LD_RUN_PATH}.
2325 @item
2326 On SunOS, if the @option{-rpath} option was not used, search any
2327 directories specified using @option{-L} options.
2328 @item
2329 For a native linker, search the contents of the environment
2330 variable @code{LD_LIBRARY_PATH}.
2331 @item
2332 For a native ELF linker, the directories in @code{DT_RUNPATH} or
2333 @code{DT_RPATH} of a shared library are searched for shared
2334 libraries needed by it. The @code{DT_RPATH} entries are ignored if
2335 @code{DT_RUNPATH} entries exist.
2336 @item
2337 For a linker for a Linux system, if the file @file{/etc/ld.so.conf}
2338 exists, the list of directories found in that file. Note: the path
2339 to this file is prefixed with the @code{sysroot} value, if that is
2340 defined, and then any @code{prefix} string if the linker was
2341 configured with the @command{--prefix=<path>} option.
2342 @item
2343 For a native linker on a FreeBSD system, any directories specified by
2344 the @code{_PATH_ELF_HINTS} macro defined in the @file{elf-hints.h}
2345 header file.
2346 @item
2347 Any directories specified by a @code{SEARCH_DIR} command in a
2348 linker script given on the command line, including scripts specified
2349 by @option{-T} (but not @option{-dT}).
2350 @item
2351 The default directories, normally @file{/lib} and @file{/usr/lib}.
2352 @item
2353 Any directories specified by a plugin LDPT_SET_EXTRA_LIBRARY_PATH.
2354 @item
2355 Any directories specified by a @code{SEARCH_DIR} command in a default
2356 linker script.
2357 @end enumerate
2358
2359 Note however on Linux based systems there is an additional caveat: If
2360 the @option{--as-needed} option is active @emph{and} a shared library
2361 is located which would normally satisfy the search @emph{and} this
2362 library does not have DT_NEEDED tag for @file{libc.so}
2363 @emph{and} there is a shared library later on in the set of search
2364 directories which also satisfies the search @emph{and}
2365 this second shared library does have a DT_NEEDED tag for
2366 @file{libc.so} @emph{then} the second library will be selected instead
2367 of the first.
2368
2369 If the required shared library is not found, the linker will issue a
2370 warning and continue with the link.
2371
2372 @end ifset
2373
2374 @kindex -shared
2375 @kindex -Bshareable
2376 @item -shared
2377 @itemx -Bshareable
2378 @cindex shared libraries
2379 Create a shared library. This is currently only supported on ELF, XCOFF
2380 and SunOS platforms. On SunOS, the linker will automatically create a
2381 shared library if the @option{-e} option is not used and there are
2382 undefined symbols in the link.
2383
2384 @kindex --sort-common
2385 @item --sort-common
2386 @itemx --sort-common=ascending
2387 @itemx --sort-common=descending
2388 This option tells @command{ld} to sort the common symbols by alignment in
2389 ascending or descending order when it places them in the appropriate output
2390 sections. The symbol alignments considered are sixteen-byte or larger,
2391 eight-byte, four-byte, two-byte, and one-byte. This is to prevent gaps
2392 between symbols due to alignment constraints. If no sorting order is
2393 specified, then descending order is assumed.
2394
2395 @kindex --sort-section=name
2396 @item --sort-section=name
2397 This option will apply @code{SORT_BY_NAME} to all wildcard section
2398 patterns in the linker script.
2399
2400 @kindex --sort-section=alignment
2401 @item --sort-section=alignment
2402 This option will apply @code{SORT_BY_ALIGNMENT} to all wildcard section
2403 patterns in the linker script.
2404
2405 @kindex --spare-dynamic-tags
2406 @item --spare-dynamic-tags=@var{count}
2407 This option specifies the number of empty slots to leave in the
2408 .dynamic section of ELF shared objects. Empty slots may be needed by
2409 post processing tools, such as the prelinker. The default is 5.
2410
2411 @kindex --split-by-file
2412 @item --split-by-file[=@var{size}]
2413 Similar to @option{--split-by-reloc} but creates a new output section for
2414 each input file when @var{size} is reached. @var{size} defaults to a
2415 size of 1 if not given.
2416
2417 @kindex --split-by-reloc
2418 @item --split-by-reloc[=@var{count}]
2419 Tries to creates extra sections in the output file so that no single
2420 output section in the file contains more than @var{count} relocations.
2421 This is useful when generating huge relocatable files for downloading into
2422 certain real time kernels with the COFF object file format; since COFF
2423 cannot represent more than 65535 relocations in a single section. Note
2424 that this will fail to work with object file formats which do not
2425 support arbitrary sections. The linker will not split up individual
2426 input sections for redistribution, so if a single input section contains
2427 more than @var{count} relocations one output section will contain that
2428 many relocations. @var{count} defaults to a value of 32768.
2429
2430 @kindex --stats
2431 @item --stats
2432 Compute and display statistics about the operation of the linker, such
2433 as execution time and memory usage.
2434
2435 @kindex --sysroot=@var{directory}
2436 @item --sysroot=@var{directory}
2437 Use @var{directory} as the location of the sysroot, overriding the
2438 configure-time default. This option is only supported by linkers
2439 that were configured using @option{--with-sysroot}.
2440
2441 @kindex --task-link
2442 @item --task-link
2443 This is used by COFF/PE based targets to create a task-linked object
2444 file where all of the global symbols have been converted to statics.
2445
2446 @kindex --traditional-format
2447 @cindex traditional format
2448 @item --traditional-format
2449 For some targets, the output of @command{ld} is different in some ways from
2450 the output of some existing linker. This switch requests @command{ld} to
2451 use the traditional format instead.
2452
2453 @cindex dbx
2454 For example, on SunOS, @command{ld} combines duplicate entries in the
2455 symbol string table. This can reduce the size of an output file with
2456 full debugging information by over 30 percent. Unfortunately, the SunOS
2457 @code{dbx} program can not read the resulting program (@code{gdb} has no
2458 trouble). The @samp{--traditional-format} switch tells @command{ld} to not
2459 combine duplicate entries.
2460
2461 @kindex --section-start=@var{sectionname}=@var{org}
2462 @item --section-start=@var{sectionname}=@var{org}
2463 Locate a section in the output file at the absolute
2464 address given by @var{org}. You may use this option as many
2465 times as necessary to locate multiple sections in the command
2466 line.
2467 @var{org} must be a single hexadecimal integer;
2468 for compatibility with other linkers, you may omit the leading
2469 @samp{0x} usually associated with hexadecimal values. @emph{Note:} there
2470 should be no white space between @var{sectionname}, the equals
2471 sign (``@key{=}''), and @var{org}.
2472
2473 @kindex -Tbss=@var{org}
2474 @kindex -Tdata=@var{org}
2475 @kindex -Ttext=@var{org}
2476 @cindex segment origins, cmd line
2477 @item -Tbss=@var{org}
2478 @itemx -Tdata=@var{org}
2479 @itemx -Ttext=@var{org}
2480 Same as @option{--section-start}, with @code{.bss}, @code{.data} or
2481 @code{.text} as the @var{sectionname}.
2482
2483 @kindex -Ttext-segment=@var{org}
2484 @item -Ttext-segment=@var{org}
2485 @cindex text segment origin, cmd line
2486 When creating an ELF executable, it will set the address of the first
2487 byte of the text segment.
2488
2489 @kindex -Trodata-segment=@var{org}
2490 @item -Trodata-segment=@var{org}
2491 @cindex rodata segment origin, cmd line
2492 When creating an ELF executable or shared object for a target where
2493 the read-only data is in its own segment separate from the executable
2494 text, it will set the address of the first byte of the read-only data segment.
2495
2496 @kindex -Tldata-segment=@var{org}
2497 @item -Tldata-segment=@var{org}
2498 @cindex ldata segment origin, cmd line
2499 When creating an ELF executable or shared object for x86-64 medium memory
2500 model, it will set the address of the first byte of the ldata segment.
2501
2502 @kindex --unresolved-symbols
2503 @item --unresolved-symbols=@var{method}
2504 Determine how to handle unresolved symbols. There are four possible
2505 values for @samp{method}:
2506
2507 @table @samp
2508 @item ignore-all
2509 Do not report any unresolved symbols.
2510
2511 @item report-all
2512 Report all unresolved symbols. This is the default.
2513
2514 @item ignore-in-object-files
2515 Report unresolved symbols that are contained in shared libraries, but
2516 ignore them if they come from regular object files.
2517
2518 @item ignore-in-shared-libs
2519 Report unresolved symbols that come from regular object files, but
2520 ignore them if they come from shared libraries. This can be useful
2521 when creating a dynamic binary and it is known that all the shared
2522 libraries that it should be referencing are included on the linker's
2523 command line.
2524 @end table
2525
2526 The behaviour for shared libraries on their own can also be controlled
2527 by the @option{--[no-]allow-shlib-undefined} option.
2528
2529 Normally the linker will generate an error message for each reported
2530 unresolved symbol but the option @option{--warn-unresolved-symbols}
2531 can change this to a warning.
2532
2533 @kindex --verbose[=@var{NUMBER}]
2534 @cindex verbose[=@var{NUMBER}]
2535 @item --dll-verbose
2536 @itemx --verbose[=@var{NUMBER}]
2537 Display the version number for @command{ld} and list the linker emulations
2538 supported. Display which input files can and cannot be opened. Display
2539 the linker script being used by the linker. If the optional @var{NUMBER}
2540 argument > 1, plugin symbol status will also be displayed.
2541
2542 @kindex --version-script=@var{version-scriptfile}
2543 @cindex version script, symbol versions
2544 @item --version-script=@var{version-scriptfile}
2545 Specify the name of a version script to the linker. This is typically
2546 used when creating shared libraries to specify additional information
2547 about the version hierarchy for the library being created. This option
2548 is only fully supported on ELF platforms which support shared libraries;
2549 see @ref{VERSION}. It is partially supported on PE platforms, which can
2550 use version scripts to filter symbol visibility in auto-export mode: any
2551 symbols marked @samp{local} in the version script will not be exported.
2552 @xref{WIN32}.
2553
2554 @kindex --warn-common
2555 @cindex warnings, on combining symbols
2556 @cindex combining symbols, warnings on
2557 @item --warn-common
2558 Warn when a common symbol is combined with another common symbol or with
2559 a symbol definition. Unix linkers allow this somewhat sloppy practice,
2560 but linkers on some other operating systems do not. This option allows
2561 you to find potential problems from combining global symbols.
2562 Unfortunately, some C libraries use this practice, so you may get some
2563 warnings about symbols in the libraries as well as in your programs.
2564
2565 There are three kinds of global symbols, illustrated here by C examples:
2566
2567 @table @samp
2568 @item int i = 1;
2569 A definition, which goes in the initialized data section of the output
2570 file.
2571
2572 @item extern int i;
2573 An undefined reference, which does not allocate space.
2574 There must be either a definition or a common symbol for the
2575 variable somewhere.
2576
2577 @item int i;
2578 A common symbol. If there are only (one or more) common symbols for a
2579 variable, it goes in the uninitialized data area of the output file.
2580 The linker merges multiple common symbols for the same variable into a
2581 single symbol. If they are of different sizes, it picks the largest
2582 size. The linker turns a common symbol into a declaration, if there is
2583 a definition of the same variable.
2584 @end table
2585
2586 The @samp{--warn-common} option can produce five kinds of warnings.
2587 Each warning consists of a pair of lines: the first describes the symbol
2588 just encountered, and the second describes the previous symbol
2589 encountered with the same name. One or both of the two symbols will be
2590 a common symbol.
2591
2592 @enumerate
2593 @item
2594 Turning a common symbol into a reference, because there is already a
2595 definition for the symbol.
2596 @smallexample
2597 @var{file}(@var{section}): warning: common of `@var{symbol}'
2598 overridden by definition
2599 @var{file}(@var{section}): warning: defined here
2600 @end smallexample
2601
2602 @item
2603 Turning a common symbol into a reference, because a later definition for
2604 the symbol is encountered. This is the same as the previous case,
2605 except that the symbols are encountered in a different order.
2606 @smallexample
2607 @var{file}(@var{section}): warning: definition of `@var{symbol}'
2608 overriding common
2609 @var{file}(@var{section}): warning: common is here
2610 @end smallexample
2611
2612 @item
2613 Merging a common symbol with a previous same-sized common symbol.
2614 @smallexample
2615 @var{file}(@var{section}): warning: multiple common
2616 of `@var{symbol}'
2617 @var{file}(@var{section}): warning: previous common is here
2618 @end smallexample
2619
2620 @item
2621 Merging a common symbol with a previous larger common symbol.
2622 @smallexample
2623 @var{file}(@var{section}): warning: common of `@var{symbol}'
2624 overridden by larger common
2625 @var{file}(@var{section}): warning: larger common is here
2626 @end smallexample
2627
2628 @item
2629 Merging a common symbol with a previous smaller common symbol. This is
2630 the same as the previous case, except that the symbols are
2631 encountered in a different order.
2632 @smallexample
2633 @var{file}(@var{section}): warning: common of `@var{symbol}'
2634 overriding smaller common
2635 @var{file}(@var{section}): warning: smaller common is here
2636 @end smallexample
2637 @end enumerate
2638
2639 @kindex --warn-constructors
2640 @item --warn-constructors
2641 Warn if any global constructors are used. This is only useful for a few
2642 object file formats. For formats like COFF or ELF, the linker can not
2643 detect the use of global constructors.
2644
2645 @kindex --warn-multiple-gp
2646 @item --warn-multiple-gp
2647 Warn if multiple global pointer values are required in the output file.
2648 This is only meaningful for certain processors, such as the Alpha.
2649 Specifically, some processors put large-valued constants in a special
2650 section. A special register (the global pointer) points into the middle
2651 of this section, so that constants can be loaded efficiently via a
2652 base-register relative addressing mode. Since the offset in
2653 base-register relative mode is fixed and relatively small (e.g., 16
2654 bits), this limits the maximum size of the constant pool. Thus, in
2655 large programs, it is often necessary to use multiple global pointer
2656 values in order to be able to address all possible constants. This
2657 option causes a warning to be issued whenever this case occurs.
2658
2659 @kindex --warn-once
2660 @cindex warnings, on undefined symbols
2661 @cindex undefined symbols, warnings on
2662 @item --warn-once
2663 Only warn once for each undefined symbol, rather than once per module
2664 which refers to it.
2665
2666 @kindex --warn-section-align
2667 @cindex warnings, on section alignment
2668 @cindex section alignment, warnings on
2669 @item --warn-section-align
2670 Warn if the address of an output section is changed because of
2671 alignment. Typically, the alignment will be set by an input section.
2672 The address will only be changed if it not explicitly specified; that
2673 is, if the @code{SECTIONS} command does not specify a start address for
2674 the section (@pxref{SECTIONS}).
2675
2676 @kindex --warn-textrel
2677 @item --warn-textrel
2678 Warn if the linker adds DT_TEXTREL to a position-independent executable
2679 or shared object.
2680
2681 @kindex --warn-alternate-em
2682 @item --warn-alternate-em
2683 Warn if an object has alternate ELF machine code.
2684
2685 @kindex --warn-unresolved-symbols
2686 @item --warn-unresolved-symbols
2687 If the linker is going to report an unresolved symbol (see the option
2688 @option{--unresolved-symbols}) it will normally generate an error.
2689 This option makes it generate a warning instead.
2690
2691 @kindex --error-unresolved-symbols
2692 @item --error-unresolved-symbols
2693 This restores the linker's default behaviour of generating errors when
2694 it is reporting unresolved symbols.
2695
2696 @kindex --whole-archive
2697 @cindex including an entire archive
2698 @item --whole-archive
2699 For each archive mentioned on the command line after the
2700 @option{--whole-archive} option, include every object file in the archive
2701 in the link, rather than searching the archive for the required object
2702 files. This is normally used to turn an archive file into a shared
2703 library, forcing every object to be included in the resulting shared
2704 library. This option may be used more than once.
2705
2706 Two notes when using this option from gcc: First, gcc doesn't know
2707 about this option, so you have to use @option{-Wl,-whole-archive}.
2708 Second, don't forget to use @option{-Wl,-no-whole-archive} after your
2709 list of archives, because gcc will add its own list of archives to
2710 your link and you may not want this flag to affect those as well.
2711
2712 @kindex --wrap=@var{symbol}
2713 @item --wrap=@var{symbol}
2714 Use a wrapper function for @var{symbol}. Any undefined reference to
2715 @var{symbol} will be resolved to @code{__wrap_@var{symbol}}. Any
2716 undefined reference to @code{__real_@var{symbol}} will be resolved to
2717 @var{symbol}.
2718
2719 This can be used to provide a wrapper for a system function. The
2720 wrapper function should be called @code{__wrap_@var{symbol}}. If it
2721 wishes to call the system function, it should call
2722 @code{__real_@var{symbol}}.
2723
2724 Here is a trivial example:
2725
2726 @smallexample
2727 void *
2728 __wrap_malloc (size_t c)
2729 @{
2730 printf ("malloc called with %zu\n", c);
2731 return __real_malloc (c);
2732 @}
2733 @end smallexample
2734
2735 If you link other code with this file using @option{--wrap malloc}, then
2736 all calls to @code{malloc} will call the function @code{__wrap_malloc}
2737 instead. The call to @code{__real_malloc} in @code{__wrap_malloc} will
2738 call the real @code{malloc} function.
2739
2740 You may wish to provide a @code{__real_malloc} function as well, so that
2741 links without the @option{--wrap} option will succeed. If you do this,
2742 you should not put the definition of @code{__real_malloc} in the same
2743 file as @code{__wrap_malloc}; if you do, the assembler may resolve the
2744 call before the linker has a chance to wrap it to @code{malloc}.
2745
2746 Only undefined references are replaced by the linker. So, translation unit
2747 internal references to @var{symbol} are not resolved to
2748 @code{__wrap_@var{symbol}}. In the next example, the call to @code{f} in
2749 @code{g} is not resolved to @code{__wrap_f}.
2750
2751 @smallexample
2752 int
2753 f (void)
2754 @{
2755 return 123;
2756 @}
2757
2758 int
2759 g (void)
2760 @{
2761 return f();
2762 @}
2763 @end smallexample
2764
2765 @kindex --eh-frame-hdr
2766 @kindex --no-eh-frame-hdr
2767 @item --eh-frame-hdr
2768 @itemx --no-eh-frame-hdr
2769 Request (@option{--eh-frame-hdr}) or suppress
2770 (@option{--no-eh-frame-hdr}) the creation of @code{.eh_frame_hdr}
2771 section and ELF @code{PT_GNU_EH_FRAME} segment header.
2772
2773 @kindex --ld-generated-unwind-info
2774 @item --no-ld-generated-unwind-info
2775 Request creation of @code{.eh_frame} unwind info for linker
2776 generated code sections like PLT. This option is on by default
2777 if linker generated unwind info is supported.
2778
2779 @kindex --enable-new-dtags
2780 @kindex --disable-new-dtags
2781 @item --enable-new-dtags
2782 @itemx --disable-new-dtags
2783 This linker can create the new dynamic tags in ELF. But the older ELF
2784 systems may not understand them. If you specify
2785 @option{--enable-new-dtags}, the new dynamic tags will be created as needed
2786 and older dynamic tags will be omitted.
2787 If you specify @option{--disable-new-dtags}, no new dynamic tags will be
2788 created. By default, the new dynamic tags are not created. Note that
2789 those options are only available for ELF systems.
2790
2791 @kindex --hash-size=@var{number}
2792 @item --hash-size=@var{number}
2793 Set the default size of the linker's hash tables to a prime number
2794 close to @var{number}. Increasing this value can reduce the length of
2795 time it takes the linker to perform its tasks, at the expense of
2796 increasing the linker's memory requirements. Similarly reducing this
2797 value can reduce the memory requirements at the expense of speed.
2798
2799 @kindex --hash-style=@var{style}
2800 @item --hash-style=@var{style}
2801 Set the type of linker's hash table(s). @var{style} can be either
2802 @code{sysv} for classic ELF @code{.hash} section, @code{gnu} for
2803 new style GNU @code{.gnu.hash} section or @code{both} for both
2804 the classic ELF @code{.hash} and new style GNU @code{.gnu.hash}
2805 hash tables. The default depends upon how the linker was configured,
2806 but for most Linux based systems it will be @code{both}.
2807
2808 @kindex --compress-debug-sections=none
2809 @kindex --compress-debug-sections=zlib
2810 @kindex --compress-debug-sections=zlib-gnu
2811 @kindex --compress-debug-sections=zlib-gabi
2812 @item --compress-debug-sections=none
2813 @itemx --compress-debug-sections=zlib
2814 @itemx --compress-debug-sections=zlib-gnu
2815 @itemx --compress-debug-sections=zlib-gabi
2816 On ELF platforms, these options control how DWARF debug sections are
2817 compressed using zlib.
2818
2819 @option{--compress-debug-sections=none} doesn't compress DWARF debug
2820 sections. @option{--compress-debug-sections=zlib-gnu} compresses
2821 DWARF debug sections and renames them to begin with @samp{.zdebug}
2822 instead of @samp{.debug}. @option{--compress-debug-sections=zlib-gabi}
2823 also compresses DWARF debug sections, but rather than renaming them it
2824 sets the SHF_COMPRESSED flag in the sections' headers.
2825
2826 The @option{--compress-debug-sections=zlib} option is an alias for
2827 @option{--compress-debug-sections=zlib-gabi}.
2828
2829 Note that this option overrides any compression in input debug
2830 sections, so if a binary is linked with @option{--compress-debug-sections=none}
2831 for example, then any compressed debug sections in input files will be
2832 uncompressed before they are copied into the output binary.
2833
2834 The default compression behaviour varies depending upon the target
2835 involved and the configure options used to build the toolchain. The
2836 default can be determined by examining the output from the linker's
2837 @option{--help} option.
2838
2839 @kindex --reduce-memory-overheads
2840 @item --reduce-memory-overheads
2841 This option reduces memory requirements at ld runtime, at the expense of
2842 linking speed. This was introduced to select the old O(n^2) algorithm
2843 for link map file generation, rather than the new O(n) algorithm which uses
2844 about 40% more memory for symbol storage.
2845
2846 Another effect of the switch is to set the default hash table size to
2847 1021, which again saves memory at the cost of lengthening the linker's
2848 run time. This is not done however if the @option{--hash-size} switch
2849 has been used.
2850
2851 The @option{--reduce-memory-overheads} switch may be also be used to
2852 enable other tradeoffs in future versions of the linker.
2853
2854 @kindex --max-cache-size=@var{size}
2855 @item --max-cache-size=@var{size}
2856 @command{ld} normally caches the relocation information and symbol tables
2857 of input files in memory with the unlimited size. This option sets the
2858 maximum cache size to @var{size}.
2859
2860 @kindex --build-id
2861 @kindex --build-id=@var{style}
2862 @item --build-id
2863 @itemx --build-id=@var{style}
2864 Request the creation of a @code{.note.gnu.build-id} ELF note section
2865 or a @code{.buildid} COFF section. The contents of the note are
2866 unique bits identifying this linked file. @var{style} can be
2867 @code{uuid} to use 128 random bits, @code{sha1} to use a 160-bit
2868 @sc{SHA1} hash on the normative parts of the output contents,
2869 @code{md5} to use a 128-bit @sc{MD5} hash on the normative parts of
2870 the output contents, or @code{0x@var{hexstring}} to use a chosen bit
2871 string specified as an even number of hexadecimal digits (@code{-} and
2872 @code{:} characters between digit pairs are ignored). If @var{style}
2873 is omitted, @code{sha1} is used.
2874
2875 The @code{md5} and @code{sha1} styles produces an identifier
2876 that is always the same in an identical output file, but will be
2877 unique among all nonidentical output files. It is not intended
2878 to be compared as a checksum for the file's contents. A linked
2879 file may be changed later by other tools, but the build ID bit
2880 string identifying the original linked file does not change.
2881
2882 Passing @code{none} for @var{style} disables the setting from any
2883 @code{--build-id} options earlier on the command line.
2884 @end table
2885
2886 @c man end
2887
2888 @subsection Options Specific to i386 PE Targets
2889
2890 @c man begin OPTIONS
2891
2892 The i386 PE linker supports the @option{-shared} option, which causes
2893 the output to be a dynamically linked library (DLL) instead of a
2894 normal executable. You should name the output @code{*.dll} when you
2895 use this option. In addition, the linker fully supports the standard
2896 @code{*.def} files, which may be specified on the linker command line
2897 like an object file (in fact, it should precede archives it exports
2898 symbols from, to ensure that they get linked in, just like a normal
2899 object file).
2900
2901 In addition to the options common to all targets, the i386 PE linker
2902 support additional command-line options that are specific to the i386
2903 PE target. Options that take values may be separated from their
2904 values by either a space or an equals sign.
2905
2906 @table @gcctabopt
2907
2908 @kindex --add-stdcall-alias
2909 @item --add-stdcall-alias
2910 If given, symbols with a stdcall suffix (@@@var{nn}) will be exported
2911 as-is and also with the suffix stripped.
2912 [This option is specific to the i386 PE targeted port of the linker]
2913
2914 @kindex --base-file
2915 @item --base-file @var{file}
2916 Use @var{file} as the name of a file in which to save the base
2917 addresses of all the relocations needed for generating DLLs with
2918 @file{dlltool}.
2919 [This is an i386 PE specific option]
2920
2921 @kindex --dll
2922 @item --dll
2923 Create a DLL instead of a regular executable. You may also use
2924 @option{-shared} or specify a @code{LIBRARY} in a given @code{.def}
2925 file.
2926 [This option is specific to the i386 PE targeted port of the linker]
2927
2928 @kindex --enable-long-section-names
2929 @kindex --disable-long-section-names
2930 @item --enable-long-section-names
2931 @itemx --disable-long-section-names
2932 The PE variants of the COFF object format add an extension that permits
2933 the use of section names longer than eight characters, the normal limit
2934 for COFF. By default, these names are only allowed in object files, as
2935 fully-linked executable images do not carry the COFF string table required
2936 to support the longer names. As a GNU extension, it is possible to
2937 allow their use in executable images as well, or to (probably pointlessly!)
2938 disallow it in object files, by using these two options. Executable images
2939 generated with these long section names are slightly non-standard, carrying
2940 as they do a string table, and may generate confusing output when examined
2941 with non-GNU PE-aware tools, such as file viewers and dumpers. However,
2942 GDB relies on the use of PE long section names to find Dwarf-2 debug
2943 information sections in an executable image at runtime, and so if neither
2944 option is specified on the command-line, @command{ld} will enable long
2945 section names, overriding the default and technically correct behaviour,
2946 when it finds the presence of debug information while linking an executable
2947 image and not stripping symbols.
2948 [This option is valid for all PE targeted ports of the linker]
2949
2950 @kindex --enable-stdcall-fixup
2951 @kindex --disable-stdcall-fixup
2952 @item --enable-stdcall-fixup
2953 @itemx --disable-stdcall-fixup
2954 If the link finds a symbol that it cannot resolve, it will attempt to
2955 do ``fuzzy linking'' by looking for another defined symbol that differs
2956 only in the format of the symbol name (cdecl vs stdcall) and will
2957 resolve that symbol by linking to the match. For example, the
2958 undefined symbol @code{_foo} might be linked to the function
2959 @code{_foo@@12}, or the undefined symbol @code{_bar@@16} might be linked
2960 to the function @code{_bar}. When the linker does this, it prints a
2961 warning, since it normally should have failed to link, but sometimes
2962 import libraries generated from third-party dlls may need this feature
2963 to be usable. If you specify @option{--enable-stdcall-fixup}, this
2964 feature is fully enabled and warnings are not printed. If you specify
2965 @option{--disable-stdcall-fixup}, this feature is disabled and such
2966 mismatches are considered to be errors.
2967 [This option is specific to the i386 PE targeted port of the linker]
2968
2969 @kindex --leading-underscore
2970 @kindex --no-leading-underscore
2971 @item --leading-underscore
2972 @itemx --no-leading-underscore
2973 For most targets default symbol-prefix is an underscore and is defined
2974 in target's description. By this option it is possible to
2975 disable/enable the default underscore symbol-prefix.
2976
2977 @cindex DLLs, creating
2978 @kindex --export-all-symbols
2979 @item --export-all-symbols
2980 If given, all global symbols in the objects used to build a DLL will
2981 be exported by the DLL. Note that this is the default if there
2982 otherwise wouldn't be any exported symbols. When symbols are
2983 explicitly exported via DEF files or implicitly exported via function
2984 attributes, the default is to not export anything else unless this
2985 option is given. Note that the symbols @code{DllMain@@12},
2986 @code{DllEntryPoint@@0}, @code{DllMainCRTStartup@@12}, and
2987 @code{impure_ptr} will not be automatically
2988 exported. Also, symbols imported from other DLLs will not be
2989 re-exported, nor will symbols specifying the DLL's internal layout
2990 such as those beginning with @code{_head_} or ending with
2991 @code{_iname}. In addition, no symbols from @code{libgcc},
2992 @code{libstd++}, @code{libmingw32}, or @code{crtX.o} will be exported.
2993 Symbols whose names begin with @code{__rtti_} or @code{__builtin_} will
2994 not be exported, to help with C++ DLLs. Finally, there is an
2995 extensive list of cygwin-private symbols that are not exported
2996 (obviously, this applies on when building DLLs for cygwin targets).
2997 These cygwin-excludes are: @code{_cygwin_dll_entry@@12},
2998 @code{_cygwin_crt0_common@@8}, @code{_cygwin_noncygwin_dll_entry@@12},
2999 @code{_fmode}, @code{_impure_ptr}, @code{cygwin_attach_dll},
3000 @code{cygwin_premain0}, @code{cygwin_premain1}, @code{cygwin_premain2},
3001 @code{cygwin_premain3}, and @code{environ}.
3002 [This option is specific to the i386 PE targeted port of the linker]
3003
3004 @kindex --exclude-symbols
3005 @item --exclude-symbols @var{symbol},@var{symbol},...
3006 Specifies a list of symbols which should not be automatically
3007 exported. The symbol names may be delimited by commas or colons.
3008 [This option is specific to the i386 PE targeted port of the linker]
3009
3010 @kindex --exclude-all-symbols
3011 @item --exclude-all-symbols
3012 Specifies no symbols should be automatically exported.
3013 [This option is specific to the i386 PE targeted port of the linker]
3014
3015 @kindex --file-alignment
3016 @item --file-alignment
3017 Specify the file alignment. Sections in the file will always begin at
3018 file offsets which are multiples of this number. This defaults to
3019 512.
3020 [This option is specific to the i386 PE targeted port of the linker]
3021
3022 @cindex heap size
3023 @kindex --heap
3024 @item --heap @var{reserve}
3025 @itemx --heap @var{reserve},@var{commit}
3026 Specify the number of bytes of memory to reserve (and optionally commit)
3027 to be used as heap for this program. The default is 1MB reserved, 4K
3028 committed.
3029 [This option is specific to the i386 PE targeted port of the linker]
3030
3031 @cindex image base
3032 @kindex --image-base
3033 @item --image-base @var{value}
3034 Use @var{value} as the base address of your program or dll. This is
3035 the lowest memory location that will be used when your program or dll
3036 is loaded. To reduce the need to relocate and improve performance of
3037 your dlls, each should have a unique base address and not overlap any
3038 other dlls. The default is 0x400000 for executables, and 0x10000000
3039 for dlls.
3040 [This option is specific to the i386 PE targeted port of the linker]
3041
3042 @kindex --kill-at
3043 @item --kill-at
3044 If given, the stdcall suffixes (@@@var{nn}) will be stripped from
3045 symbols before they are exported.
3046 [This option is specific to the i386 PE targeted port of the linker]
3047
3048 @kindex --large-address-aware
3049 @item --large-address-aware
3050 If given, the appropriate bit in the ``Characteristics'' field of the COFF
3051 header is set to indicate that this executable supports virtual addresses
3052 greater than 2 gigabytes. This should be used in conjunction with the /3GB
3053 or /USERVA=@var{value} megabytes switch in the ``[operating systems]''
3054 section of the BOOT.INI. Otherwise, this bit has no effect.
3055 [This option is specific to PE targeted ports of the linker]
3056
3057 @kindex --disable-large-address-aware
3058 @item --disable-large-address-aware
3059 Reverts the effect of a previous @samp{--large-address-aware} option.
3060 This is useful if @samp{--large-address-aware} is always set by the compiler
3061 driver (e.g. Cygwin gcc) and the executable does not support virtual
3062 addresses greater than 2 gigabytes.
3063 [This option is specific to PE targeted ports of the linker]
3064
3065 @kindex --major-image-version
3066 @item --major-image-version @var{value}
3067 Sets the major number of the ``image version''. Defaults to 1.
3068 [This option is specific to the i386 PE targeted port of the linker]
3069
3070 @kindex --major-os-version
3071 @item --major-os-version @var{value}
3072 Sets the major number of the ``os version''. Defaults to 4.
3073 [This option is specific to the i386 PE targeted port of the linker]
3074
3075 @kindex --major-subsystem-version
3076 @item --major-subsystem-version @var{value}
3077 Sets the major number of the ``subsystem version''. Defaults to 4.
3078 [This option is specific to the i386 PE targeted port of the linker]
3079
3080 @kindex --minor-image-version
3081 @item --minor-image-version @var{value}
3082 Sets the minor number of the ``image version''. Defaults to 0.
3083 [This option is specific to the i386 PE targeted port of the linker]
3084
3085 @kindex --minor-os-version
3086 @item --minor-os-version @var{value}
3087 Sets the minor number of the ``os version''. Defaults to 0.
3088 [This option is specific to the i386 PE targeted port of the linker]
3089
3090 @kindex --minor-subsystem-version
3091 @item --minor-subsystem-version @var{value}
3092 Sets the minor number of the ``subsystem version''. Defaults to 0.
3093 [This option is specific to the i386 PE targeted port of the linker]
3094
3095 @cindex DEF files, creating
3096 @cindex DLLs, creating
3097 @kindex --output-def
3098 @item --output-def @var{file}
3099 The linker will create the file @var{file} which will contain a DEF
3100 file corresponding to the DLL the linker is generating. This DEF file
3101 (which should be called @code{*.def}) may be used to create an import
3102 library with @code{dlltool} or may be used as a reference to
3103 automatically or implicitly exported symbols.
3104 [This option is specific to the i386 PE targeted port of the linker]
3105
3106 @cindex DLLs, creating
3107 @kindex --enable-auto-image-base
3108 @item --enable-auto-image-base
3109 @itemx --enable-auto-image-base=@var{value}
3110 Automatically choose the image base for DLLs, optionally starting with base
3111 @var{value}, unless one is specified using the @code{--image-base} argument.
3112 By using a hash generated from the dllname to create unique image bases
3113 for each DLL, in-memory collisions and relocations which can delay program
3114 execution are avoided.
3115 [This option is specific to the i386 PE targeted port of the linker]
3116
3117 @kindex --disable-auto-image-base
3118 @item --disable-auto-image-base
3119 Do not automatically generate a unique image base. If there is no
3120 user-specified image base (@code{--image-base}) then use the platform
3121 default.
3122 [This option is specific to the i386 PE targeted port of the linker]
3123
3124 @cindex DLLs, linking to
3125 @kindex --dll-search-prefix
3126 @item --dll-search-prefix @var{string}
3127 When linking dynamically to a dll without an import library,
3128 search for @code{<string><basename>.dll} in preference to
3129 @code{lib<basename>.dll}. This behaviour allows easy distinction
3130 between DLLs built for the various "subplatforms": native, cygwin,
3131 uwin, pw, etc. For instance, cygwin DLLs typically use
3132 @code{--dll-search-prefix=cyg}.
3133 [This option is specific to the i386 PE targeted port of the linker]
3134
3135 @kindex --enable-auto-import
3136 @item --enable-auto-import
3137 Do sophisticated linking of @code{_symbol} to @code{__imp__symbol} for
3138 DATA imports from DLLs, thus making it possible to bypass the dllimport
3139 mechanism on the user side and to reference unmangled symbol names.
3140 [This option is specific to the i386 PE targeted port of the linker]
3141
3142 The following remarks pertain to the original implementation of the
3143 feature and are obsolete nowadays for Cygwin and MinGW targets.
3144
3145 Note: Use of the 'auto-import' extension will cause the text section
3146 of the image file to be made writable. This does not conform to the
3147 PE-COFF format specification published by Microsoft.
3148
3149 Note - use of the 'auto-import' extension will also cause read only
3150 data which would normally be placed into the .rdata section to be
3151 placed into the .data section instead. This is in order to work
3152 around a problem with consts that is described here:
3153 http://www.cygwin.com/ml/cygwin/2004-09/msg01101.html
3154
3155 Using 'auto-import' generally will 'just work' -- but sometimes you may
3156 see this message:
3157
3158 "variable '<var>' can't be auto-imported. Please read the
3159 documentation for ld's @code{--enable-auto-import} for details."
3160
3161 This message occurs when some (sub)expression accesses an address
3162 ultimately given by the sum of two constants (Win32 import tables only
3163 allow one). Instances where this may occur include accesses to member
3164 fields of struct variables imported from a DLL, as well as using a
3165 constant index into an array variable imported from a DLL. Any
3166 multiword variable (arrays, structs, long long, etc) may trigger
3167 this error condition. However, regardless of the exact data type
3168 of the offending exported variable, ld will always detect it, issue
3169 the warning, and exit.
3170
3171 There are several ways to address this difficulty, regardless of the
3172 data type of the exported variable:
3173
3174 One way is to use --enable-runtime-pseudo-reloc switch. This leaves the task
3175 of adjusting references in your client code for runtime environment, so
3176 this method works only when runtime environment supports this feature.
3177
3178 A second solution is to force one of the 'constants' to be a variable --
3179 that is, unknown and un-optimizable at compile time. For arrays,
3180 there are two possibilities: a) make the indexee (the array's address)
3181 a variable, or b) make the 'constant' index a variable. Thus:
3182
3183 @example
3184 extern type extern_array[];
3185 extern_array[1] -->
3186 @{ volatile type *t=extern_array; t[1] @}
3187 @end example
3188
3189 or
3190
3191 @example
3192 extern type extern_array[];
3193 extern_array[1] -->
3194 @{ volatile int t=1; extern_array[t] @}
3195 @end example
3196
3197 For structs (and most other multiword data types) the only option
3198 is to make the struct itself (or the long long, or the ...) variable:
3199
3200 @example
3201 extern struct s extern_struct;
3202 extern_struct.field -->
3203 @{ volatile struct s *t=&extern_struct; t->field @}
3204 @end example
3205
3206 or
3207
3208 @example
3209 extern long long extern_ll;
3210 extern_ll -->
3211 @{ volatile long long * local_ll=&extern_ll; *local_ll @}
3212 @end example
3213
3214 A third method of dealing with this difficulty is to abandon
3215 'auto-import' for the offending symbol and mark it with
3216 @code{__declspec(dllimport)}. However, in practice that
3217 requires using compile-time #defines to indicate whether you are
3218 building a DLL, building client code that will link to the DLL, or
3219 merely building/linking to a static library. In making the choice
3220 between the various methods of resolving the 'direct address with
3221 constant offset' problem, you should consider typical real-world usage:
3222
3223 Original:
3224 @example
3225 --foo.h
3226 extern int arr[];
3227 --foo.c
3228 #include "foo.h"
3229 void main(int argc, char **argv)@{
3230 printf("%d\n",arr[1]);
3231 @}
3232 @end example
3233
3234 Solution 1:
3235 @example
3236 --foo.h
3237 extern int arr[];
3238 --foo.c
3239 #include "foo.h"
3240 void main(int argc, char **argv)@{
3241 /* This workaround is for win32 and cygwin; do not "optimize" */
3242 volatile int *parr = arr;
3243 printf("%d\n",parr[1]);
3244 @}
3245 @end example
3246
3247 Solution 2:
3248 @example
3249 --foo.h
3250 /* Note: auto-export is assumed (no __declspec(dllexport)) */
3251 #if (defined(_WIN32) || defined(__CYGWIN__)) && \
3252 !(defined(FOO_BUILD_DLL) || defined(FOO_STATIC))
3253 #define FOO_IMPORT __declspec(dllimport)
3254 #else
3255 #define FOO_IMPORT
3256 #endif
3257 extern FOO_IMPORT int arr[];
3258 --foo.c
3259 #include "foo.h"
3260 void main(int argc, char **argv)@{
3261 printf("%d\n",arr[1]);
3262 @}
3263 @end example
3264
3265 A fourth way to avoid this problem is to re-code your
3266 library to use a functional interface rather than a data interface
3267 for the offending variables (e.g. set_foo() and get_foo() accessor
3268 functions).
3269
3270 @kindex --disable-auto-import
3271 @item --disable-auto-import
3272 Do not attempt to do sophisticated linking of @code{_symbol} to
3273 @code{__imp__symbol} for DATA imports from DLLs.
3274 [This option is specific to the i386 PE targeted port of the linker]
3275
3276 @kindex --enable-runtime-pseudo-reloc
3277 @item --enable-runtime-pseudo-reloc
3278 If your code contains expressions described in --enable-auto-import section,
3279 that is, DATA imports from DLL with non-zero offset, this switch will create
3280 a vector of 'runtime pseudo relocations' which can be used by runtime
3281 environment to adjust references to such data in your client code.
3282 [This option is specific to the i386 PE targeted port of the linker]
3283
3284 @kindex --disable-runtime-pseudo-reloc
3285 @item --disable-runtime-pseudo-reloc
3286 Do not create pseudo relocations for non-zero offset DATA imports from DLLs.
3287 [This option is specific to the i386 PE targeted port of the linker]
3288
3289 @kindex --enable-extra-pe-debug
3290 @item --enable-extra-pe-debug
3291 Show additional debug info related to auto-import symbol thunking.
3292 [This option is specific to the i386 PE targeted port of the linker]
3293
3294 @kindex --section-alignment
3295 @item --section-alignment
3296 Sets the section alignment. Sections in memory will always begin at
3297 addresses which are a multiple of this number. Defaults to 0x1000.
3298 [This option is specific to the i386 PE targeted port of the linker]
3299
3300 @cindex stack size
3301 @kindex --stack
3302 @item --stack @var{reserve}
3303 @itemx --stack @var{reserve},@var{commit}
3304 Specify the number of bytes of memory to reserve (and optionally commit)
3305 to be used as stack for this program. The default is 2MB reserved, 4K
3306 committed.
3307 [This option is specific to the i386 PE targeted port of the linker]
3308
3309 @kindex --subsystem
3310 @item --subsystem @var{which}
3311 @itemx --subsystem @var{which}:@var{major}
3312 @itemx --subsystem @var{which}:@var{major}.@var{minor}
3313 Specifies the subsystem under which your program will execute. The
3314 legal values for @var{which} are @code{native}, @code{windows},
3315 @code{console}, @code{posix}, and @code{xbox}. You may optionally set
3316 the subsystem version also. Numeric values are also accepted for
3317 @var{which}.
3318 [This option is specific to the i386 PE targeted port of the linker]
3319
3320 The following options set flags in the @code{DllCharacteristics} field
3321 of the PE file header:
3322 [These options are specific to PE targeted ports of the linker]
3323
3324 @kindex --high-entropy-va
3325 @item --high-entropy-va
3326 @itemx --disable-high-entropy-va
3327 Image is compatible with 64-bit address space layout randomization
3328 (ASLR). This option is enabled by default for 64-bit PE images.
3329
3330 This option also implies @option{--dynamicbase} and
3331 @option{--enable-reloc-section}.
3332
3333 @kindex --dynamicbase
3334 @item --dynamicbase
3335 @itemx --disable-dynamicbase
3336 The image base address may be relocated using address space layout
3337 randomization (ASLR). This feature was introduced with MS Windows
3338 Vista for i386 PE targets. This option is enabled by default but
3339 can be disabled via the @option{--disable-dynamicbase} option.
3340 This option also implies @option{--enable-reloc-section}.
3341
3342 @kindex --forceinteg
3343 @item --forceinteg
3344 @itemx --disable-forceinteg
3345 Code integrity checks are enforced. This option is disabled by
3346 default.
3347
3348 @kindex --nxcompat
3349 @item --nxcompat
3350 @item --disable-nxcompat
3351 The image is compatible with the Data Execution Prevention.
3352 This feature was introduced with MS Windows XP SP2 for i386 PE
3353 targets. The option is enabled by default.
3354
3355 @kindex --no-isolation
3356 @item --no-isolation
3357 @itemx --disable-no-isolation
3358 Although the image understands isolation, do not isolate the image.
3359 This option is disabled by default.
3360
3361 @kindex --no-seh
3362 @item --no-seh
3363 @itemx --disable-no-seh
3364 The image does not use SEH. No SE handler may be called from
3365 this image. This option is disabled by default.
3366
3367 @kindex --no-bind
3368 @item --no-bind
3369 @itemx --disable-no-bind
3370 Do not bind this image. This option is disabled by default.
3371
3372 @kindex --wdmdriver
3373 @item --wdmdriver
3374 @itemx --disable-wdmdriver
3375 The driver uses the MS Windows Driver Model. This option is disabled
3376 by default.
3377
3378 @kindex --tsaware
3379 @item --tsaware
3380 @itemx --disable-tsaware
3381 The image is Terminal Server aware. This option is disabled by
3382 default.
3383
3384 @kindex --insert-timestamp
3385 @item --insert-timestamp
3386 @itemx --no-insert-timestamp
3387 Insert a real timestamp into the image. This is the default behaviour
3388 as it matches legacy code and it means that the image will work with
3389 other, proprietary tools. The problem with this default is that it
3390 will result in slightly different images being produced each time the
3391 same sources are linked. The option @option{--no-insert-timestamp}
3392 can be used to insert a zero value for the timestamp, this ensuring
3393 that binaries produced from identical sources will compare
3394 identically.
3395
3396 @kindex --enable-reloc-section
3397 @item --enable-reloc-section
3398 @itemx --disable-reloc-section
3399 Create the base relocation table, which is necessary if the image
3400 is loaded at a different image base than specified in the PE header.
3401 This option is enabled by default.
3402 @end table
3403
3404 @c man end
3405
3406 @ifset C6X
3407 @subsection Options specific to C6X uClinux targets
3408
3409 @c man begin OPTIONS
3410
3411 The C6X uClinux target uses a binary format called DSBT to support shared
3412 libraries. Each shared library in the system needs to have a unique index;
3413 all executables use an index of 0.
3414
3415 @table @gcctabopt
3416
3417 @kindex --dsbt-size
3418 @item --dsbt-size @var{size}
3419 This option sets the number of entries in the DSBT of the current executable
3420 or shared library to @var{size}. The default is to create a table with 64
3421 entries.
3422
3423 @kindex --dsbt-index
3424 @item --dsbt-index @var{index}
3425 This option sets the DSBT index of the current executable or shared library
3426 to @var{index}. The default is 0, which is appropriate for generating
3427 executables. If a shared library is generated with a DSBT index of 0, the
3428 @code{R_C6000_DSBT_INDEX} relocs are copied into the output file.
3429
3430 @kindex --no-merge-exidx-entries
3431 The @samp{--no-merge-exidx-entries} switch disables the merging of adjacent
3432 exidx entries in frame unwind info.
3433
3434 @end table
3435
3436 @c man end
3437 @end ifset
3438
3439 @ifset CSKY
3440 @subsection Options specific to C-SKY targets
3441
3442 @c man begin OPTIONS
3443
3444 @table @gcctabopt
3445
3446 @kindex --branch-stub on C-SKY
3447 @item --branch-stub
3448 This option enables linker branch relaxation by inserting branch stub
3449 sections when needed to extend the range of branches. This option is
3450 usually not required since C-SKY supports branch and call instructions that
3451 can access the full memory range and branch relaxation is normally handled by
3452 the compiler or assembler.
3453
3454 @kindex --stub-group-size on C-SKY
3455 @item --stub-group-size=@var{N}
3456 This option allows finer control of linker branch stub creation.
3457 It sets the maximum size of a group of input sections that can
3458 be handled by one stub section. A negative value of @var{N} locates
3459 stub sections after their branches, while a positive value allows stub
3460 sections to appear either before or after the branches. Values of
3461 @samp{1} or @samp{-1} indicate that the
3462 linker should choose suitable defaults.
3463
3464 @end table
3465
3466 @c man end
3467 @end ifset
3468
3469 @ifset M68HC11
3470 @subsection Options specific to Motorola 68HC11 and 68HC12 targets
3471
3472 @c man begin OPTIONS
3473
3474 The 68HC11 and 68HC12 linkers support specific options to control the
3475 memory bank switching mapping and trampoline code generation.
3476
3477 @table @gcctabopt
3478
3479 @kindex --no-trampoline
3480 @item --no-trampoline
3481 This option disables the generation of trampoline. By default a trampoline
3482 is generated for each far function which is called using a @code{jsr}
3483 instruction (this happens when a pointer to a far function is taken).
3484
3485 @kindex --bank-window
3486 @item --bank-window @var{name}
3487 This option indicates to the linker the name of the memory region in
3488 the @samp{MEMORY} specification that describes the memory bank window.
3489 The definition of such region is then used by the linker to compute
3490 paging and addresses within the memory window.
3491
3492 @end table
3493
3494 @c man end
3495 @end ifset
3496
3497 @ifset M68K
3498 @subsection Options specific to Motorola 68K target
3499
3500 @c man begin OPTIONS
3501
3502 The following options are supported to control handling of GOT generation
3503 when linking for 68K targets.
3504
3505 @table @gcctabopt
3506
3507 @kindex --got
3508 @item --got=@var{type}
3509 This option tells the linker which GOT generation scheme to use.
3510 @var{type} should be one of @samp{single}, @samp{negative},
3511 @samp{multigot} or @samp{target}. For more information refer to the
3512 Info entry for @file{ld}.
3513
3514 @end table
3515
3516 @c man end
3517 @end ifset
3518
3519 @ifset MIPS
3520 @subsection Options specific to MIPS targets
3521
3522 @c man begin OPTIONS
3523
3524 The following options are supported to control microMIPS instruction
3525 generation and branch relocation checks for ISA mode transitions when
3526 linking for MIPS targets.
3527
3528 @table @gcctabopt
3529
3530 @kindex --insn32
3531 @item --insn32
3532 @kindex --no-insn32
3533 @itemx --no-insn32
3534 These options control the choice of microMIPS instructions used in code
3535 generated by the linker, such as that in the PLT or lazy binding stubs,
3536 or in relaxation. If @samp{--insn32} is used, then the linker only uses
3537 32-bit instruction encodings. By default or if @samp{--no-insn32} is
3538 used, all instruction encodings are used, including 16-bit ones where
3539 possible.
3540
3541 @kindex --ignore-branch-isa
3542 @item --ignore-branch-isa
3543 @kindex --no-ignore-branch-isa
3544 @itemx --no-ignore-branch-isa
3545 These options control branch relocation checks for invalid ISA mode
3546 transitions. If @samp{--ignore-branch-isa} is used, then the linker
3547 accepts any branch relocations and any ISA mode transition required
3548 is lost in relocation calculation, except for some cases of @code{BAL}
3549 instructions which meet relaxation conditions and are converted to
3550 equivalent @code{JALX} instructions as the associated relocation is
3551 calculated. By default or if @samp{--no-ignore-branch-isa} is used
3552 a check is made causing the loss of an ISA mode transition to produce
3553 an error.
3554
3555 @kindex --compact-branches
3556 @item --compact-branches
3557 @kindex --no-compact-branches
3558 @itemx --no-compact-branches
3559 These options control the generation of compact instructions by the linker
3560 in the PLT entries for MIPS R6.
3561
3562 @end table
3563
3564 @c man end
3565 @end ifset
3566
3567
3568 @ifset PDP11
3569 @subsection Options specific to PDP11 targets
3570
3571 @c man begin OPTIONS
3572
3573 For the pdp11-aout target, three variants of the output format can be
3574 produced as selected by the following options. The default variant
3575 for pdp11-aout is the @samp{--omagic} option, whereas for other
3576 targets @samp{--nmagic} is the default. The @samp{--imagic} option is
3577 defined only for the pdp11-aout target, while the others are described
3578 here as they apply to the pdp11-aout target.
3579
3580 @table @gcctabopt
3581
3582 @kindex -N
3583 @item -N
3584 @kindex --omagic
3585 @itemx --omagic
3586
3587 Mark the output as @code{OMAGIC} (0407) in the @file{a.out} header to
3588 indicate that the text segment is not to be write-protected and
3589 shared. Since the text and data sections are both readable and
3590 writable, the data section is allocated immediately contiguous after
3591 the text segment. This is the oldest format for PDP11 executable
3592 programs and is the default for @command{ld} on PDP11 Unix systems
3593 from the beginning through 2.11BSD.
3594
3595 @kindex -n
3596 @item -n
3597 @kindex --nmagic
3598 @itemx --nmagic
3599
3600 Mark the output as @code{NMAGIC} (0410) in the @file{a.out} header to
3601 indicate that when the output file is executed, the text portion will
3602 be read-only and shareable among all processes executing the same
3603 file. This involves moving the data areas up to the first possible 8K
3604 byte page boundary following the end of the text. This option creates
3605 a @emph{pure executable} format.
3606
3607 @kindex -z
3608 @item -z
3609 @kindex --imagic
3610 @itemx --imagic
3611
3612 Mark the output as @code{IMAGIC} (0411) in the @file{a.out} header to
3613 indicate that when the output file is executed, the program text and
3614 data areas will be loaded into separate address spaces using the split
3615 instruction and data space feature of the memory management unit in
3616 larger models of the PDP11. This doubles the address space available
3617 to the program. The text segment is again pure, write-protected, and
3618 shareable. The only difference in the output format between this
3619 option and the others, besides the magic number, is that both the text
3620 and data sections start at location 0. The @samp{-z} option selected
3621 this format in 2.11BSD. This option creates a @emph{separate
3622 executable} format.
3623
3624 @kindex --no-omagic
3625 @item --no-omagic
3626
3627 Equivalent to @samp{--nmagic} for pdp11-aout.
3628
3629 @end table
3630
3631 @c man end
3632 @end ifset
3633
3634 @ifset UsesEnvVars
3635 @node Environment
3636 @section Environment Variables
3637
3638 @c man begin ENVIRONMENT
3639
3640 You can change the behaviour of @command{ld} with the environment variables
3641 @ifclear SingleFormat
3642 @code{GNUTARGET},
3643 @end ifclear
3644 @code{LDEMULATION} and @code{COLLECT_NO_DEMANGLE}.
3645
3646 @ifclear SingleFormat
3647 @kindex GNUTARGET
3648 @cindex default input format
3649 @code{GNUTARGET} determines the input-file object format if you don't
3650 use @samp{-b} (or its synonym @samp{--format}). Its value should be one
3651 of the BFD names for an input format (@pxref{BFD}). If there is no
3652 @code{GNUTARGET} in the environment, @command{ld} uses the natural format
3653 of the target. If @code{GNUTARGET} is set to @code{default} then BFD
3654 attempts to discover the input format by examining binary input files;
3655 this method often succeeds, but there are potential ambiguities, since
3656 there is no method of ensuring that the magic number used to specify
3657 object-file formats is unique. However, the configuration procedure for
3658 BFD on each system places the conventional format for that system first
3659 in the search-list, so ambiguities are resolved in favor of convention.
3660 @end ifclear
3661
3662 @kindex LDEMULATION
3663 @cindex default emulation
3664 @cindex emulation, default
3665 @code{LDEMULATION} determines the default emulation if you don't use the
3666 @samp{-m} option. The emulation can affect various aspects of linker
3667 behaviour, particularly the default linker script. You can list the
3668 available emulations with the @samp{--verbose} or @samp{-V} options. If
3669 the @samp{-m} option is not used, and the @code{LDEMULATION} environment
3670 variable is not defined, the default emulation depends upon how the
3671 linker was configured.
3672
3673 @kindex COLLECT_NO_DEMANGLE
3674 @cindex demangling, default
3675 Normally, the linker will default to demangling symbols. However, if
3676 @code{COLLECT_NO_DEMANGLE} is set in the environment, then it will
3677 default to not demangling symbols. This environment variable is used in
3678 a similar fashion by the @code{gcc} linker wrapper program. The default
3679 may be overridden by the @samp{--demangle} and @samp{--no-demangle}
3680 options.
3681
3682 @c man end
3683 @end ifset
3684
3685 @node Scripts
3686 @chapter Linker Scripts
3687
3688 @cindex scripts
3689 @cindex linker scripts
3690 @cindex command files
3691 Every link is controlled by a @dfn{linker script}. This script is
3692 written in the linker command language.
3693
3694 The main purpose of the linker script is to describe how the sections in
3695 the input files should be mapped into the output file, and to control
3696 the memory layout of the output file. Most linker scripts do nothing
3697 more than this. However, when necessary, the linker script can also
3698 direct the linker to perform many other operations, using the commands
3699 described below.
3700
3701 The linker always uses a linker script. If you do not supply one
3702 yourself, the linker will use a default script that is compiled into the
3703 linker executable. You can use the @samp{--verbose} command-line option
3704 to display the default linker script. Certain command-line options,
3705 such as @samp{-r} or @samp{-N}, will affect the default linker script.
3706
3707 You may supply your own linker script by using the @samp{-T} command
3708 line option. When you do this, your linker script will replace the
3709 default linker script.
3710
3711 You may also use linker scripts implicitly by naming them as input files
3712 to the linker, as though they were files to be linked. @xref{Implicit
3713 Linker Scripts}.
3714
3715 @menu
3716 * Basic Script Concepts:: Basic Linker Script Concepts
3717 * Script Format:: Linker Script Format
3718 * Simple Example:: Simple Linker Script Example
3719 * Simple Commands:: Simple Linker Script Commands
3720 * Assignments:: Assigning Values to Symbols
3721 * SECTIONS:: SECTIONS Command
3722 * MEMORY:: MEMORY Command
3723 * PHDRS:: PHDRS Command
3724 * VERSION:: VERSION Command
3725 * Expressions:: Expressions in Linker Scripts
3726 * Implicit Linker Scripts:: Implicit Linker Scripts
3727 @end menu
3728
3729 @node Basic Script Concepts
3730 @section Basic Linker Script Concepts
3731 @cindex linker script concepts
3732 We need to define some basic concepts and vocabulary in order to
3733 describe the linker script language.
3734
3735 The linker combines input files into a single output file. The output
3736 file and each input file are in a special data format known as an
3737 @dfn{object file format}. Each file is called an @dfn{object file}.
3738 The output file is often called an @dfn{executable}, but for our
3739 purposes we will also call it an object file. Each object file has,
3740 among other things, a list of @dfn{sections}. We sometimes refer to a
3741 section in an input file as an @dfn{input section}; similarly, a section
3742 in the output file is an @dfn{output section}.
3743
3744 Each section in an object file has a name and a size. Most sections
3745 also have an associated block of data, known as the @dfn{section
3746 contents}. A section may be marked as @dfn{loadable}, which means that
3747 the contents should be loaded into memory when the output file is run.
3748 A section with no contents may be @dfn{allocatable}, which means that an
3749 area in memory should be set aside, but nothing in particular should be
3750 loaded there (in some cases this memory must be zeroed out). A section
3751 which is neither loadable nor allocatable typically contains some sort
3752 of debugging information.
3753
3754 Every loadable or allocatable output section has two addresses. The
3755 first is the @dfn{VMA}, or virtual memory address. This is the address
3756 the section will have when the output file is run. The second is the
3757 @dfn{LMA}, or load memory address. This is the address at which the
3758 section will be loaded. In most cases the two addresses will be the
3759 same. An example of when they might be different is when a data section
3760 is loaded into ROM, and then copied into RAM when the program starts up
3761 (this technique is often used to initialize global variables in a ROM
3762 based system). In this case the ROM address would be the LMA, and the
3763 RAM address would be the VMA.
3764
3765 You can see the sections in an object file by using the @code{objdump}
3766 program with the @samp{-h} option.
3767
3768 Every object file also has a list of @dfn{symbols}, known as the
3769 @dfn{symbol table}. A symbol may be defined or undefined. Each symbol
3770 has a name, and each defined symbol has an address, among other
3771 information. If you compile a C or C++ program into an object file, you
3772 will get a defined symbol for every defined function and global or
3773 static variable. Every undefined function or global variable which is
3774 referenced in the input file will become an undefined symbol.
3775
3776 You can see the symbols in an object file by using the @code{nm}
3777 program, or by using the @code{objdump} program with the @samp{-t}
3778 option.
3779
3780 @node Script Format
3781 @section Linker Script Format
3782 @cindex linker script format
3783 Linker scripts are text files.
3784
3785 You write a linker script as a series of commands. Each command is
3786 either a keyword, possibly followed by arguments, or an assignment to a
3787 symbol. You may separate commands using semicolons. Whitespace is
3788 generally ignored.
3789
3790 Strings such as file or format names can normally be entered directly.
3791 If the file name contains a character such as a comma which would
3792 otherwise serve to separate file names, you may put the file name in
3793 double quotes. There is no way to use a double quote character in a
3794 file name.
3795
3796 You may include comments in linker scripts just as in C, delimited by
3797 @samp{/*} and @samp{*/}. As in C, comments are syntactically equivalent
3798 to whitespace.
3799
3800 @node Simple Example
3801 @section Simple Linker Script Example
3802 @cindex linker script example
3803 @cindex example of linker script
3804 Many linker scripts are fairly simple.
3805
3806 The simplest possible linker script has just one command:
3807 @samp{SECTIONS}. You use the @samp{SECTIONS} command to describe the
3808 memory layout of the output file.
3809
3810 The @samp{SECTIONS} command is a powerful command. Here we will
3811 describe a simple use of it. Let's assume your program consists only of
3812 code, initialized data, and uninitialized data. These will be in the
3813 @samp{.text}, @samp{.data}, and @samp{.bss} sections, respectively.
3814 Let's assume further that these are the only sections which appear in
3815 your input files.
3816
3817 For this example, let's say that the code should be loaded at address
3818 0x10000, and that the data should start at address 0x8000000. Here is a
3819 linker script which will do that:
3820 @smallexample
3821 SECTIONS
3822 @{
3823 . = 0x10000;
3824 .text : @{ *(.text) @}
3825 . = 0x8000000;
3826 .data : @{ *(.data) @}
3827 .bss : @{ *(.bss) @}
3828 @}
3829 @end smallexample
3830
3831 You write the @samp{SECTIONS} command as the keyword @samp{SECTIONS},
3832 followed by a series of symbol assignments and output section
3833 descriptions enclosed in curly braces.
3834
3835 The first line inside the @samp{SECTIONS} command of the above example
3836 sets the value of the special symbol @samp{.}, which is the location
3837 counter. If you do not specify the address of an output section in some
3838 other way (other ways are described later), the address is set from the
3839 current value of the location counter. The location counter is then
3840 incremented by the size of the output section. At the start of the
3841 @samp{SECTIONS} command, the location counter has the value @samp{0}.
3842
3843 The second line defines an output section, @samp{.text}. The colon is
3844 required syntax which may be ignored for now. Within the curly braces
3845 after the output section name, you list the names of the input sections
3846 which should be placed into this output section. The @samp{*} is a
3847 wildcard which matches any file name. The expression @samp{*(.text)}
3848 means all @samp{.text} input sections in all input files.
3849
3850 Since the location counter is @samp{0x10000} when the output section
3851 @samp{.text} is defined, the linker will set the address of the
3852 @samp{.text} section in the output file to be @samp{0x10000}.
3853
3854 The remaining lines define the @samp{.data} and @samp{.bss} sections in
3855 the output file. The linker will place the @samp{.data} output section
3856 at address @samp{0x8000000}. After the linker places the @samp{.data}
3857 output section, the value of the location counter will be
3858 @samp{0x8000000} plus the size of the @samp{.data} output section. The
3859 effect is that the linker will place the @samp{.bss} output section
3860 immediately after the @samp{.data} output section in memory.
3861
3862 The linker will ensure that each output section has the required
3863 alignment, by increasing the location counter if necessary. In this
3864 example, the specified addresses for the @samp{.text} and @samp{.data}
3865 sections will probably satisfy any alignment constraints, but the linker
3866 may have to create a small gap between the @samp{.data} and @samp{.bss}
3867 sections.
3868
3869 That's it! That's a simple and complete linker script.
3870
3871 @node Simple Commands
3872 @section Simple Linker Script Commands
3873 @cindex linker script simple commands
3874 In this section we describe the simple linker script commands.
3875
3876 @menu
3877 * Entry Point:: Setting the entry point
3878 * File Commands:: Commands dealing with files
3879 @ifclear SingleFormat
3880 * Format Commands:: Commands dealing with object file formats
3881 @end ifclear
3882
3883 * REGION_ALIAS:: Assign alias names to memory regions
3884 * Miscellaneous Commands:: Other linker script commands
3885 @end menu
3886
3887 @node Entry Point
3888 @subsection Setting the Entry Point
3889 @kindex ENTRY(@var{symbol})
3890 @cindex start of execution
3891 @cindex first instruction
3892 @cindex entry point
3893 The first instruction to execute in a program is called the @dfn{entry
3894 point}. You can use the @code{ENTRY} linker script command to set the
3895 entry point. The argument is a symbol name:
3896 @smallexample
3897 ENTRY(@var{symbol})
3898 @end smallexample
3899
3900 There are several ways to set the entry point. The linker will set the
3901 entry point by trying each of the following methods in order, and
3902 stopping when one of them succeeds:
3903 @itemize @bullet
3904 @item
3905 the @samp{-e} @var{entry} command-line option;
3906 @item
3907 the @code{ENTRY(@var{symbol})} command in a linker script;
3908 @item
3909 the value of a target-specific symbol, if it is defined; For many
3910 targets this is @code{start}, but PE- and BeOS-based systems for example
3911 check a list of possible entry symbols, matching the first one found.
3912 @item
3913 the address of the first byte of the code section, if present and an
3914 executable is being created - the code section is usually
3915 @samp{.text}, but can be something else;
3916 @item
3917 The address @code{0}.
3918 @end itemize
3919
3920 @node File Commands
3921 @subsection Commands Dealing with Files
3922 @cindex linker script file commands
3923 Several linker script commands deal with files.
3924
3925 @table @code
3926 @item INCLUDE @var{filename}
3927 @kindex INCLUDE @var{filename}
3928 @cindex including a linker script
3929 Include the linker script @var{filename} at this point. The file will
3930 be searched for in the current directory, and in any directory specified
3931 with the @option{-L} option. You can nest calls to @code{INCLUDE} up to
3932 10 levels deep.
3933
3934 You can place @code{INCLUDE} directives at the top level, in @code{MEMORY} or
3935 @code{SECTIONS} commands, or in output section descriptions.
3936
3937 @item INPUT(@var{file}, @var{file}, @dots{})
3938 @itemx INPUT(@var{file} @var{file} @dots{})
3939 @kindex INPUT(@var{files})
3940 @cindex input files in linker scripts
3941 @cindex input object files in linker scripts
3942 @cindex linker script input object files
3943 The @code{INPUT} command directs the linker to include the named files
3944 in the link, as though they were named on the command line.
3945
3946 For example, if you always want to include @file{subr.o} any time you do
3947 a link, but you can't be bothered to put it on every link command line,
3948 then you can put @samp{INPUT (subr.o)} in your linker script.
3949
3950 In fact, if you like, you can list all of your input files in the linker
3951 script, and then invoke the linker with nothing but a @samp{-T} option.
3952
3953 In case a @dfn{sysroot prefix} is configured, and the filename starts
3954 with the @samp{/} character, and the script being processed was
3955 located inside the @dfn{sysroot prefix}, the filename will be looked
3956 for in the @dfn{sysroot prefix}. The @dfn{sysroot prefix} can also be forced by specifying
3957 @code{=} as the first character in the filename path, or prefixing the
3958 filename path with @code{$SYSROOT}. See also the description of
3959 @samp{-L} in @ref{Options,,Command-line Options}.
3960
3961 If a @dfn{sysroot prefix} is not used then the linker will try to open
3962 the file in the directory containing the linker script. If it is not
3963 found the linker will then search the current directory. If it is still
3964 not found the linker will search through the archive library search
3965 path.
3966
3967 If you use @samp{INPUT (-l@var{file})}, @command{ld} will transform the
3968 name to @code{lib@var{file}.a}, as with the command-line argument
3969 @samp{-l}.
3970
3971 When you use the @code{INPUT} command in an implicit linker script, the
3972 files will be included in the link at the point at which the linker
3973 script file is included. This can affect archive searching.
3974
3975 @item GROUP(@var{file}, @var{file}, @dots{})
3976 @itemx GROUP(@var{file} @var{file} @dots{})
3977 @kindex GROUP(@var{files})
3978 @cindex grouping input files
3979 The @code{GROUP} command is like @code{INPUT}, except that the named
3980 files should all be archives, and they are searched repeatedly until no
3981 new undefined references are created. See the description of @samp{-(}
3982 in @ref{Options,,Command-line Options}.
3983
3984 @item AS_NEEDED(@var{file}, @var{file}, @dots{})
3985 @itemx AS_NEEDED(@var{file} @var{file} @dots{})
3986 @kindex AS_NEEDED(@var{files})
3987 This construct can appear only inside of the @code{INPUT} or @code{GROUP}
3988 commands, among other filenames. The files listed will be handled
3989 as if they appear directly in the @code{INPUT} or @code{GROUP} commands,
3990 with the exception of ELF shared libraries, that will be added only
3991 when they are actually needed. This construct essentially enables
3992 @option{--as-needed} option for all the files listed inside of it
3993 and restores previous @option{--as-needed} resp. @option{--no-as-needed}
3994 setting afterwards.
3995
3996 @item OUTPUT(@var{filename})
3997 @kindex OUTPUT(@var{filename})
3998 @cindex output file name in linker script
3999 The @code{OUTPUT} command names the output file. Using
4000 @code{OUTPUT(@var{filename})} in the linker script is exactly like using
4001 @samp{-o @var{filename}} on the command line (@pxref{Options,,Command
4002 Line Options}). If both are used, the command-line option takes
4003 precedence.
4004
4005 You can use the @code{OUTPUT} command to define a default name for the
4006 output file other than the usual default of @file{a.out}.
4007
4008 @item SEARCH_DIR(@var{path})
4009 @kindex SEARCH_DIR(@var{path})
4010 @cindex library search path in linker script
4011 @cindex archive search path in linker script
4012 @cindex search path in linker script
4013 The @code{SEARCH_DIR} command adds @var{path} to the list of paths where
4014 @command{ld} looks for archive libraries. Using
4015 @code{SEARCH_DIR(@var{path})} is exactly like using @samp{-L @var{path}}
4016 on the command line (@pxref{Options,,Command-line Options}). If both
4017 are used, then the linker will search both paths. Paths specified using
4018 the command-line option are searched first.
4019
4020 @item STARTUP(@var{filename})
4021 @kindex STARTUP(@var{filename})
4022 @cindex first input file
4023 The @code{STARTUP} command is just like the @code{INPUT} command, except
4024 that @var{filename} will become the first input file to be linked, as
4025 though it were specified first on the command line. This may be useful
4026 when using a system in which the entry point is always the start of the
4027 first file.
4028 @end table
4029
4030 @ifclear SingleFormat
4031 @node Format Commands
4032 @subsection Commands Dealing with Object File Formats
4033 A couple of linker script commands deal with object file formats.
4034
4035 @table @code
4036 @item OUTPUT_FORMAT(@var{bfdname})
4037 @itemx OUTPUT_FORMAT(@var{default}, @var{big}, @var{little})
4038 @kindex OUTPUT_FORMAT(@var{bfdname})
4039 @cindex output file format in linker script
4040 The @code{OUTPUT_FORMAT} command names the BFD format to use for the
4041 output file (@pxref{BFD}). Using @code{OUTPUT_FORMAT(@var{bfdname})} is
4042 exactly like using @samp{--oformat @var{bfdname}} on the command line
4043 (@pxref{Options,,Command-line Options}). If both are used, the command
4044 line option takes precedence.
4045
4046 You can use @code{OUTPUT_FORMAT} with three arguments to use different
4047 formats based on the @samp{-EB} and @samp{-EL} command-line options.
4048 This permits the linker script to set the output format based on the
4049 desired endianness.
4050
4051 If neither @samp{-EB} nor @samp{-EL} are used, then the output format
4052 will be the first argument, @var{default}. If @samp{-EB} is used, the
4053 output format will be the second argument, @var{big}. If @samp{-EL} is
4054 used, the output format will be the third argument, @var{little}.
4055
4056 For example, the default linker script for the MIPS ELF target uses this
4057 command:
4058 @smallexample
4059 OUTPUT_FORMAT(elf32-bigmips, elf32-bigmips, elf32-littlemips)
4060 @end smallexample
4061 This says that the default format for the output file is
4062 @samp{elf32-bigmips}, but if the user uses the @samp{-EL} command-line
4063 option, the output file will be created in the @samp{elf32-littlemips}
4064 format.
4065
4066 @item TARGET(@var{bfdname})
4067 @kindex TARGET(@var{bfdname})
4068 @cindex input file format in linker script
4069 The @code{TARGET} command names the BFD format to use when reading input
4070 files. It affects subsequent @code{INPUT} and @code{GROUP} commands.
4071 This command is like using @samp{-b @var{bfdname}} on the command line
4072 (@pxref{Options,,Command-line Options}). If the @code{TARGET} command
4073 is used but @code{OUTPUT_FORMAT} is not, then the last @code{TARGET}
4074 command is also used to set the format for the output file. @xref{BFD}.
4075 @end table
4076 @end ifclear
4077
4078 @node REGION_ALIAS
4079 @subsection Assign alias names to memory regions
4080 @kindex REGION_ALIAS(@var{alias}, @var{region})
4081 @cindex region alias
4082 @cindex region names
4083
4084 Alias names can be added to existing memory regions created with the
4085 @ref{MEMORY} command. Each name corresponds to at most one memory region.
4086
4087 @smallexample
4088 REGION_ALIAS(@var{alias}, @var{region})
4089 @end smallexample
4090
4091 The @code{REGION_ALIAS} function creates an alias name @var{alias} for the
4092 memory region @var{region}. This allows a flexible mapping of output sections
4093 to memory regions. An example follows.
4094
4095 Suppose we have an application for embedded systems which come with various
4096 memory storage devices. All have a general purpose, volatile memory @code{RAM}
4097 that allows code execution or data storage. Some may have a read-only,
4098 non-volatile memory @code{ROM} that allows code execution and read-only data
4099 access. The last variant is a read-only, non-volatile memory @code{ROM2} with
4100 read-only data access and no code execution capability. We have four output
4101 sections:
4102
4103 @itemize @bullet
4104 @item
4105 @code{.text} program code;
4106 @item
4107 @code{.rodata} read-only data;
4108 @item
4109 @code{.data} read-write initialized data;
4110 @item
4111 @code{.bss} read-write zero initialized data.
4112 @end itemize
4113
4114 The goal is to provide a linker command file that contains a system independent
4115 part defining the output sections and a system dependent part mapping the
4116 output sections to the memory regions available on the system. Our embedded
4117 systems come with three different memory setups @code{A}, @code{B} and
4118 @code{C}:
4119 @multitable @columnfractions .25 .25 .25 .25
4120 @item Section @tab Variant A @tab Variant B @tab Variant C
4121 @item .text @tab RAM @tab ROM @tab ROM
4122 @item .rodata @tab RAM @tab ROM @tab ROM2
4123 @item .data @tab RAM @tab RAM/ROM @tab RAM/ROM2
4124 @item .bss @tab RAM @tab RAM @tab RAM
4125 @end multitable
4126 The notation @code{RAM/ROM} or @code{RAM/ROM2} means that this section is
4127 loaded into region @code{ROM} or @code{ROM2} respectively. Please note that
4128 the load address of the @code{.data} section starts in all three variants at
4129 the end of the @code{.rodata} section.
4130
4131 The base linker script that deals with the output sections follows. It
4132 includes the system dependent @code{linkcmds.memory} file that describes the
4133 memory layout:
4134 @smallexample
4135 INCLUDE linkcmds.memory
4136
4137 SECTIONS
4138 @{
4139 .text :
4140 @{
4141 *(.text)
4142 @} > REGION_TEXT
4143 .rodata :
4144 @{
4145 *(.rodata)
4146 rodata_end = .;
4147 @} > REGION_RODATA
4148 .data : AT (rodata_end)
4149 @{
4150 data_start = .;
4151 *(.data)
4152 @} > REGION_DATA
4153 data_size = SIZEOF(.data);
4154 data_load_start = LOADADDR(.data);
4155 .bss :
4156 @{
4157 *(.bss)
4158 @} > REGION_BSS
4159 @}
4160 @end smallexample
4161
4162 Now we need three different @code{linkcmds.memory} files to define memory
4163 regions and alias names. The content of @code{linkcmds.memory} for the three
4164 variants @code{A}, @code{B} and @code{C}:
4165 @table @code
4166 @item A
4167 Here everything goes into the @code{RAM}.
4168 @smallexample
4169 MEMORY
4170 @{
4171 RAM : ORIGIN = 0, LENGTH = 4M
4172 @}
4173
4174 REGION_ALIAS("REGION_TEXT", RAM);
4175 REGION_ALIAS("REGION_RODATA", RAM);
4176 REGION_ALIAS("REGION_DATA", RAM);
4177 REGION_ALIAS("REGION_BSS", RAM);
4178 @end smallexample
4179 @item B
4180 Program code and read-only data go into the @code{ROM}. Read-write data goes
4181 into the @code{RAM}. An image of the initialized data is loaded into the
4182 @code{ROM} and will be copied during system start into the @code{RAM}.
4183 @smallexample
4184 MEMORY
4185 @{
4186 ROM : ORIGIN = 0, LENGTH = 3M
4187 RAM : ORIGIN = 0x10000000, LENGTH = 1M
4188 @}
4189
4190 REGION_ALIAS("REGION_TEXT", ROM);
4191 REGION_ALIAS("REGION_RODATA", ROM);
4192 REGION_ALIAS("REGION_DATA", RAM);
4193 REGION_ALIAS("REGION_BSS", RAM);
4194 @end smallexample
4195 @item C
4196 Program code goes into the @code{ROM}. Read-only data goes into the
4197 @code{ROM2}. Read-write data goes into the @code{RAM}. An image of the
4198 initialized data is loaded into the @code{ROM2} and will be copied during
4199 system start into the @code{RAM}.
4200 @smallexample
4201 MEMORY
4202 @{
4203 ROM : ORIGIN = 0, LENGTH = 2M
4204 ROM2 : ORIGIN = 0x10000000, LENGTH = 1M
4205 RAM : ORIGIN = 0x20000000, LENGTH = 1M
4206 @}
4207
4208 REGION_ALIAS("REGION_TEXT", ROM);
4209 REGION_ALIAS("REGION_RODATA", ROM2);
4210 REGION_ALIAS("REGION_DATA", RAM);
4211 REGION_ALIAS("REGION_BSS", RAM);
4212 @end smallexample
4213 @end table
4214
4215 It is possible to write a common system initialization routine to copy the
4216 @code{.data} section from @code{ROM} or @code{ROM2} into the @code{RAM} if
4217 necessary:
4218 @smallexample
4219 #include <string.h>
4220
4221 extern char data_start [];
4222 extern char data_size [];
4223 extern char data_load_start [];
4224
4225 void copy_data(void)
4226 @{
4227 if (data_start != data_load_start)
4228 @{
4229 memcpy(data_start, data_load_start, (size_t) data_size);
4230 @}
4231 @}
4232 @end smallexample
4233
4234 @node Miscellaneous Commands
4235 @subsection Other Linker Script Commands
4236 There are a few other linker scripts commands.
4237
4238 @table @code
4239 @item ASSERT(@var{exp}, @var{message})
4240 @kindex ASSERT
4241 @cindex assertion in linker script
4242 Ensure that @var{exp} is non-zero. If it is zero, then exit the linker
4243 with an error code, and print @var{message}.
4244
4245 Note that assertions are checked before the final stages of linking
4246 take place. This means that expressions involving symbols PROVIDEd
4247 inside section definitions will fail if the user has not set values
4248 for those symbols. The only exception to this rule is PROVIDEd
4249 symbols that just reference dot. Thus an assertion like this:
4250
4251 @smallexample
4252 .stack :
4253 @{
4254 PROVIDE (__stack = .);
4255 PROVIDE (__stack_size = 0x100);
4256 ASSERT ((__stack > (_end + __stack_size)), "Error: No room left for the stack");
4257 @}
4258 @end smallexample
4259
4260 will fail if @code{__stack_size} is not defined elsewhere. Symbols
4261 PROVIDEd outside of section definitions are evaluated earlier, so they
4262 can be used inside ASSERTions. Thus:
4263
4264 @smallexample
4265 PROVIDE (__stack_size = 0x100);
4266 .stack :
4267 @{
4268 PROVIDE (__stack = .);
4269 ASSERT ((__stack > (_end + __stack_size)), "Error: No room left for the stack");
4270 @}
4271 @end smallexample
4272
4273 will work.
4274
4275 @item EXTERN(@var{symbol} @var{symbol} @dots{})
4276 @kindex EXTERN
4277 @cindex undefined symbol in linker script
4278 Force @var{symbol} to be entered in the output file as an undefined
4279 symbol. Doing this may, for example, trigger linking of additional
4280 modules from standard libraries. You may list several @var{symbol}s for
4281 each @code{EXTERN}, and you may use @code{EXTERN} multiple times. This
4282 command has the same effect as the @samp{-u} command-line option.
4283
4284 @item FORCE_COMMON_ALLOCATION
4285 @kindex FORCE_COMMON_ALLOCATION
4286 @cindex common allocation in linker script
4287 This command has the same effect as the @samp{-d} command-line option:
4288 to make @command{ld} assign space to common symbols even if a relocatable
4289 output file is specified (@samp{-r}).
4290
4291 @item INHIBIT_COMMON_ALLOCATION
4292 @kindex INHIBIT_COMMON_ALLOCATION
4293 @cindex common allocation in linker script
4294 This command has the same effect as the @samp{--no-define-common}
4295 command-line option: to make @code{ld} omit the assignment of addresses
4296 to common symbols even for a non-relocatable output file.
4297
4298 @item FORCE_GROUP_ALLOCATION
4299 @kindex FORCE_GROUP_ALLOCATION
4300 @cindex group allocation in linker script
4301 @cindex section groups
4302 @cindex COMDAT
4303 This command has the same effect as the
4304 @samp{--force-group-allocation} command-line option: to make
4305 @command{ld} place section group members like normal input sections,
4306 and to delete the section groups even if a relocatable output file is
4307 specified (@samp{-r}).
4308
4309 @item INSERT [ AFTER | BEFORE ] @var{output_section}
4310 @kindex INSERT
4311 @cindex insert user script into default script
4312 This command is typically used in a script specified by @samp{-T} to
4313 augment the default @code{SECTIONS} with, for example, overlays. It
4314 inserts all prior linker script statements after (or before)
4315 @var{output_section}, and also causes @samp{-T} to not override the
4316 default linker script. The exact insertion point is as for orphan
4317 sections. @xref{Location Counter}. The insertion happens after the
4318 linker has mapped input sections to output sections. Prior to the
4319 insertion, since @samp{-T} scripts are parsed before the default
4320 linker script, statements in the @samp{-T} script occur before the
4321 default linker script statements in the internal linker representation
4322 of the script. In particular, input section assignments will be made
4323 to @samp{-T} output sections before those in the default script. Here
4324 is an example of how a @samp{-T} script using @code{INSERT} might look:
4325
4326 @smallexample
4327 SECTIONS
4328 @{
4329 OVERLAY :
4330 @{
4331 .ov1 @{ ov1*(.text) @}
4332 .ov2 @{ ov2*(.text) @}
4333 @}
4334 @}
4335 INSERT AFTER .text;
4336 @end smallexample
4337
4338 @item NOCROSSREFS(@var{section} @var{section} @dots{})
4339 @kindex NOCROSSREFS(@var{sections})
4340 @cindex cross references
4341 This command may be used to tell @command{ld} to issue an error about any
4342 references among certain output sections.
4343
4344 In certain types of programs, particularly on embedded systems when
4345 using overlays, when one section is loaded into memory, another section
4346 will not be. Any direct references between the two sections would be
4347 errors. For example, it would be an error if code in one section called
4348 a function defined in the other section.
4349
4350 The @code{NOCROSSREFS} command takes a list of output section names. If
4351 @command{ld} detects any cross references between the sections, it reports
4352 an error and returns a non-zero exit status. Note that the
4353 @code{NOCROSSREFS} command uses output section names, not input section
4354 names.
4355
4356 @item NOCROSSREFS_TO(@var{tosection} @var{fromsection} @dots{})
4357 @kindex NOCROSSREFS_TO(@var{tosection} @var{fromsections})
4358 @cindex cross references
4359 This command may be used to tell @command{ld} to issue an error about any
4360 references to one section from a list of other sections.
4361
4362 The @code{NOCROSSREFS} command is useful when ensuring that two or more
4363 output sections are entirely independent but there are situations where
4364 a one-way dependency is needed. For example, in a multi-core application
4365 there may be shared code that can be called from each core but for safety
4366 must never call back.
4367
4368 The @code{NOCROSSREFS_TO} command takes a list of output section names.
4369 The first section can not be referenced from any of the other sections.
4370 If @command{ld} detects any references to the first section from any of
4371 the other sections, it reports an error and returns a non-zero exit
4372 status. Note that the @code{NOCROSSREFS_TO} command uses output section
4373 names, not input section names.
4374
4375 @ifclear SingleFormat
4376 @item OUTPUT_ARCH(@var{bfdarch})
4377 @kindex OUTPUT_ARCH(@var{bfdarch})
4378 @cindex machine architecture
4379 @cindex architecture
4380 Specify a particular output machine architecture. The argument is one
4381 of the names used by the BFD library (@pxref{BFD}). You can see the
4382 architecture of an object file by using the @code{objdump} program with
4383 the @samp{-f} option.
4384 @end ifclear
4385
4386 @item LD_FEATURE(@var{string})
4387 @kindex LD_FEATURE(@var{string})
4388 This command may be used to modify @command{ld} behavior. If
4389 @var{string} is @code{"SANE_EXPR"} then absolute symbols and numbers
4390 in a script are simply treated as numbers everywhere.
4391 @xref{Expression Section}.
4392 @end table
4393
4394 @node Assignments
4395 @section Assigning Values to Symbols
4396 @cindex assignment in scripts
4397 @cindex symbol definition, scripts
4398 @cindex variables, defining
4399 You may assign a value to a symbol in a linker script. This will define
4400 the symbol and place it into the symbol table with a global scope.
4401
4402 @menu
4403 * Simple Assignments:: Simple Assignments
4404 * HIDDEN:: HIDDEN
4405 * PROVIDE:: PROVIDE
4406 * PROVIDE_HIDDEN:: PROVIDE_HIDDEN
4407 * Source Code Reference:: How to use a linker script defined symbol in source code
4408 @end menu
4409
4410 @node Simple Assignments
4411 @subsection Simple Assignments
4412
4413 You may assign to a symbol using any of the C assignment operators:
4414
4415 @table @code
4416 @item @var{symbol} = @var{expression} ;
4417 @itemx @var{symbol} += @var{expression} ;
4418 @itemx @var{symbol} -= @var{expression} ;
4419 @itemx @var{symbol} *= @var{expression} ;
4420 @itemx @var{symbol} /= @var{expression} ;
4421 @itemx @var{symbol} <<= @var{expression} ;
4422 @itemx @var{symbol} >>= @var{expression} ;
4423 @itemx @var{symbol} &= @var{expression} ;
4424 @itemx @var{symbol} |= @var{expression} ;
4425 @end table
4426
4427 The first case will define @var{symbol} to the value of
4428 @var{expression}. In the other cases, @var{symbol} must already be
4429 defined, and the value will be adjusted accordingly.
4430
4431 The special symbol name @samp{.} indicates the location counter. You
4432 may only use this within a @code{SECTIONS} command. @xref{Location Counter}.
4433
4434 The semicolon after @var{expression} is required.
4435
4436 Expressions are defined below; see @ref{Expressions}.
4437
4438 You may write symbol assignments as commands in their own right, or as
4439 statements within a @code{SECTIONS} command, or as part of an output
4440 section description in a @code{SECTIONS} command.
4441
4442 The section of the symbol will be set from the section of the
4443 expression; for more information, see @ref{Expression Section}.
4444
4445 Here is an example showing the three different places that symbol
4446 assignments may be used:
4447
4448 @smallexample
4449 floating_point = 0;
4450 SECTIONS
4451 @{
4452 .text :
4453 @{
4454 *(.text)
4455 _etext = .;
4456 @}
4457 _bdata = (. + 3) & ~ 3;
4458 .data : @{ *(.data) @}
4459 @}
4460 @end smallexample
4461 @noindent
4462 In this example, the symbol @samp{floating_point} will be defined as
4463 zero. The symbol @samp{_etext} will be defined as the address following
4464 the last @samp{.text} input section. The symbol @samp{_bdata} will be
4465 defined as the address following the @samp{.text} output section aligned
4466 upward to a 4 byte boundary.
4467
4468 @node HIDDEN
4469 @subsection HIDDEN
4470 @cindex HIDDEN
4471 For ELF targeted ports, define a symbol that will be hidden and won't be
4472 exported. The syntax is @code{HIDDEN(@var{symbol} = @var{expression})}.
4473
4474 Here is the example from @ref{Simple Assignments}, rewritten to use
4475 @code{HIDDEN}:
4476
4477 @smallexample
4478 HIDDEN(floating_point = 0);
4479 SECTIONS
4480 @{
4481 .text :
4482 @{
4483 *(.text)
4484 HIDDEN(_etext = .);
4485 @}
4486 HIDDEN(_bdata = (. + 3) & ~ 3);
4487 .data : @{ *(.data) @}
4488 @}
4489 @end smallexample
4490 @noindent
4491 In this case none of the three symbols will be visible outside this module.
4492
4493 @node PROVIDE
4494 @subsection PROVIDE
4495 @cindex PROVIDE
4496 In some cases, it is desirable for a linker script to define a symbol
4497 only if it is referenced and is not defined by any object included in
4498 the link. For example, traditional linkers defined the symbol
4499 @samp{etext}. However, ANSI C requires that the user be able to use
4500 @samp{etext} as a function name without encountering an error. The
4501 @code{PROVIDE} keyword may be used to define a symbol, such as
4502 @samp{etext}, only if it is referenced but not defined. The syntax is
4503 @code{PROVIDE(@var{symbol} = @var{expression})}.
4504
4505 Here is an example of using @code{PROVIDE} to define @samp{etext}:
4506 @smallexample
4507 SECTIONS
4508 @{
4509 .text :
4510 @{
4511 *(.text)
4512 _etext = .;
4513 PROVIDE(etext = .);
4514 @}
4515 @}
4516 @end smallexample
4517
4518 In this example, if the program defines @samp{_etext} (with a leading
4519 underscore), the linker will give a multiple definition diagnostic. If,
4520 on the other hand, the program defines @samp{etext} (with no leading
4521 underscore), the linker will silently use the definition in the program.
4522 If the program references @samp{etext} but does not define it, the
4523 linker will use the definition in the linker script.
4524
4525 Note - the @code{PROVIDE} directive considers a common symbol to be
4526 defined, even though such a symbol could be combined with the symbol
4527 that the @code{PROVIDE} would create. This is particularly important
4528 when considering constructor and destructor list symbols such as
4529 @samp{__CTOR_LIST__} as these are often defined as common symbols.
4530
4531 @node PROVIDE_HIDDEN
4532 @subsection PROVIDE_HIDDEN
4533 @cindex PROVIDE_HIDDEN
4534 Similar to @code{PROVIDE}. For ELF targeted ports, the symbol will be
4535 hidden and won't be exported.
4536
4537 @node Source Code Reference
4538 @subsection Source Code Reference
4539
4540 Accessing a linker script defined variable from source code is not
4541 intuitive. In particular a linker script symbol is not equivalent to
4542 a variable declaration in a high level language, it is instead a
4543 symbol that does not have a value.
4544
4545 Before going further, it is important to note that compilers often
4546 transform names in the source code into different names when they are
4547 stored in the symbol table. For example, Fortran compilers commonly
4548 prepend or append an underscore, and C++ performs extensive @samp{name
4549 mangling}. Therefore there might be a discrepancy between the name
4550 of a variable as it is used in source code and the name of the same
4551 variable as it is defined in a linker script. For example in C a
4552 linker script variable might be referred to as:
4553
4554 @smallexample
4555 extern int foo;
4556 @end smallexample
4557
4558 But in the linker script it might be defined as:
4559
4560 @smallexample
4561 _foo = 1000;
4562 @end smallexample
4563
4564 In the remaining examples however it is assumed that no name
4565 transformation has taken place.
4566
4567 When a symbol is declared in a high level language such as C, two
4568 things happen. The first is that the compiler reserves enough space
4569 in the program's memory to hold the @emph{value} of the symbol. The
4570 second is that the compiler creates an entry in the program's symbol
4571 table which holds the symbol's @emph{address}. ie the symbol table
4572 contains the address of the block of memory holding the symbol's
4573 value. So for example the following C declaration, at file scope:
4574
4575 @smallexample
4576 int foo = 1000;
4577 @end smallexample
4578
4579 creates an entry called @samp{foo} in the symbol table. This entry
4580 holds the address of an @samp{int} sized block of memory where the
4581 number 1000 is initially stored.
4582
4583 When a program references a symbol the compiler generates code that
4584 first accesses the symbol table to find the address of the symbol's
4585 memory block and then code to read the value from that memory block.
4586 So:
4587
4588 @smallexample
4589 foo = 1;
4590 @end smallexample
4591
4592 looks up the symbol @samp{foo} in the symbol table, gets the address
4593 associated with this symbol and then writes the value 1 into that
4594 address. Whereas:
4595
4596 @smallexample
4597 int * a = & foo;
4598 @end smallexample
4599
4600 looks up the symbol @samp{foo} in the symbol table, gets its address
4601 and then copies this address into the block of memory associated with
4602 the variable @samp{a}.
4603
4604 Linker scripts symbol declarations, by contrast, create an entry in
4605 the symbol table but do not assign any memory to them. Thus they are
4606 an address without a value. So for example the linker script definition:
4607
4608 @smallexample
4609 foo = 1000;
4610 @end smallexample
4611
4612 creates an entry in the symbol table called @samp{foo} which holds
4613 the address of memory location 1000, but nothing special is stored at
4614 address 1000. This means that you cannot access the @emph{value} of a
4615 linker script defined symbol - it has no value - all you can do is
4616 access the @emph{address} of a linker script defined symbol.
4617
4618 Hence when you are using a linker script defined symbol in source code
4619 you should always take the address of the symbol, and never attempt to
4620 use its value. For example suppose you want to copy the contents of a
4621 section of memory called .ROM into a section called .FLASH and the
4622 linker script contains these declarations:
4623
4624 @smallexample
4625 @group
4626 start_of_ROM = .ROM;
4627 end_of_ROM = .ROM + sizeof (.ROM);
4628 start_of_FLASH = .FLASH;
4629 @end group
4630 @end smallexample
4631
4632 Then the C source code to perform the copy would be:
4633
4634 @smallexample
4635 @group
4636 extern char start_of_ROM, end_of_ROM, start_of_FLASH;
4637
4638 memcpy (& start_of_FLASH, & start_of_ROM, & end_of_ROM - & start_of_ROM);
4639 @end group
4640 @end smallexample
4641
4642 Note the use of the @samp{&} operators. These are correct.
4643 Alternatively the symbols can be treated as the names of vectors or
4644 arrays and then the code will again work as expected:
4645
4646 @smallexample
4647 @group
4648 extern char start_of_ROM[], end_of_ROM[], start_of_FLASH[];
4649
4650 memcpy (start_of_FLASH, start_of_ROM, end_of_ROM - start_of_ROM);
4651 @end group
4652 @end smallexample
4653
4654 Note how using this method does not require the use of @samp{&}
4655 operators.
4656
4657 @node SECTIONS
4658 @section SECTIONS Command
4659 @kindex SECTIONS
4660 The @code{SECTIONS} command tells the linker how to map input sections
4661 into output sections, and how to place the output sections in memory.
4662
4663 The format of the @code{SECTIONS} command is:
4664 @smallexample
4665 SECTIONS
4666 @{
4667 @var{sections-command}
4668 @var{sections-command}
4669 @dots{}
4670 @}
4671 @end smallexample
4672
4673 Each @var{sections-command} may of be one of the following:
4674
4675 @itemize @bullet
4676 @item
4677 an @code{ENTRY} command (@pxref{Entry Point,,Entry command})
4678 @item
4679 a symbol assignment (@pxref{Assignments})
4680 @item
4681 an output section description
4682 @item
4683 an overlay description
4684 @end itemize
4685
4686 The @code{ENTRY} command and symbol assignments are permitted inside the
4687 @code{SECTIONS} command for convenience in using the location counter in
4688 those commands. This can also make the linker script easier to
4689 understand because you can use those commands at meaningful points in
4690 the layout of the output file.
4691
4692 Output section descriptions and overlay descriptions are described
4693 below.
4694
4695 If you do not use a @code{SECTIONS} command in your linker script, the
4696 linker will place each input section into an identically named output
4697 section in the order that the sections are first encountered in the
4698 input files. If all input sections are present in the first file, for
4699 example, the order of sections in the output file will match the order
4700 in the first input file. The first section will be at address zero.
4701
4702 @menu
4703 * Output Section Description:: Output section description
4704 * Output Section Name:: Output section name
4705 * Output Section Address:: Output section address
4706 * Input Section:: Input section description
4707 * Output Section Data:: Output section data
4708 * Output Section Keywords:: Output section keywords
4709 * Output Section Discarding:: Output section discarding
4710 * Output Section Attributes:: Output section attributes
4711 * Overlay Description:: Overlay description
4712 @end menu
4713
4714 @node Output Section Description
4715 @subsection Output Section Description
4716 The full description of an output section looks like this:
4717 @smallexample
4718 @group
4719 @var{section} [@var{address}] [(@var{type})] :
4720 [AT(@var{lma})]
4721 [ALIGN(@var{section_align}) | ALIGN_WITH_INPUT]
4722 [SUBALIGN(@var{subsection_align})]
4723 [@var{constraint}]
4724 @{
4725 @var{output-section-command}
4726 @var{output-section-command}
4727 @dots{}
4728 @} [>@var{region}] [AT>@var{lma_region}] [:@var{phdr} :@var{phdr} @dots{}] [=@var{fillexp}] [,]
4729 @end group
4730 @end smallexample
4731
4732 Most output sections do not use most of the optional section attributes.
4733
4734 The whitespace around @var{section} is required, so that the section
4735 name is unambiguous. The colon and the curly braces are also required.
4736 The comma at the end may be required if a @var{fillexp} is used and
4737 the next @var{sections-command} looks like a continuation of the expression.
4738 The line breaks and other white space are optional.
4739
4740 Each @var{output-section-command} may be one of the following:
4741
4742 @itemize @bullet
4743 @item
4744 a symbol assignment (@pxref{Assignments})
4745 @item
4746 an input section description (@pxref{Input Section})
4747 @item
4748 data values to include directly (@pxref{Output Section Data})
4749 @item
4750 a special output section keyword (@pxref{Output Section Keywords})
4751 @end itemize
4752
4753 @node Output Section Name
4754 @subsection Output Section Name
4755 @cindex name, section
4756 @cindex section name
4757 The name of the output section is @var{section}. @var{section} must
4758 meet the constraints of your output format. In formats which only
4759 support a limited number of sections, such as @code{a.out}, the name
4760 must be one of the names supported by the format (@code{a.out}, for
4761 example, allows only @samp{.text}, @samp{.data} or @samp{.bss}). If the
4762 output format supports any number of sections, but with numbers and not
4763 names (as is the case for Oasys), the name should be supplied as a
4764 quoted numeric string. A section name may consist of any sequence of
4765 characters, but a name which contains any unusual characters such as
4766 commas must be quoted.
4767
4768 The output section name @samp{/DISCARD/} is special; @ref{Output Section
4769 Discarding}.
4770
4771 @node Output Section Address
4772 @subsection Output Section Address
4773 @cindex address, section
4774 @cindex section address
4775 The @var{address} is an expression for the VMA (the virtual memory
4776 address) of the output section. This address is optional, but if it
4777 is provided then the output address will be set exactly as specified.
4778
4779 If the output address is not specified then one will be chosen for the
4780 section, based on the heuristic below. This address will be adjusted
4781 to fit the alignment requirement of the output section. The
4782 alignment requirement is the strictest alignment of any input section
4783 contained within the output section.
4784
4785 The output section address heuristic is as follows:
4786
4787 @itemize @bullet
4788 @item
4789 If an output memory @var{region} is set for the section then it
4790 is added to this region and its address will be the next free address
4791 in that region.
4792
4793 @item
4794 If the MEMORY command has been used to create a list of memory
4795 regions then the first region which has attributes compatible with the
4796 section is selected to contain it. The section's output address will
4797 be the next free address in that region; @ref{MEMORY}.
4798
4799 @item
4800 If no memory regions were specified, or none match the section then
4801 the output address will be based on the current value of the location
4802 counter.
4803 @end itemize
4804
4805 @noindent
4806 For example:
4807
4808 @smallexample
4809 .text . : @{ *(.text) @}
4810 @end smallexample
4811
4812 @noindent
4813 and
4814
4815 @smallexample
4816 .text : @{ *(.text) @}
4817 @end smallexample
4818
4819 @noindent
4820 are subtly different. The first will set the address of the
4821 @samp{.text} output section to the current value of the location
4822 counter. The second will set it to the current value of the location
4823 counter aligned to the strictest alignment of any of the @samp{.text}
4824 input sections.
4825
4826 The @var{address} may be an arbitrary expression; @ref{Expressions}.
4827 For example, if you want to align the section on a 0x10 byte boundary,
4828 so that the lowest four bits of the section address are zero, you could
4829 do something like this:
4830 @smallexample
4831 .text ALIGN(0x10) : @{ *(.text) @}
4832 @end smallexample
4833 @noindent
4834 This works because @code{ALIGN} returns the current location counter
4835 aligned upward to the specified value.
4836
4837 Specifying @var{address} for a section will change the value of the
4838 location counter, provided that the section is non-empty. (Empty
4839 sections are ignored).
4840
4841 @node Input Section
4842 @subsection Input Section Description
4843 @cindex input sections
4844 @cindex mapping input sections to output sections
4845 The most common output section command is an input section description.
4846
4847 The input section description is the most basic linker script operation.
4848 You use output sections to tell the linker how to lay out your program
4849 in memory. You use input section descriptions to tell the linker how to
4850 map the input files into your memory layout.
4851
4852 @menu
4853 * Input Section Basics:: Input section basics
4854 * Input Section Wildcards:: Input section wildcard patterns
4855 * Input Section Common:: Input section for common symbols
4856 * Input Section Keep:: Input section and garbage collection
4857 * Input Section Example:: Input section example
4858 @end menu
4859
4860 @node Input Section Basics
4861 @subsubsection Input Section Basics
4862 @cindex input section basics
4863 An input section description consists of a file name optionally followed
4864 by a list of section names in parentheses.
4865
4866 The file name and the section name may be wildcard patterns, which we
4867 describe further below (@pxref{Input Section Wildcards}).
4868
4869 The most common input section description is to include all input
4870 sections with a particular name in the output section. For example, to
4871 include all input @samp{.text} sections, you would write:
4872 @smallexample
4873 *(.text)
4874 @end smallexample
4875 @noindent
4876 Here the @samp{*} is a wildcard which matches any file name. To exclude a list
4877 @cindex EXCLUDE_FILE
4878 of files from matching the file name wildcard, EXCLUDE_FILE may be used to
4879 match all files except the ones specified in the EXCLUDE_FILE list. For
4880 example:
4881 @smallexample
4882 EXCLUDE_FILE (*crtend.o *otherfile.o) *(.ctors)
4883 @end smallexample
4884 @noindent
4885 will cause all .ctors sections from all files except @file{crtend.o}
4886 and @file{otherfile.o} to be included. The EXCLUDE_FILE can also be
4887 placed inside the section list, for example:
4888 @smallexample
4889 *(EXCLUDE_FILE (*crtend.o *otherfile.o) .ctors)
4890 @end smallexample
4891 @noindent
4892 The result of this is identically to the previous example. Supporting
4893 two syntaxes for EXCLUDE_FILE is useful if the section list contains
4894 more than one section, as described below.
4895
4896 There are two ways to include more than one section:
4897 @smallexample
4898 *(.text .rdata)
4899 *(.text) *(.rdata)
4900 @end smallexample
4901 @noindent
4902 The difference between these is the order in which the @samp{.text} and
4903 @samp{.rdata} input sections will appear in the output section. In the
4904 first example, they will be intermingled, appearing in the same order as
4905 they are found in the linker input. In the second example, all
4906 @samp{.text} input sections will appear first, followed by all
4907 @samp{.rdata} input sections.
4908
4909 When using EXCLUDE_FILE with more than one section, if the exclusion
4910 is within the section list then the exclusion only applies to the
4911 immediately following section, for example:
4912 @smallexample
4913 *(EXCLUDE_FILE (*somefile.o) .text .rdata)
4914 @end smallexample
4915 @noindent
4916 will cause all @samp{.text} sections from all files except
4917 @file{somefile.o} to be included, while all @samp{.rdata} sections
4918 from all files, including @file{somefile.o}, will be included. To
4919 exclude the @samp{.rdata} sections from @file{somefile.o} the example
4920 could be modified to:
4921 @smallexample
4922 *(EXCLUDE_FILE (*somefile.o) .text EXCLUDE_FILE (*somefile.o) .rdata)
4923 @end smallexample
4924 @noindent
4925 Alternatively, placing the EXCLUDE_FILE outside of the section list,
4926 before the input file selection, will cause the exclusion to apply for
4927 all sections. Thus the previous example can be rewritten as:
4928 @smallexample
4929 EXCLUDE_FILE (*somefile.o) *(.text .rdata)
4930 @end smallexample
4931
4932 You can specify a file name to include sections from a particular file.
4933 You would do this if one or more of your files contain special data that
4934 needs to be at a particular location in memory. For example:
4935 @smallexample
4936 data.o(.data)
4937 @end smallexample
4938
4939 To refine the sections that are included based on the section flags
4940 of an input section, INPUT_SECTION_FLAGS may be used.
4941
4942 Here is a simple example for using Section header flags for ELF sections:
4943
4944 @smallexample
4945 @group
4946 SECTIONS @{
4947 .text : @{ INPUT_SECTION_FLAGS (SHF_MERGE & SHF_STRINGS) *(.text) @}
4948 .text2 : @{ INPUT_SECTION_FLAGS (!SHF_WRITE) *(.text) @}
4949 @}
4950 @end group
4951 @end smallexample
4952
4953 In this example, the output section @samp{.text} will be comprised of any
4954 input section matching the name *(.text) whose section header flags
4955 @code{SHF_MERGE} and @code{SHF_STRINGS} are set. The output section
4956 @samp{.text2} will be comprised of any input section matching the name *(.text)
4957 whose section header flag @code{SHF_WRITE} is clear.
4958
4959 You can also specify files within archives by writing a pattern
4960 matching the archive, a colon, then the pattern matching the file,
4961 with no whitespace around the colon.
4962
4963 @table @samp
4964 @item archive:file
4965 matches file within archive
4966 @item archive:
4967 matches the whole archive
4968 @item :file
4969 matches file but not one in an archive
4970 @end table
4971
4972 Either one or both of @samp{archive} and @samp{file} can contain shell
4973 wildcards. On DOS based file systems, the linker will assume that a
4974 single letter followed by a colon is a drive specifier, so
4975 @samp{c:myfile.o} is a simple file specification, not @samp{myfile.o}
4976 within an archive called @samp{c}. @samp{archive:file} filespecs may
4977 also be used within an @code{EXCLUDE_FILE} list, but may not appear in
4978 other linker script contexts. For instance, you cannot extract a file
4979 from an archive by using @samp{archive:file} in an @code{INPUT}
4980 command.
4981
4982 If you use a file name without a list of sections, then all sections in
4983 the input file will be included in the output section. This is not
4984 commonly done, but it may by useful on occasion. For example:
4985 @smallexample
4986 data.o
4987 @end smallexample
4988
4989 When you use a file name which is not an @samp{archive:file} specifier
4990 and does not contain any wild card
4991 characters, the linker will first see if you also specified the file
4992 name on the linker command line or in an @code{INPUT} command. If you
4993 did not, the linker will attempt to open the file as an input file, as
4994 though it appeared on the command line. Note that this differs from an
4995 @code{INPUT} command, because the linker will not search for the file in
4996 the archive search path.
4997
4998 @node Input Section Wildcards
4999 @subsubsection Input Section Wildcard Patterns
5000 @cindex input section wildcards
5001 @cindex wildcard file name patterns
5002 @cindex file name wildcard patterns
5003 @cindex section name wildcard patterns
5004 In an input section description, either the file name or the section
5005 name or both may be wildcard patterns.
5006
5007 The file name of @samp{*} seen in many examples is a simple wildcard
5008 pattern for the file name.
5009
5010 The wildcard patterns are like those used by the Unix shell.
5011
5012 @table @samp
5013 @item *
5014 matches any number of characters
5015 @item ?
5016 matches any single character
5017 @item [@var{chars}]
5018 matches a single instance of any of the @var{chars}; the @samp{-}
5019 character may be used to specify a range of characters, as in
5020 @samp{[a-z]} to match any lower case letter
5021 @item \
5022 quotes the following character
5023 @end table
5024
5025 When a file name is matched with a wildcard, the wildcard characters
5026 will not match a @samp{/} character (used to separate directory names on
5027 Unix). A pattern consisting of a single @samp{*} character is an
5028 exception; it will always match any file name, whether it contains a
5029 @samp{/} or not. In a section name, the wildcard characters will match
5030 a @samp{/} character.
5031
5032 File name wildcard patterns only match files which are explicitly
5033 specified on the command line or in an @code{INPUT} command. The linker
5034 does not search directories to expand wildcards.
5035
5036 If a file name matches more than one wildcard pattern, or if a file name
5037 appears explicitly and is also matched by a wildcard pattern, the linker
5038 will use the first match in the linker script. For example, this
5039 sequence of input section descriptions is probably in error, because the
5040 @file{data.o} rule will not be used:
5041 @smallexample
5042 .data : @{ *(.data) @}
5043 .data1 : @{ data.o(.data) @}
5044 @end smallexample
5045
5046 @cindex SORT_BY_NAME
5047 Normally, the linker will place files and sections matched by wildcards
5048 in the order in which they are seen during the link. You can change
5049 this by using the @code{SORT_BY_NAME} keyword, which appears before a wildcard
5050 pattern in parentheses (e.g., @code{SORT_BY_NAME(.text*)}). When the
5051 @code{SORT_BY_NAME} keyword is used, the linker will sort the files or sections
5052 into ascending order by name before placing them in the output file.
5053
5054 @cindex SORT_BY_ALIGNMENT
5055 @code{SORT_BY_ALIGNMENT} is similar to @code{SORT_BY_NAME}.
5056 @code{SORT_BY_ALIGNMENT} will sort sections into descending order of
5057 alignment before placing them in the output file. Placing larger
5058 alignments before smaller alignments can reduce the amount of padding
5059 needed.
5060
5061 @cindex SORT_BY_INIT_PRIORITY
5062 @code{SORT_BY_INIT_PRIORITY} is also similar to @code{SORT_BY_NAME}.
5063 @code{SORT_BY_INIT_PRIORITY} will sort sections into ascending
5064 numerical order of the GCC init_priority attribute encoded in the
5065 section name before placing them in the output file. In
5066 @code{.init_array.NNNNN} and @code{.fini_array.NNNNN}, @code{NNNNN} is
5067 the init_priority. In @code{.ctors.NNNNN} and @code{.dtors.NNNNN},
5068 @code{NNNNN} is 65535 minus the init_priority.
5069
5070 @cindex SORT
5071 @code{SORT} is an alias for @code{SORT_BY_NAME}.
5072
5073 When there are nested section sorting commands in linker script, there
5074 can be at most 1 level of nesting for section sorting commands.
5075
5076 @enumerate
5077 @item
5078 @code{SORT_BY_NAME} (@code{SORT_BY_ALIGNMENT} (wildcard section pattern)).
5079 It will sort the input sections by name first, then by alignment if two
5080 sections have the same name.
5081 @item
5082 @code{SORT_BY_ALIGNMENT} (@code{SORT_BY_NAME} (wildcard section pattern)).
5083 It will sort the input sections by alignment first, then by name if two
5084 sections have the same alignment.
5085 @item
5086 @code{SORT_BY_NAME} (@code{SORT_BY_NAME} (wildcard section pattern)) is
5087 treated the same as @code{SORT_BY_NAME} (wildcard section pattern).
5088 @item
5089 @code{SORT_BY_ALIGNMENT} (@code{SORT_BY_ALIGNMENT} (wildcard section pattern))
5090 is treated the same as @code{SORT_BY_ALIGNMENT} (wildcard section pattern).
5091 @item
5092 All other nested section sorting commands are invalid.
5093 @end enumerate
5094
5095 When both command-line section sorting option and linker script
5096 section sorting command are used, section sorting command always
5097 takes precedence over the command-line option.
5098
5099 If the section sorting command in linker script isn't nested, the
5100 command-line option will make the section sorting command to be
5101 treated as nested sorting command.
5102
5103 @enumerate
5104 @item
5105 @code{SORT_BY_NAME} (wildcard section pattern ) with
5106 @option{--sort-sections alignment} is equivalent to
5107 @code{SORT_BY_NAME} (@code{SORT_BY_ALIGNMENT} (wildcard section pattern)).
5108 @item
5109 @code{SORT_BY_ALIGNMENT} (wildcard section pattern) with
5110 @option{--sort-section name} is equivalent to
5111 @code{SORT_BY_ALIGNMENT} (@code{SORT_BY_NAME} (wildcard section pattern)).
5112 @end enumerate
5113
5114 If the section sorting command in linker script is nested, the
5115 command-line option will be ignored.
5116
5117 @cindex SORT_NONE
5118 @code{SORT_NONE} disables section sorting by ignoring the command-line
5119 section sorting option.
5120
5121 If you ever get confused about where input sections are going, use the
5122 @samp{-M} linker option to generate a map file. The map file shows
5123 precisely how input sections are mapped to output sections.
5124
5125 This example shows how wildcard patterns might be used to partition
5126 files. This linker script directs the linker to place all @samp{.text}
5127 sections in @samp{.text} and all @samp{.bss} sections in @samp{.bss}.
5128 The linker will place the @samp{.data} section from all files beginning
5129 with an upper case character in @samp{.DATA}; for all other files, the
5130 linker will place the @samp{.data} section in @samp{.data}.
5131 @smallexample
5132 @group
5133 SECTIONS @{
5134 .text : @{ *(.text) @}
5135 .DATA : @{ [A-Z]*(.data) @}
5136 .data : @{ *(.data) @}
5137 .bss : @{ *(.bss) @}
5138 @}
5139 @end group
5140 @end smallexample
5141
5142 @node Input Section Common
5143 @subsubsection Input Section for Common Symbols
5144 @cindex common symbol placement
5145 @cindex uninitialized data placement
5146 A special notation is needed for common symbols, because in many object
5147 file formats common symbols do not have a particular input section. The
5148 linker treats common symbols as though they are in an input section
5149 named @samp{COMMON}.
5150
5151 You may use file names with the @samp{COMMON} section just as with any
5152 other input sections. You can use this to place common symbols from a
5153 particular input file in one section while common symbols from other
5154 input files are placed in another section.
5155
5156 In most cases, common symbols in input files will be placed in the
5157 @samp{.bss} section in the output file. For example:
5158 @smallexample
5159 .bss @{ *(.bss) *(COMMON) @}
5160 @end smallexample
5161
5162 @cindex scommon section
5163 @cindex small common symbols
5164 Some object file formats have more than one type of common symbol. For
5165 example, the MIPS ELF object file format distinguishes standard common
5166 symbols and small common symbols. In this case, the linker will use a
5167 different special section name for other types of common symbols. In
5168 the case of MIPS ELF, the linker uses @samp{COMMON} for standard common
5169 symbols and @samp{.scommon} for small common symbols. This permits you
5170 to map the different types of common symbols into memory at different
5171 locations.
5172
5173 @cindex [COMMON]
5174 You will sometimes see @samp{[COMMON]} in old linker scripts. This
5175 notation is now considered obsolete. It is equivalent to
5176 @samp{*(COMMON)}.
5177
5178 @node Input Section Keep
5179 @subsubsection Input Section and Garbage Collection
5180 @cindex KEEP
5181 @cindex garbage collection
5182 When link-time garbage collection is in use (@samp{--gc-sections}),
5183 it is often useful to mark sections that should not be eliminated.
5184 This is accomplished by surrounding an input section's wildcard entry
5185 with @code{KEEP()}, as in @code{KEEP(*(.init))} or
5186 @code{KEEP(SORT_BY_NAME(*)(.ctors))}.
5187
5188 @node Input Section Example
5189 @subsubsection Input Section Example
5190 The following example is a complete linker script. It tells the linker
5191 to read all of the sections from file @file{all.o} and place them at the
5192 start of output section @samp{outputa} which starts at location
5193 @samp{0x10000}. All of section @samp{.input1} from file @file{foo.o}
5194 follows immediately, in the same output section. All of section
5195 @samp{.input2} from @file{foo.o} goes into output section
5196 @samp{outputb}, followed by section @samp{.input1} from @file{foo1.o}.
5197 All of the remaining @samp{.input1} and @samp{.input2} sections from any
5198 files are written to output section @samp{outputc}.
5199
5200 @smallexample
5201 @group
5202 SECTIONS @{
5203 outputa 0x10000 :
5204 @{
5205 all.o
5206 foo.o (.input1)
5207 @}
5208 @end group
5209 @group
5210 outputb :
5211 @{
5212 foo.o (.input2)
5213 foo1.o (.input1)
5214 @}
5215 @end group
5216 @group
5217 outputc :
5218 @{
5219 *(.input1)
5220 *(.input2)
5221 @}
5222 @}
5223 @end group
5224 @end smallexample
5225
5226 If an output section's name is the same as the input section's name
5227 and is representable as a C identifier, then the linker will
5228 automatically @pxref{PROVIDE} two symbols: __start_SECNAME and
5229 __stop_SECNAME, where SECNAME is the name of the section. These
5230 indicate the start address and end address of the output section
5231 respectively. Note: most section names are not representable as
5232 C identifiers because they contain a @samp{.} character.
5233
5234 @node Output Section Data
5235 @subsection Output Section Data
5236 @cindex data
5237 @cindex section data
5238 @cindex output section data
5239 @kindex BYTE(@var{expression})
5240 @kindex SHORT(@var{expression})
5241 @kindex LONG(@var{expression})
5242 @kindex QUAD(@var{expression})
5243 @kindex SQUAD(@var{expression})
5244 You can include explicit bytes of data in an output section by using
5245 @code{BYTE}, @code{SHORT}, @code{LONG}, @code{QUAD}, or @code{SQUAD} as
5246 an output section command. Each keyword is followed by an expression in
5247 parentheses providing the value to store (@pxref{Expressions}). The
5248 value of the expression is stored at the current value of the location
5249 counter.
5250
5251 The @code{BYTE}, @code{SHORT}, @code{LONG}, and @code{QUAD} commands
5252 store one, two, four, and eight bytes (respectively). After storing the
5253 bytes, the location counter is incremented by the number of bytes
5254 stored.
5255
5256 For example, this will store the byte 1 followed by the four byte value
5257 of the symbol @samp{addr}:
5258 @smallexample
5259 BYTE(1)
5260 LONG(addr)
5261 @end smallexample
5262
5263 When using a 64 bit host or target, @code{QUAD} and @code{SQUAD} are the
5264 same; they both store an 8 byte, or 64 bit, value. When both host and
5265 target are 32 bits, an expression is computed as 32 bits. In this case
5266 @code{QUAD} stores a 32 bit value zero extended to 64 bits, and
5267 @code{SQUAD} stores a 32 bit value sign extended to 64 bits.
5268
5269 If the object file format of the output file has an explicit endianness,
5270 which is the normal case, the value will be stored in that endianness.
5271 When the object file format does not have an explicit endianness, as is
5272 true of, for example, S-records, the value will be stored in the
5273 endianness of the first input object file.
5274
5275 Note---these commands only work inside a section description and not
5276 between them, so the following will produce an error from the linker:
5277 @smallexample
5278 SECTIONS @{@ .text : @{@ *(.text) @}@ LONG(1) .data : @{@ *(.data) @}@ @}@
5279 @end smallexample
5280 whereas this will work:
5281 @smallexample
5282 SECTIONS @{@ .text : @{@ *(.text) ; LONG(1) @}@ .data : @{@ *(.data) @}@ @}@
5283 @end smallexample
5284
5285 @kindex FILL(@var{expression})
5286 @cindex holes, filling
5287 @cindex unspecified memory
5288 You may use the @code{FILL} command to set the fill pattern for the
5289 current section. It is followed by an expression in parentheses. Any
5290 otherwise unspecified regions of memory within the section (for example,
5291 gaps left due to the required alignment of input sections) are filled
5292 with the value of the expression, repeated as
5293 necessary. A @code{FILL} statement covers memory locations after the
5294 point at which it occurs in the section definition; by including more
5295 than one @code{FILL} statement, you can have different fill patterns in
5296 different parts of an output section.
5297
5298 This example shows how to fill unspecified regions of memory with the
5299 value @samp{0x90}:
5300 @smallexample
5301 FILL(0x90909090)
5302 @end smallexample
5303
5304 The @code{FILL} command is similar to the @samp{=@var{fillexp}} output
5305 section attribute, but it only affects the
5306 part of the section following the @code{FILL} command, rather than the
5307 entire section. If both are used, the @code{FILL} command takes
5308 precedence. @xref{Output Section Fill}, for details on the fill
5309 expression.
5310
5311 @node Output Section Keywords
5312 @subsection Output Section Keywords
5313 There are a couple of keywords which can appear as output section
5314 commands.
5315
5316 @table @code
5317 @kindex CREATE_OBJECT_SYMBOLS
5318 @cindex input filename symbols
5319 @cindex filename symbols
5320 @item CREATE_OBJECT_SYMBOLS
5321 The command tells the linker to create a symbol for each input file.
5322 The name of each symbol will be the name of the corresponding input
5323 file. The section of each symbol will be the output section in which
5324 the @code{CREATE_OBJECT_SYMBOLS} command appears.
5325
5326 This is conventional for the a.out object file format. It is not
5327 normally used for any other object file format.
5328
5329 @kindex CONSTRUCTORS
5330 @cindex C++ constructors, arranging in link
5331 @cindex constructors, arranging in link
5332 @item CONSTRUCTORS
5333 When linking using the a.out object file format, the linker uses an
5334 unusual set construct to support C++ global constructors and
5335 destructors. When linking object file formats which do not support
5336 arbitrary sections, such as ECOFF and XCOFF, the linker will
5337 automatically recognize C++ global constructors and destructors by name.
5338 For these object file formats, the @code{CONSTRUCTORS} command tells the
5339 linker to place constructor information in the output section where the
5340 @code{CONSTRUCTORS} command appears. The @code{CONSTRUCTORS} command is
5341 ignored for other object file formats.
5342
5343 The symbol @w{@code{__CTOR_LIST__}} marks the start of the global
5344 constructors, and the symbol @w{@code{__CTOR_END__}} marks the end.
5345 Similarly, @w{@code{__DTOR_LIST__}} and @w{@code{__DTOR_END__}} mark
5346 the start and end of the global destructors. The
5347 first word in the list is the number of entries, followed by the address
5348 of each constructor or destructor, followed by a zero word. The
5349 compiler must arrange to actually run the code. For these object file
5350 formats @sc{gnu} C++ normally calls constructors from a subroutine
5351 @code{__main}; a call to @code{__main} is automatically inserted into
5352 the startup code for @code{main}. @sc{gnu} C++ normally runs
5353 destructors either by using @code{atexit}, or directly from the function
5354 @code{exit}.
5355
5356 For object file formats such as @code{COFF} or @code{ELF} which support
5357 arbitrary section names, @sc{gnu} C++ will normally arrange to put the
5358 addresses of global constructors and destructors into the @code{.ctors}
5359 and @code{.dtors} sections. Placing the following sequence into your
5360 linker script will build the sort of table which the @sc{gnu} C++
5361 runtime code expects to see.
5362
5363 @smallexample
5364 __CTOR_LIST__ = .;
5365 LONG((__CTOR_END__ - __CTOR_LIST__) / 4 - 2)
5366 *(.ctors)
5367 LONG(0)
5368 __CTOR_END__ = .;
5369 __DTOR_LIST__ = .;
5370 LONG((__DTOR_END__ - __DTOR_LIST__) / 4 - 2)
5371 *(.dtors)
5372 LONG(0)
5373 __DTOR_END__ = .;
5374 @end smallexample
5375
5376 If you are using the @sc{gnu} C++ support for initialization priority,
5377 which provides some control over the order in which global constructors
5378 are run, you must sort the constructors at link time to ensure that they
5379 are executed in the correct order. When using the @code{CONSTRUCTORS}
5380 command, use @samp{SORT_BY_NAME(CONSTRUCTORS)} instead. When using the
5381 @code{.ctors} and @code{.dtors} sections, use @samp{*(SORT_BY_NAME(.ctors))} and
5382 @samp{*(SORT_BY_NAME(.dtors))} instead of just @samp{*(.ctors)} and
5383 @samp{*(.dtors)}.
5384
5385 Normally the compiler and linker will handle these issues automatically,
5386 and you will not need to concern yourself with them. However, you may
5387 need to consider this if you are using C++ and writing your own linker
5388 scripts.
5389
5390 @end table
5391
5392 @node Output Section Discarding
5393 @subsection Output Section Discarding
5394 @cindex discarding sections
5395 @cindex sections, discarding
5396 @cindex removing sections
5397 The linker will not normally create output sections with no contents.
5398 This is for convenience when referring to input sections that may or
5399 may not be present in any of the input files. For example:
5400 @smallexample
5401 .foo : @{ *(.foo) @}
5402 @end smallexample
5403 @noindent
5404 will only create a @samp{.foo} section in the output file if there is a
5405 @samp{.foo} section in at least one input file, and if the input
5406 sections are not all empty. Other link script directives that allocate
5407 space in an output section will also create the output section. So
5408 too will assignments to dot even if the assignment does not create
5409 space, except for @samp{. = 0}, @samp{. = . + 0}, @samp{. = sym},
5410 @samp{. = . + sym} and @samp{. = ALIGN (. != 0, expr, 1)} when
5411 @samp{sym} is an absolute symbol of value 0 defined in the script.
5412 This allows you to force output of an empty section with @samp{. = .}.
5413
5414 The linker will ignore address assignments (@pxref{Output Section Address})
5415 on discarded output sections, except when the linker script defines
5416 symbols in the output section. In that case the linker will obey
5417 the address assignments, possibly advancing dot even though the
5418 section is discarded.
5419
5420 @cindex /DISCARD/
5421 The special output section name @samp{/DISCARD/} may be used to discard
5422 input sections. Any input sections which are assigned to an output
5423 section named @samp{/DISCARD/} are not included in the output file.
5424
5425 This can be used to discard input sections marked with the ELF flag
5426 @code{SHF_GNU_RETAIN}, which would otherwise have been saved from linker
5427 garbage collection.
5428
5429 Note, sections that match the @samp{/DISCARD/} output section will be
5430 discarded even if they are in an ELF section group which has other
5431 members which are not being discarded. This is deliberate.
5432 Discarding takes precedence over grouping.
5433
5434 @node Output Section Attributes
5435 @subsection Output Section Attributes
5436 @cindex output section attributes
5437 We showed above that the full description of an output section looked
5438 like this:
5439
5440 @smallexample
5441 @group
5442 @var{section} [@var{address}] [(@var{type})] :
5443 [AT(@var{lma})]
5444 [ALIGN(@var{section_align}) | ALIGN_WITH_INPUT]
5445 [SUBALIGN(@var{subsection_align})]
5446 [@var{constraint}]
5447 @{
5448 @var{output-section-command}
5449 @var{output-section-command}
5450 @dots{}
5451 @} [>@var{region}] [AT>@var{lma_region}] [:@var{phdr} :@var{phdr} @dots{}] [=@var{fillexp}]
5452 @end group
5453 @end smallexample
5454
5455 We've already described @var{section}, @var{address}, and
5456 @var{output-section-command}. In this section we will describe the
5457 remaining section attributes.
5458
5459 @menu
5460 * Output Section Type:: Output section type
5461 * Output Section LMA:: Output section LMA
5462 * Forced Output Alignment:: Forced Output Alignment
5463 * Forced Input Alignment:: Forced Input Alignment
5464 * Output Section Constraint:: Output section constraint
5465 * Output Section Region:: Output section region
5466 * Output Section Phdr:: Output section phdr
5467 * Output Section Fill:: Output section fill
5468 @end menu
5469
5470 @node Output Section Type
5471 @subsubsection Output Section Type
5472 Each output section may have a type. The type is a keyword in
5473 parentheses. The following types are defined:
5474
5475 @table @code
5476 @item NOLOAD
5477 The section should be marked as not loadable, so that it will not be
5478 loaded into memory when the program is run.
5479 @item READONLY
5480 The section should be marked as read-only.
5481 @item DSECT
5482 @itemx COPY
5483 @itemx INFO
5484 @itemx OVERLAY
5485 These type names are supported for backward compatibility, and are
5486 rarely used. They all have the same effect: the section should be
5487 marked as not allocatable, so that no memory is allocated for the
5488 section when the program is run.
5489 @end table
5490
5491 @kindex NOLOAD
5492 @cindex prevent unnecessary loading
5493 @cindex loading, preventing
5494 The linker normally sets the attributes of an output section based on
5495 the input sections which map into it. You can override this by using
5496 the section type. For example, in the script sample below, the
5497 @samp{ROM} section is addressed at memory location @samp{0} and does not
5498 need to be loaded when the program is run.
5499 @smallexample
5500 @group
5501 SECTIONS @{
5502 ROM 0 (NOLOAD) : @{ @dots{} @}
5503 @dots{}
5504 @}
5505 @end group
5506 @end smallexample
5507
5508 @node Output Section LMA
5509 @subsubsection Output Section LMA
5510 @kindex AT>@var{lma_region}
5511 @kindex AT(@var{lma})
5512 @cindex load address
5513 @cindex section load address
5514 Every section has a virtual address (VMA) and a load address (LMA); see
5515 @ref{Basic Script Concepts}. The virtual address is specified by the
5516 @pxref{Output Section Address} described earlier. The load address is
5517 specified by the @code{AT} or @code{AT>} keywords. Specifying a load
5518 address is optional.
5519
5520 The @code{AT} keyword takes an expression as an argument. This
5521 specifies the exact load address of the section. The @code{AT>} keyword
5522 takes the name of a memory region as an argument. @xref{MEMORY}. The
5523 load address of the section is set to the next free address in the
5524 region, aligned to the section's alignment requirements.
5525
5526 If neither @code{AT} nor @code{AT>} is specified for an allocatable
5527 section, the linker will use the following heuristic to determine the
5528 load address:
5529
5530 @itemize @bullet
5531 @item
5532 If the section has a specific VMA address, then this is used as
5533 the LMA address as well.
5534
5535 @item
5536 If the section is not allocatable then its LMA is set to its VMA.
5537
5538 @item
5539 Otherwise if a memory region can be found that is compatible
5540 with the current section, and this region contains at least one
5541 section, then the LMA is set so the difference between the
5542 VMA and LMA is the same as the difference between the VMA and LMA of
5543 the last section in the located region.
5544
5545 @item
5546 If no memory regions have been declared then a default region
5547 that covers the entire address space is used in the previous step.
5548
5549 @item
5550 If no suitable region could be found, or there was no previous
5551 section then the LMA is set equal to the VMA.
5552 @end itemize
5553
5554 @cindex ROM initialized data
5555 @cindex initialized data in ROM
5556 This feature is designed to make it easy to build a ROM image. For
5557 example, the following linker script creates three output sections: one
5558 called @samp{.text}, which starts at @code{0x1000}, one called
5559 @samp{.mdata}, which is loaded at the end of the @samp{.text} section
5560 even though its VMA is @code{0x2000}, and one called @samp{.bss} to hold
5561 uninitialized data at address @code{0x3000}. The symbol @code{_data} is
5562 defined with the value @code{0x2000}, which shows that the location
5563 counter holds the VMA value, not the LMA value.
5564
5565 @smallexample
5566 @group
5567 SECTIONS
5568 @{
5569 .text 0x1000 : @{ *(.text) _etext = . ; @}
5570 .mdata 0x2000 :
5571 AT ( ADDR (.text) + SIZEOF (.text) )
5572 @{ _data = . ; *(.data); _edata = . ; @}
5573 .bss 0x3000 :
5574 @{ _bstart = . ; *(.bss) *(COMMON) ; _bend = . ;@}
5575 @}
5576 @end group
5577 @end smallexample
5578
5579 The run-time initialization code for use with a program generated with
5580 this linker script would include something like the following, to copy
5581 the initialized data from the ROM image to its runtime address. Notice
5582 how this code takes advantage of the symbols defined by the linker
5583 script.
5584
5585 @smallexample
5586 @group
5587 extern char _etext, _data, _edata, _bstart, _bend;
5588 char *src = &_etext;
5589 char *dst = &_data;
5590
5591 /* ROM has data at end of text; copy it. */
5592 while (dst < &_edata)
5593 *dst++ = *src++;
5594
5595 /* Zero bss. */
5596 for (dst = &_bstart; dst< &_bend; dst++)
5597 *dst = 0;
5598 @end group
5599 @end smallexample
5600
5601 @node Forced Output Alignment
5602 @subsubsection Forced Output Alignment
5603 @kindex ALIGN(@var{section_align})
5604 @cindex forcing output section alignment
5605 @cindex output section alignment
5606 You can increase an output section's alignment by using ALIGN. As an
5607 alternative you can enforce that the difference between the VMA and LMA remains
5608 intact throughout this output section with the ALIGN_WITH_INPUT attribute.
5609
5610 @node Forced Input Alignment
5611 @subsubsection Forced Input Alignment
5612 @kindex SUBALIGN(@var{subsection_align})
5613 @cindex forcing input section alignment
5614 @cindex input section alignment
5615 You can force input section alignment within an output section by using
5616 SUBALIGN. The value specified overrides any alignment given by input
5617 sections, whether larger or smaller.
5618
5619 @node Output Section Constraint
5620 @subsubsection Output Section Constraint
5621 @kindex ONLY_IF_RO
5622 @kindex ONLY_IF_RW
5623 @cindex constraints on output sections
5624 You can specify that an output section should only be created if all
5625 of its input sections are read-only or all of its input sections are
5626 read-write by using the keyword @code{ONLY_IF_RO} and
5627 @code{ONLY_IF_RW} respectively.
5628
5629 @node Output Section Region
5630 @subsubsection Output Section Region
5631 @kindex >@var{region}
5632 @cindex section, assigning to memory region
5633 @cindex memory regions and sections
5634 You can assign a section to a previously defined region of memory by
5635 using @samp{>@var{region}}. @xref{MEMORY}.
5636
5637 Here is a simple example:
5638 @smallexample
5639 @group
5640 MEMORY @{ rom : ORIGIN = 0x1000, LENGTH = 0x1000 @}
5641 SECTIONS @{ ROM : @{ *(.text) @} >rom @}
5642 @end group
5643 @end smallexample
5644
5645 @node Output Section Phdr
5646 @subsubsection Output Section Phdr
5647 @kindex :@var{phdr}
5648 @cindex section, assigning to program header
5649 @cindex program headers and sections
5650 You can assign a section to a previously defined program segment by
5651 using @samp{:@var{phdr}}. @xref{PHDRS}. If a section is assigned to
5652 one or more segments, then all subsequent allocated sections will be
5653 assigned to those segments as well, unless they use an explicitly
5654 @code{:@var{phdr}} modifier. You can use @code{:NONE} to tell the
5655 linker to not put the section in any segment at all.
5656
5657 Here is a simple example:
5658 @smallexample
5659 @group
5660 PHDRS @{ text PT_LOAD ; @}
5661 SECTIONS @{ .text : @{ *(.text) @} :text @}
5662 @end group
5663 @end smallexample
5664
5665 @node Output Section Fill
5666 @subsubsection Output Section Fill
5667 @kindex =@var{fillexp}
5668 @cindex section fill pattern
5669 @cindex fill pattern, entire section
5670 You can set the fill pattern for an entire section by using
5671 @samp{=@var{fillexp}}. @var{fillexp} is an expression
5672 (@pxref{Expressions}). Any otherwise unspecified regions of memory
5673 within the output section (for example, gaps left due to the required
5674 alignment of input sections) will be filled with the value, repeated as
5675 necessary. If the fill expression is a simple hex number, ie. a string
5676 of hex digit starting with @samp{0x} and without a trailing @samp{k} or @samp{M}, then
5677 an arbitrarily long sequence of hex digits can be used to specify the
5678 fill pattern; Leading zeros become part of the pattern too. For all
5679 other cases, including extra parentheses or a unary @code{+}, the fill
5680 pattern is the four least significant bytes of the value of the
5681 expression. In all cases, the number is big-endian.
5682
5683 You can also change the fill value with a @code{FILL} command in the
5684 output section commands; (@pxref{Output Section Data}).
5685
5686 Here is a simple example:
5687 @smallexample
5688 @group
5689 SECTIONS @{ .text : @{ *(.text) @} =0x90909090 @}
5690 @end group
5691 @end smallexample
5692
5693 @node Overlay Description
5694 @subsection Overlay Description
5695 @kindex OVERLAY
5696 @cindex overlays
5697 An overlay description provides an easy way to describe sections which
5698 are to be loaded as part of a single memory image but are to be run at
5699 the same memory address. At run time, some sort of overlay manager will
5700 copy the overlaid sections in and out of the runtime memory address as
5701 required, perhaps by simply manipulating addressing bits. This approach
5702 can be useful, for example, when a certain region of memory is faster
5703 than another.
5704
5705 Overlays are described using the @code{OVERLAY} command. The
5706 @code{OVERLAY} command is used within a @code{SECTIONS} command, like an
5707 output section description. The full syntax of the @code{OVERLAY}
5708 command is as follows:
5709 @smallexample
5710 @group
5711 OVERLAY [@var{start}] : [NOCROSSREFS] [AT ( @var{ldaddr} )]
5712 @{
5713 @var{secname1}
5714 @{
5715 @var{output-section-command}
5716 @var{output-section-command}
5717 @dots{}
5718 @} [:@var{phdr}@dots{}] [=@var{fill}]
5719 @var{secname2}
5720 @{
5721 @var{output-section-command}
5722 @var{output-section-command}
5723 @dots{}
5724 @} [:@var{phdr}@dots{}] [=@var{fill}]
5725 @dots{}
5726 @} [>@var{region}] [:@var{phdr}@dots{}] [=@var{fill}] [,]
5727 @end group
5728 @end smallexample
5729
5730 Everything is optional except @code{OVERLAY} (a keyword), and each
5731 section must have a name (@var{secname1} and @var{secname2} above). The
5732 section definitions within the @code{OVERLAY} construct are identical to
5733 those within the general @code{SECTIONS} construct (@pxref{SECTIONS}),
5734 except that no addresses and no memory regions may be defined for
5735 sections within an @code{OVERLAY}.
5736
5737 The comma at the end may be required if a @var{fill} is used and
5738 the next @var{sections-command} looks like a continuation of the expression.
5739
5740 The sections are all defined with the same starting address. The load
5741 addresses of the sections are arranged such that they are consecutive in
5742 memory starting at the load address used for the @code{OVERLAY} as a
5743 whole (as with normal section definitions, the load address is optional,
5744 and defaults to the start address; the start address is also optional,
5745 and defaults to the current value of the location counter).
5746
5747 If the @code{NOCROSSREFS} keyword is used, and there are any
5748 references among the sections, the linker will report an error. Since
5749 the sections all run at the same address, it normally does not make
5750 sense for one section to refer directly to another.
5751 @xref{Miscellaneous Commands, NOCROSSREFS}.
5752
5753 For each section within the @code{OVERLAY}, the linker automatically
5754 provides two symbols. The symbol @code{__load_start_@var{secname}} is
5755 defined as the starting load address of the section. The symbol
5756 @code{__load_stop_@var{secname}} is defined as the final load address of
5757 the section. Any characters within @var{secname} which are not legal
5758 within C identifiers are removed. C (or assembler) code may use these
5759 symbols to move the overlaid sections around as necessary.
5760
5761 At the end of the overlay, the value of the location counter is set to
5762 the start address of the overlay plus the size of the largest section.
5763
5764 Here is an example. Remember that this would appear inside a
5765 @code{SECTIONS} construct.
5766 @smallexample
5767 @group
5768 OVERLAY 0x1000 : AT (0x4000)
5769 @{
5770 .text0 @{ o1/*.o(.text) @}
5771 .text1 @{ o2/*.o(.text) @}
5772 @}
5773 @end group
5774 @end smallexample
5775 @noindent
5776 This will define both @samp{.text0} and @samp{.text1} to start at
5777 address 0x1000. @samp{.text0} will be loaded at address 0x4000, and
5778 @samp{.text1} will be loaded immediately after @samp{.text0}. The
5779 following symbols will be defined if referenced: @code{__load_start_text0},
5780 @code{__load_stop_text0}, @code{__load_start_text1},
5781 @code{__load_stop_text1}.
5782
5783 C code to copy overlay @code{.text1} into the overlay area might look
5784 like the following.
5785
5786 @smallexample
5787 @group
5788 extern char __load_start_text1, __load_stop_text1;
5789 memcpy ((char *) 0x1000, &__load_start_text1,
5790 &__load_stop_text1 - &__load_start_text1);
5791 @end group
5792 @end smallexample
5793
5794 Note that the @code{OVERLAY} command is just syntactic sugar, since
5795 everything it does can be done using the more basic commands. The above
5796 example could have been written identically as follows.
5797
5798 @smallexample
5799 @group
5800 .text0 0x1000 : AT (0x4000) @{ o1/*.o(.text) @}
5801 PROVIDE (__load_start_text0 = LOADADDR (.text0));
5802 PROVIDE (__load_stop_text0 = LOADADDR (.text0) + SIZEOF (.text0));
5803 .text1 0x1000 : AT (0x4000 + SIZEOF (.text0)) @{ o2/*.o(.text) @}
5804 PROVIDE (__load_start_text1 = LOADADDR (.text1));
5805 PROVIDE (__load_stop_text1 = LOADADDR (.text1) + SIZEOF (.text1));
5806 . = 0x1000 + MAX (SIZEOF (.text0), SIZEOF (.text1));
5807 @end group
5808 @end smallexample
5809
5810 @node MEMORY
5811 @section MEMORY Command
5812 @kindex MEMORY
5813 @cindex memory regions
5814 @cindex regions of memory
5815 @cindex allocating memory
5816 @cindex discontinuous memory
5817 The linker's default configuration permits allocation of all available
5818 memory. You can override this by using the @code{MEMORY} command.
5819
5820 The @code{MEMORY} command describes the location and size of blocks of
5821 memory in the target. You can use it to describe which memory regions
5822 may be used by the linker, and which memory regions it must avoid. You
5823 can then assign sections to particular memory regions. The linker will
5824 set section addresses based on the memory regions, and will warn about
5825 regions that become too full. The linker will not shuffle sections
5826 around to fit into the available regions.
5827
5828 A linker script may contain many uses of the @code{MEMORY} command,
5829 however, all memory blocks defined are treated as if they were
5830 specified inside a single @code{MEMORY} command. The syntax for
5831 @code{MEMORY} is:
5832 @smallexample
5833 @group
5834 MEMORY
5835 @{
5836 @var{name} [(@var{attr})] : ORIGIN = @var{origin}, LENGTH = @var{len}
5837 @dots{}
5838 @}
5839 @end group
5840 @end smallexample
5841
5842 The @var{name} is a name used in the linker script to refer to the
5843 region. The region name has no meaning outside of the linker script.
5844 Region names are stored in a separate name space, and will not conflict
5845 with symbol names, file names, or section names. Each memory region
5846 must have a distinct name within the @code{MEMORY} command. However you can
5847 add later alias names to existing memory regions with the @ref{REGION_ALIAS}
5848 command.
5849
5850 @cindex memory region attributes
5851 The @var{attr} string is an optional list of attributes that specify
5852 whether to use a particular memory region for an input section which is
5853 not explicitly mapped in the linker script. As described in
5854 @ref{SECTIONS}, if you do not specify an output section for some input
5855 section, the linker will create an output section with the same name as
5856 the input section. If you define region attributes, the linker will use
5857 them to select the memory region for the output section that it creates.
5858
5859 The @var{attr} string must consist only of the following characters:
5860 @table @samp
5861 @item R
5862 Read-only section
5863 @item W
5864 Read/write section
5865 @item X
5866 Executable section
5867 @item A
5868 Allocatable section
5869 @item I
5870 Initialized section
5871 @item L
5872 Same as @samp{I}
5873 @item !
5874 Invert the sense of any of the attributes that follow
5875 @end table
5876
5877 If an unmapped section matches any of the listed attributes other than
5878 @samp{!}, it will be placed in the memory region. The @samp{!}
5879 attribute reverses the test for the characters that follow, so that an
5880 unmapped section will be placed in the memory region only if it does
5881 not match any of the attributes listed afterwards. Thus an attribute
5882 string of @samp{RW!X} will match any unmapped section that has either
5883 or both of the @samp{R} and @samp{W} attributes, but only as long as
5884 the section does not also have the @samp{X} attribute.
5885
5886 @kindex ORIGIN =
5887 @kindex o =
5888 @kindex org =
5889 The @var{origin} is an numerical expression for the start address of
5890 the memory region. The expression must evaluate to a constant and it
5891 cannot involve any symbols. The keyword @code{ORIGIN} may be
5892 abbreviated to @code{org} or @code{o} (but not, for example,
5893 @code{ORG}).
5894
5895 @kindex LENGTH =
5896 @kindex len =
5897 @kindex l =
5898 The @var{len} is an expression for the size in bytes of the memory
5899 region. As with the @var{origin} expression, the expression must
5900 be numerical only and must evaluate to a constant. The keyword
5901 @code{LENGTH} may be abbreviated to @code{len} or @code{l}.
5902
5903 In the following example, we specify that there are two memory regions
5904 available for allocation: one starting at @samp{0} for 256 kilobytes,
5905 and the other starting at @samp{0x40000000} for four megabytes. The
5906 linker will place into the @samp{rom} memory region every section which
5907 is not explicitly mapped into a memory region, and is either read-only
5908 or executable. The linker will place other sections which are not
5909 explicitly mapped into a memory region into the @samp{ram} memory
5910 region.
5911
5912 @smallexample
5913 @group
5914 MEMORY
5915 @{
5916 rom (rx) : ORIGIN = 0, LENGTH = 256K
5917 ram (!rx) : org = 0x40000000, l = 4M
5918 @}
5919 @end group
5920 @end smallexample
5921
5922 Once you define a memory region, you can direct the linker to place
5923 specific output sections into that memory region by using the
5924 @samp{>@var{region}} output section attribute. For example, if you have
5925 a memory region named @samp{mem}, you would use @samp{>mem} in the
5926 output section definition. @xref{Output Section Region}. If no address
5927 was specified for the output section, the linker will set the address to
5928 the next available address within the memory region. If the combined
5929 output sections directed to a memory region are too large for the
5930 region, the linker will issue an error message.
5931
5932 It is possible to access the origin and length of a memory in an
5933 expression via the @code{ORIGIN(@var{memory})} and
5934 @code{LENGTH(@var{memory})} functions:
5935
5936 @smallexample
5937 @group
5938 _fstack = ORIGIN(ram) + LENGTH(ram) - 4;
5939 @end group
5940 @end smallexample
5941
5942 @node PHDRS
5943 @section PHDRS Command
5944 @kindex PHDRS
5945 @cindex program headers
5946 @cindex ELF program headers
5947 @cindex program segments
5948 @cindex segments, ELF
5949 The ELF object file format uses @dfn{program headers}, also knows as
5950 @dfn{segments}. The program headers describe how the program should be
5951 loaded into memory. You can print them out by using the @code{objdump}
5952 program with the @samp{-p} option.
5953
5954 When you run an ELF program on a native ELF system, the system loader
5955 reads the program headers in order to figure out how to load the
5956 program. This will only work if the program headers are set correctly.
5957 This manual does not describe the details of how the system loader
5958 interprets program headers; for more information, see the ELF ABI.
5959
5960 The linker will create reasonable program headers by default. However,
5961 in some cases, you may need to specify the program headers more
5962 precisely. You may use the @code{PHDRS} command for this purpose. When
5963 the linker sees the @code{PHDRS} command in the linker script, it will
5964 not create any program headers other than the ones specified.
5965
5966 The linker only pays attention to the @code{PHDRS} command when
5967 generating an ELF output file. In other cases, the linker will simply
5968 ignore @code{PHDRS}.
5969
5970 This is the syntax of the @code{PHDRS} command. The words @code{PHDRS},
5971 @code{FILEHDR}, @code{AT}, and @code{FLAGS} are keywords.
5972
5973 @smallexample
5974 @group
5975 PHDRS
5976 @{
5977 @var{name} @var{type} [ FILEHDR ] [ PHDRS ] [ AT ( @var{address} ) ]
5978 [ FLAGS ( @var{flags} ) ] ;
5979 @}
5980 @end group
5981 @end smallexample
5982
5983 The @var{name} is used only for reference in the @code{SECTIONS} command
5984 of the linker script. It is not put into the output file. Program
5985 header names are stored in a separate name space, and will not conflict
5986 with symbol names, file names, or section names. Each program header
5987 must have a distinct name. The headers are processed in order and it
5988 is usual for them to map to sections in ascending load address order.
5989
5990 Certain program header types describe segments of memory which the
5991 system loader will load from the file. In the linker script, you
5992 specify the contents of these segments by placing allocatable output
5993 sections in the segments. You use the @samp{:@var{phdr}} output section
5994 attribute to place a section in a particular segment. @xref{Output
5995 Section Phdr}.
5996
5997 It is normal to put certain sections in more than one segment. This
5998 merely implies that one segment of memory contains another. You may
5999 repeat @samp{:@var{phdr}}, using it once for each segment which should
6000 contain the section.
6001
6002 If you place a section in one or more segments using @samp{:@var{phdr}},
6003 then the linker will place all subsequent allocatable sections which do
6004 not specify @samp{:@var{phdr}} in the same segments. This is for
6005 convenience, since generally a whole set of contiguous sections will be
6006 placed in a single segment. You can use @code{:NONE} to override the
6007 default segment and tell the linker to not put the section in any
6008 segment at all.
6009
6010 @kindex FILEHDR
6011 @kindex PHDRS
6012 You may use the @code{FILEHDR} and @code{PHDRS} keywords after
6013 the program header type to further describe the contents of the segment.
6014 The @code{FILEHDR} keyword means that the segment should include the ELF
6015 file header. The @code{PHDRS} keyword means that the segment should
6016 include the ELF program headers themselves. If applied to a loadable
6017 segment (@code{PT_LOAD}), all prior loadable segments must have one of
6018 these keywords.
6019
6020 The @var{type} may be one of the following. The numbers indicate the
6021 value of the keyword.
6022
6023 @table @asis
6024 @item @code{PT_NULL} (0)
6025 Indicates an unused program header.
6026
6027 @item @code{PT_LOAD} (1)
6028 Indicates that this program header describes a segment to be loaded from
6029 the file.
6030
6031 @item @code{PT_DYNAMIC} (2)
6032 Indicates a segment where dynamic linking information can be found.
6033
6034 @item @code{PT_INTERP} (3)
6035 Indicates a segment where the name of the program interpreter may be
6036 found.
6037
6038 @item @code{PT_NOTE} (4)
6039 Indicates a segment holding note information.
6040
6041 @item @code{PT_SHLIB} (5)
6042 A reserved program header type, defined but not specified by the ELF
6043 ABI.
6044
6045 @item @code{PT_PHDR} (6)
6046 Indicates a segment where the program headers may be found.
6047
6048 @item @code{PT_TLS} (7)
6049 Indicates a segment containing thread local storage.
6050
6051 @item @var{expression}
6052 An expression giving the numeric type of the program header. This may
6053 be used for types not defined above.
6054 @end table
6055
6056 You can specify that a segment should be loaded at a particular address
6057 in memory by using an @code{AT} expression. This is identical to the
6058 @code{AT} command used as an output section attribute (@pxref{Output
6059 Section LMA}). The @code{AT} command for a program header overrides the
6060 output section attribute.
6061
6062 The linker will normally set the segment flags based on the sections
6063 which comprise the segment. You may use the @code{FLAGS} keyword to
6064 explicitly specify the segment flags. The value of @var{flags} must be
6065 an integer. It is used to set the @code{p_flags} field of the program
6066 header.
6067
6068 Here is an example of @code{PHDRS}. This shows a typical set of program
6069 headers used on a native ELF system.
6070
6071 @example
6072 @group
6073 PHDRS
6074 @{
6075 headers PT_PHDR PHDRS ;
6076 interp PT_INTERP ;
6077 text PT_LOAD FILEHDR PHDRS ;
6078 data PT_LOAD ;
6079 dynamic PT_DYNAMIC ;
6080 @}
6081
6082 SECTIONS
6083 @{
6084 . = SIZEOF_HEADERS;
6085 .interp : @{ *(.interp) @} :text :interp
6086 .text : @{ *(.text) @} :text
6087 .rodata : @{ *(.rodata) @} /* defaults to :text */
6088 @dots{}
6089 . = . + 0x1000; /* move to a new page in memory */
6090 .data : @{ *(.data) @} :data
6091 .dynamic : @{ *(.dynamic) @} :data :dynamic
6092 @dots{}
6093 @}
6094 @end group
6095 @end example
6096
6097 @node VERSION
6098 @section VERSION Command
6099 @kindex VERSION @{script text@}
6100 @cindex symbol versions
6101 @cindex version script
6102 @cindex versions of symbols
6103 The linker supports symbol versions when using ELF. Symbol versions are
6104 only useful when using shared libraries. The dynamic linker can use
6105 symbol versions to select a specific version of a function when it runs
6106 a program that may have been linked against an earlier version of the
6107 shared library.
6108
6109 You can include a version script directly in the main linker script, or
6110 you can supply the version script as an implicit linker script. You can
6111 also use the @samp{--version-script} linker option.
6112
6113 The syntax of the @code{VERSION} command is simply
6114 @smallexample
6115 VERSION @{ version-script-commands @}
6116 @end smallexample
6117
6118 The format of the version script commands is identical to that used by
6119 Sun's linker in Solaris 2.5. The version script defines a tree of
6120 version nodes. You specify the node names and interdependencies in the
6121 version script. You can specify which symbols are bound to which
6122 version nodes, and you can reduce a specified set of symbols to local
6123 scope so that they are not globally visible outside of the shared
6124 library.
6125
6126 The easiest way to demonstrate the version script language is with a few
6127 examples.
6128
6129 @smallexample
6130 VERS_1.1 @{
6131 global:
6132 foo1;
6133 local:
6134 old*;
6135 original*;
6136 new*;
6137 @};
6138
6139 VERS_1.2 @{
6140 foo2;
6141 @} VERS_1.1;
6142
6143 VERS_2.0 @{
6144 bar1; bar2;
6145 extern "C++" @{
6146 ns::*;
6147 "f(int, double)";
6148 @};
6149 @} VERS_1.2;
6150 @end smallexample
6151
6152 This example version script defines three version nodes. The first
6153 version node defined is @samp{VERS_1.1}; it has no other dependencies.
6154 The script binds the symbol @samp{foo1} to @samp{VERS_1.1}. It reduces
6155 a number of symbols to local scope so that they are not visible outside
6156 of the shared library; this is done using wildcard patterns, so that any
6157 symbol whose name begins with @samp{old}, @samp{original}, or @samp{new}
6158 is matched. The wildcard patterns available are the same as those used
6159 in the shell when matching filenames (also known as ``globbing'').
6160 However, if you specify the symbol name inside double quotes, then the
6161 name is treated as literal, rather than as a glob pattern.
6162
6163 Next, the version script defines node @samp{VERS_1.2}. This node
6164 depends upon @samp{VERS_1.1}. The script binds the symbol @samp{foo2}
6165 to the version node @samp{VERS_1.2}.
6166
6167 Finally, the version script defines node @samp{VERS_2.0}. This node
6168 depends upon @samp{VERS_1.2}. The scripts binds the symbols @samp{bar1}
6169 and @samp{bar2} are bound to the version node @samp{VERS_2.0}.
6170
6171 When the linker finds a symbol defined in a library which is not
6172 specifically bound to a version node, it will effectively bind it to an
6173 unspecified base version of the library. You can bind all otherwise
6174 unspecified symbols to a given version node by using @samp{global: *;}
6175 somewhere in the version script. Note that it's slightly crazy to use
6176 wildcards in a global spec except on the last version node. Global
6177 wildcards elsewhere run the risk of accidentally adding symbols to the
6178 set exported for an old version. That's wrong since older versions
6179 ought to have a fixed set of symbols.
6180
6181 The names of the version nodes have no specific meaning other than what
6182 they might suggest to the person reading them. The @samp{2.0} version
6183 could just as well have appeared in between @samp{1.1} and @samp{1.2}.
6184 However, this would be a confusing way to write a version script.
6185
6186 Node name can be omitted, provided it is the only version node
6187 in the version script. Such version script doesn't assign any versions to
6188 symbols, only selects which symbols will be globally visible out and which
6189 won't.
6190
6191 @smallexample
6192 @{ global: foo; bar; local: *; @};
6193 @end smallexample
6194
6195 When you link an application against a shared library that has versioned
6196 symbols, the application itself knows which version of each symbol it
6197 requires, and it also knows which version nodes it needs from each
6198 shared library it is linked against. Thus at runtime, the dynamic
6199 loader can make a quick check to make sure that the libraries you have
6200 linked against do in fact supply all of the version nodes that the
6201 application will need to resolve all of the dynamic symbols. In this
6202 way it is possible for the dynamic linker to know with certainty that
6203 all external symbols that it needs will be resolvable without having to
6204 search for each symbol reference.
6205
6206 The symbol versioning is in effect a much more sophisticated way of
6207 doing minor version checking that SunOS does. The fundamental problem
6208 that is being addressed here is that typically references to external
6209 functions are bound on an as-needed basis, and are not all bound when
6210 the application starts up. If a shared library is out of date, a
6211 required interface may be missing; when the application tries to use
6212 that interface, it may suddenly and unexpectedly fail. With symbol
6213 versioning, the user will get a warning when they start their program if
6214 the libraries being used with the application are too old.
6215
6216 There are several GNU extensions to Sun's versioning approach. The
6217 first of these is the ability to bind a symbol to a version node in the
6218 source file where the symbol is defined instead of in the versioning
6219 script. This was done mainly to reduce the burden on the library
6220 maintainer. You can do this by putting something like:
6221 @smallexample
6222 __asm__(".symver original_foo,foo@@VERS_1.1");
6223 @end smallexample
6224 @noindent
6225 in the C source file. This renames the function @samp{original_foo} to
6226 be an alias for @samp{foo} bound to the version node @samp{VERS_1.1}.
6227 The @samp{local:} directive can be used to prevent the symbol
6228 @samp{original_foo} from being exported. A @samp{.symver} directive
6229 takes precedence over a version script.
6230
6231 The second GNU extension is to allow multiple versions of the same
6232 function to appear in a given shared library. In this way you can make
6233 an incompatible change to an interface without increasing the major
6234 version number of the shared library, while still allowing applications
6235 linked against the old interface to continue to function.
6236
6237 To do this, you must use multiple @samp{.symver} directives in the
6238 source file. Here is an example:
6239
6240 @smallexample
6241 __asm__(".symver original_foo,foo@@");
6242 __asm__(".symver old_foo,foo@@VERS_1.1");
6243 __asm__(".symver old_foo1,foo@@VERS_1.2");
6244 __asm__(".symver new_foo,foo@@@@VERS_2.0");
6245 @end smallexample
6246
6247 In this example, @samp{foo@@} represents the symbol @samp{foo} bound to the
6248 unspecified base version of the symbol. The source file that contains this
6249 example would define 4 C functions: @samp{original_foo}, @samp{old_foo},
6250 @samp{old_foo1}, and @samp{new_foo}.
6251
6252 When you have multiple definitions of a given symbol, there needs to be
6253 some way to specify a default version to which external references to
6254 this symbol will be bound. You can do this with the
6255 @samp{foo@@@@VERS_2.0} type of @samp{.symver} directive. You can only
6256 declare one version of a symbol as the default in this manner; otherwise
6257 you would effectively have multiple definitions of the same symbol.
6258
6259 If you wish to bind a reference to a specific version of the symbol
6260 within the shared library, you can use the aliases of convenience
6261 (i.e., @samp{old_foo}), or you can use the @samp{.symver} directive to
6262 specifically bind to an external version of the function in question.
6263
6264 You can also specify the language in the version script:
6265
6266 @smallexample
6267 VERSION extern "lang" @{ version-script-commands @}
6268 @end smallexample
6269
6270 The supported @samp{lang}s are @samp{C}, @samp{C++}, and @samp{Java}.
6271 The linker will iterate over the list of symbols at the link time and
6272 demangle them according to @samp{lang} before matching them to the
6273 patterns specified in @samp{version-script-commands}. The default
6274 @samp{lang} is @samp{C}.
6275
6276 Demangled names may contains spaces and other special characters. As
6277 described above, you can use a glob pattern to match demangled names,
6278 or you can use a double-quoted string to match the string exactly. In
6279 the latter case, be aware that minor differences (such as differing
6280 whitespace) between the version script and the demangler output will
6281 cause a mismatch. As the exact string generated by the demangler
6282 might change in the future, even if the mangled name does not, you
6283 should check that all of your version directives are behaving as you
6284 expect when you upgrade.
6285
6286 @node Expressions
6287 @section Expressions in Linker Scripts
6288 @cindex expressions
6289 @cindex arithmetic
6290 The syntax for expressions in the linker script language is identical to
6291 that of C expressions, except that whitespace is required in some
6292 places to resolve syntactic ambiguities. All expressions are
6293 evaluated as integers. All expressions are evaluated in the same
6294 size, which is 32 bits if both the host and target are 32 bits, and is
6295 otherwise 64 bits.
6296
6297 You can use and set symbol values in expressions.
6298
6299 The linker defines several special purpose builtin functions for use in
6300 expressions.
6301
6302 @menu
6303 * Constants:: Constants
6304 * Symbolic Constants:: Symbolic constants
6305 * Symbols:: Symbol Names
6306 * Orphan Sections:: Orphan Sections
6307 * Location Counter:: The Location Counter
6308 * Operators:: Operators
6309 * Evaluation:: Evaluation
6310 * Expression Section:: The Section of an Expression
6311 * Builtin Functions:: Builtin Functions
6312 @end menu
6313
6314 @node Constants
6315 @subsection Constants
6316 @cindex integer notation
6317 @cindex constants in linker scripts
6318 All constants are integers.
6319
6320 As in C, the linker considers an integer beginning with @samp{0} to be
6321 octal, and an integer beginning with @samp{0x} or @samp{0X} to be
6322 hexadecimal. Alternatively the linker accepts suffixes of @samp{h} or
6323 @samp{H} for hexadecimal, @samp{o} or @samp{O} for octal, @samp{b} or
6324 @samp{B} for binary and @samp{d} or @samp{D} for decimal. Any integer
6325 value without a prefix or a suffix is considered to be decimal.
6326
6327 @cindex scaled integers
6328 @cindex K and M integer suffixes
6329 @cindex M and K integer suffixes
6330 @cindex suffixes for integers
6331 @cindex integer suffixes
6332 In addition, you can use the suffixes @code{K} and @code{M} to scale a
6333 constant by
6334 @c TEXI2ROFF-KILL
6335 @ifnottex
6336 @c END TEXI2ROFF-KILL
6337 @code{1024} or @code{1024*1024}
6338 @c TEXI2ROFF-KILL
6339 @end ifnottex
6340 @tex
6341 ${\rm 1024}$ or ${\rm 1024}^2$
6342 @end tex
6343 @c END TEXI2ROFF-KILL
6344 respectively. For example, the following
6345 all refer to the same quantity:
6346
6347 @smallexample
6348 _fourk_1 = 4K;
6349 _fourk_2 = 4096;
6350 _fourk_3 = 0x1000;
6351 _fourk_4 = 10000o;
6352 @end smallexample
6353
6354 Note - the @code{K} and @code{M} suffixes cannot be used in
6355 conjunction with the base suffixes mentioned above.
6356
6357 @node Symbolic Constants
6358 @subsection Symbolic Constants
6359 @cindex symbolic constants
6360 @kindex CONSTANT
6361 It is possible to refer to target-specific constants via the use of
6362 the @code{CONSTANT(@var{name})} operator, where @var{name} is one of:
6363
6364 @table @code
6365 @item MAXPAGESIZE
6366 @kindex MAXPAGESIZE
6367 The target's maximum page size.
6368
6369 @item COMMONPAGESIZE
6370 @kindex COMMONPAGESIZE
6371 The target's default page size.
6372 @end table
6373
6374 So for example:
6375
6376 @smallexample
6377 .text ALIGN (CONSTANT (MAXPAGESIZE)) : @{ *(.text) @}
6378 @end smallexample
6379
6380 will create a text section aligned to the largest page boundary
6381 supported by the target.
6382
6383 @node Symbols
6384 @subsection Symbol Names
6385 @cindex symbol names
6386 @cindex names
6387 @cindex quoted symbol names
6388 @kindex "
6389 Unless quoted, symbol names start with a letter, underscore, or period
6390 and may include letters, digits, underscores, periods, and hyphens.
6391 Unquoted symbol names must not conflict with any keywords. You can
6392 specify a symbol which contains odd characters or has the same name as a
6393 keyword by surrounding the symbol name in double quotes:
6394 @smallexample
6395 "SECTION" = 9;
6396 "with a space" = "also with a space" + 10;
6397 @end smallexample
6398
6399 Since symbols can contain many non-alphabetic characters, it is safest
6400 to delimit symbols with spaces. For example, @samp{A-B} is one symbol,
6401 whereas @samp{A - B} is an expression involving subtraction.
6402
6403 @node Orphan Sections
6404 @subsection Orphan Sections
6405 @cindex orphan
6406 Orphan sections are sections present in the input files which
6407 are not explicitly placed into the output file by the linker
6408 script. The linker will still copy these sections into the
6409 output file by either finding, or creating a suitable output section
6410 in which to place the orphaned input section.
6411
6412 If the name of an orphaned input section exactly matches the name of
6413 an existing output section, then the orphaned input section will be
6414 placed at the end of that output section.
6415
6416 If there is no output section with a matching name then new output
6417 sections will be created. Each new output section will have the same
6418 name as the orphan section placed within it. If there are multiple
6419 orphan sections with the same name, these will all be combined into
6420 one new output section.
6421
6422 If new output sections are created to hold orphaned input sections,
6423 then the linker must decide where to place these new output sections
6424 in relation to existing output sections. On most modern targets, the
6425 linker attempts to place orphan sections after sections of the same
6426 attribute, such as code vs data, loadable vs non-loadable, etc. If no
6427 sections with matching attributes are found, or your target lacks this
6428 support, the orphan section is placed at the end of the file.
6429
6430 The command-line options @samp{--orphan-handling} and @samp{--unique}
6431 (@pxref{Options,,Command-line Options}) can be used to control which
6432 output sections an orphan is placed in.
6433
6434 @node Location Counter
6435 @subsection The Location Counter
6436 @kindex .
6437 @cindex dot
6438 @cindex location counter
6439 @cindex current output location
6440 The special linker variable @dfn{dot} @samp{.} always contains the
6441 current output location counter. Since the @code{.} always refers to a
6442 location in an output section, it may only appear in an expression
6443 within a @code{SECTIONS} command. The @code{.} symbol may appear
6444 anywhere that an ordinary symbol is allowed in an expression.
6445
6446 @cindex holes
6447 Assigning a value to @code{.} will cause the location counter to be
6448 moved. This may be used to create holes in the output section. The
6449 location counter may not be moved backwards inside an output section,
6450 and may not be moved backwards outside of an output section if so
6451 doing creates areas with overlapping LMAs.
6452
6453 @smallexample
6454 SECTIONS
6455 @{
6456 output :
6457 @{
6458 file1(.text)
6459 . = . + 1000;
6460 file2(.text)
6461 . += 1000;
6462 file3(.text)
6463 @} = 0x12345678;
6464 @}
6465 @end smallexample
6466 @noindent
6467 In the previous example, the @samp{.text} section from @file{file1} is
6468 located at the beginning of the output section @samp{output}. It is
6469 followed by a 1000 byte gap. Then the @samp{.text} section from
6470 @file{file2} appears, also with a 1000 byte gap following before the
6471 @samp{.text} section from @file{file3}. The notation @samp{= 0x12345678}
6472 specifies what data to write in the gaps (@pxref{Output Section Fill}).
6473
6474 @cindex dot inside sections
6475 Note: @code{.} actually refers to the byte offset from the start of the
6476 current containing object. Normally this is the @code{SECTIONS}
6477 statement, whose start address is 0, hence @code{.} can be used as an
6478 absolute address. If @code{.} is used inside a section description
6479 however, it refers to the byte offset from the start of that section,
6480 not an absolute address. Thus in a script like this:
6481
6482 @smallexample
6483 SECTIONS
6484 @{
6485 . = 0x100
6486 .text: @{
6487 *(.text)
6488 . = 0x200
6489 @}
6490 . = 0x500
6491 .data: @{
6492 *(.data)
6493 . += 0x600
6494 @}
6495 @}
6496 @end smallexample
6497
6498 The @samp{.text} section will be assigned a starting address of 0x100
6499 and a size of exactly 0x200 bytes, even if there is not enough data in
6500 the @samp{.text} input sections to fill this area. (If there is too
6501 much data, an error will be produced because this would be an attempt to
6502 move @code{.} backwards). The @samp{.data} section will start at 0x500
6503 and it will have an extra 0x600 bytes worth of space after the end of
6504 the values from the @samp{.data} input sections and before the end of
6505 the @samp{.data} output section itself.
6506
6507 @cindex dot outside sections
6508 Setting symbols to the value of the location counter outside of an
6509 output section statement can result in unexpected values if the linker
6510 needs to place orphan sections. For example, given the following:
6511
6512 @smallexample
6513 SECTIONS
6514 @{
6515 start_of_text = . ;
6516 .text: @{ *(.text) @}
6517 end_of_text = . ;
6518
6519 start_of_data = . ;
6520 .data: @{ *(.data) @}
6521 end_of_data = . ;
6522 @}
6523 @end smallexample
6524
6525 If the linker needs to place some input section, e.g. @code{.rodata},
6526 not mentioned in the script, it might choose to place that section
6527 between @code{.text} and @code{.data}. You might think the linker
6528 should place @code{.rodata} on the blank line in the above script, but
6529 blank lines are of no particular significance to the linker. As well,
6530 the linker doesn't associate the above symbol names with their
6531 sections. Instead, it assumes that all assignments or other
6532 statements belong to the previous output section, except for the
6533 special case of an assignment to @code{.}. I.e., the linker will
6534 place the orphan @code{.rodata} section as if the script was written
6535 as follows:
6536
6537 @smallexample
6538 SECTIONS
6539 @{
6540 start_of_text = . ;
6541 .text: @{ *(.text) @}
6542 end_of_text = . ;
6543
6544 start_of_data = . ;
6545 .rodata: @{ *(.rodata) @}
6546 .data: @{ *(.data) @}
6547 end_of_data = . ;
6548 @}
6549 @end smallexample
6550
6551 This may or may not be the script author's intention for the value of
6552 @code{start_of_data}. One way to influence the orphan section
6553 placement is to assign the location counter to itself, as the linker
6554 assumes that an assignment to @code{.} is setting the start address of
6555 a following output section and thus should be grouped with that
6556 section. So you could write:
6557
6558 @smallexample
6559 SECTIONS
6560 @{
6561 start_of_text = . ;
6562 .text: @{ *(.text) @}
6563 end_of_text = . ;
6564
6565 . = . ;
6566 start_of_data = . ;
6567 .data: @{ *(.data) @}
6568 end_of_data = . ;
6569 @}
6570 @end smallexample
6571
6572 Now, the orphan @code{.rodata} section will be placed between
6573 @code{end_of_text} and @code{start_of_data}.
6574
6575 @need 2000
6576 @node Operators
6577 @subsection Operators
6578 @cindex operators for arithmetic
6579 @cindex arithmetic operators
6580 @cindex precedence in expressions
6581 The linker recognizes the standard C set of arithmetic operators, with
6582 the standard bindings and precedence levels:
6583 @c TEXI2ROFF-KILL
6584 @ifnottex
6585 @c END TEXI2ROFF-KILL
6586 @smallexample
6587 precedence associativity Operators Notes
6588 (highest)
6589 1 left ! - ~ (1)
6590 2 left * / %
6591 3 left + -
6592 4 left >> <<
6593 5 left == != > < <= >=
6594 6 left &
6595 7 left |
6596 8 left &&
6597 9 left ||
6598 10 right ? :
6599 11 right &= += -= *= /= (2)
6600 (lowest)
6601 @end smallexample
6602 Notes:
6603 (1) Prefix operators
6604 (2) @xref{Assignments}.
6605 @c TEXI2ROFF-KILL
6606 @end ifnottex
6607 @tex
6608 \vskip \baselineskip
6609 %"lispnarrowing" is the extra indent used generally for smallexample
6610 \hskip\lispnarrowing\vbox{\offinterlineskip
6611 \hrule
6612 \halign
6613 {\vrule#&\strut\hfil\ #\ \hfil&\vrule#&\strut\hfil\ #\ \hfil&\vrule#&\strut\hfil\ {\tt #}\ \hfil&\vrule#\cr
6614 height2pt&\omit&&\omit&&\omit&\cr
6615 &Precedence&& Associativity &&{\rm Operators}&\cr
6616 height2pt&\omit&&\omit&&\omit&\cr
6617 \noalign{\hrule}
6618 height2pt&\omit&&\omit&&\omit&\cr
6619 &highest&&&&&\cr
6620 % '176 is tilde, '~' in tt font
6621 &1&&left&&\qquad- \char'176\ !\qquad\dag&\cr
6622 &2&&left&&* / \%&\cr
6623 &3&&left&&+ -&\cr
6624 &4&&left&&>> <<&\cr
6625 &5&&left&&== != > < <= >=&\cr
6626 &6&&left&&\&&\cr
6627 &7&&left&&|&\cr
6628 &8&&left&&{\&\&}&\cr
6629 &9&&left&&||&\cr
6630 &10&&right&&? :&\cr
6631 &11&&right&&\qquad\&= += -= *= /=\qquad\ddag&\cr
6632 &lowest&&&&&\cr
6633 height2pt&\omit&&\omit&&\omit&\cr}
6634 \hrule}
6635 @end tex
6636 @iftex
6637 {
6638 @obeylines@parskip=0pt@parindent=0pt
6639 @dag@quad Prefix operators.
6640 @ddag@quad @xref{Assignments}.
6641 }
6642 @end iftex
6643 @c END TEXI2ROFF-KILL
6644
6645 @node Evaluation
6646 @subsection Evaluation
6647 @cindex lazy evaluation
6648 @cindex expression evaluation order
6649 The linker evaluates expressions lazily. It only computes the value of
6650 an expression when absolutely necessary.
6651
6652 The linker needs some information, such as the value of the start
6653 address of the first section, and the origins and lengths of memory
6654 regions, in order to do any linking at all. These values are computed
6655 as soon as possible when the linker reads in the linker script.
6656
6657 However, other values (such as symbol values) are not known or needed
6658 until after storage allocation. Such values are evaluated later, when
6659 other information (such as the sizes of output sections) is available
6660 for use in the symbol assignment expression.
6661
6662 The sizes of sections cannot be known until after allocation, so
6663 assignments dependent upon these are not performed until after
6664 allocation.
6665
6666 Some expressions, such as those depending upon the location counter
6667 @samp{.}, must be evaluated during section allocation.
6668
6669 If the result of an expression is required, but the value is not
6670 available, then an error results. For example, a script like the
6671 following
6672 @smallexample
6673 @group
6674 SECTIONS
6675 @{
6676 .text 9+this_isnt_constant :
6677 @{ *(.text) @}
6678 @}
6679 @end group
6680 @end smallexample
6681 @noindent
6682 will cause the error message @samp{non constant expression for initial
6683 address}.
6684
6685 @node Expression Section
6686 @subsection The Section of an Expression
6687 @cindex expression sections
6688 @cindex absolute expressions
6689 @cindex relative expressions
6690 @cindex absolute and relocatable symbols
6691 @cindex relocatable and absolute symbols
6692 @cindex symbols, relocatable and absolute
6693 Addresses and symbols may be section relative, or absolute. A section
6694 relative symbol is relocatable. If you request relocatable output
6695 using the @samp{-r} option, a further link operation may change the
6696 value of a section relative symbol. On the other hand, an absolute
6697 symbol will retain the same value throughout any further link
6698 operations.
6699
6700 Some terms in linker expressions are addresses. This is true of
6701 section relative symbols and for builtin functions that return an
6702 address, such as @code{ADDR}, @code{LOADADDR}, @code{ORIGIN} and
6703 @code{SEGMENT_START}. Other terms are simply numbers, or are builtin
6704 functions that return a non-address value, such as @code{LENGTH}.
6705 One complication is that unless you set @code{LD_FEATURE ("SANE_EXPR")}
6706 (@pxref{Miscellaneous Commands}), numbers and absolute symbols are treated
6707 differently depending on their location, for compatibility with older
6708 versions of @code{ld}. Expressions appearing outside an output
6709 section definition treat all numbers as absolute addresses.
6710 Expressions appearing inside an output section definition treat
6711 absolute symbols as numbers. If @code{LD_FEATURE ("SANE_EXPR")} is
6712 given, then absolute symbols and numbers are simply treated as numbers
6713 everywhere.
6714
6715 In the following simple example,
6716
6717 @smallexample
6718 @group
6719 SECTIONS
6720 @{
6721 . = 0x100;
6722 __executable_start = 0x100;
6723 .data :
6724 @{
6725 . = 0x10;
6726 __data_start = 0x10;
6727 *(.data)
6728 @}
6729 @dots{}
6730 @}
6731 @end group
6732 @end smallexample
6733
6734 both @code{.} and @code{__executable_start} are set to the absolute
6735 address 0x100 in the first two assignments, then both @code{.} and
6736 @code{__data_start} are set to 0x10 relative to the @code{.data}
6737 section in the second two assignments.
6738
6739 For expressions involving numbers, relative addresses and absolute
6740 addresses, ld follows these rules to evaluate terms:
6741
6742 @itemize @bullet
6743 @item
6744 Unary operations on an absolute address or number, and binary
6745 operations on two absolute addresses or two numbers, or between one
6746 absolute address and a number, apply the operator to the value(s).
6747 @item
6748 Unary operations on a relative address, and binary operations on two
6749 relative addresses in the same section or between one relative address
6750 and a number, apply the operator to the offset part of the address(es).
6751 @item
6752 Other binary operations, that is, between two relative addresses not
6753 in the same section, or between a relative address and an absolute
6754 address, first convert any non-absolute term to an absolute address
6755 before applying the operator.
6756 @end itemize
6757
6758 The result section of each sub-expression is as follows:
6759
6760 @itemize @bullet
6761 @item
6762 An operation involving only numbers results in a number.
6763 @item
6764 The result of comparisons, @samp{&&} and @samp{||} is also a number.
6765 @item
6766 The result of other binary arithmetic and logical operations on two
6767 relative addresses in the same section or two absolute addresses
6768 (after above conversions) is also a number when
6769 @code{LD_FEATURE ("SANE_EXPR")} or inside an output section definition
6770 but an absolute address otherwise.
6771 @item
6772 The result of other operations on relative addresses or one
6773 relative address and a number, is a relative address in the same
6774 section as the relative operand(s).
6775 @item
6776 The result of other operations on absolute addresses (after above
6777 conversions) is an absolute address.
6778 @end itemize
6779
6780 You can use the builtin function @code{ABSOLUTE} to force an expression
6781 to be absolute when it would otherwise be relative. For example, to
6782 create an absolute symbol set to the address of the end of the output
6783 section @samp{.data}:
6784 @smallexample
6785 SECTIONS
6786 @{
6787 .data : @{ *(.data) _edata = ABSOLUTE(.); @}
6788 @}
6789 @end smallexample
6790 @noindent
6791 If @samp{ABSOLUTE} were not used, @samp{_edata} would be relative to the
6792 @samp{.data} section.
6793
6794 Using @code{LOADADDR} also forces an expression absolute, since this
6795 particular builtin function returns an absolute address.
6796
6797 @node Builtin Functions
6798 @subsection Builtin Functions
6799 @cindex functions in expressions
6800 The linker script language includes a number of builtin functions for
6801 use in linker script expressions.
6802
6803 @table @code
6804 @item ABSOLUTE(@var{exp})
6805 @kindex ABSOLUTE(@var{exp})
6806 @cindex expression, absolute
6807 Return the absolute (non-relocatable, as opposed to non-negative) value
6808 of the expression @var{exp}. Primarily useful to assign an absolute
6809 value to a symbol within a section definition, where symbol values are
6810 normally section relative. @xref{Expression Section}.
6811
6812 @item ADDR(@var{section})
6813 @kindex ADDR(@var{section})
6814 @cindex section address in expression
6815 Return the address (VMA) of the named @var{section}. Your
6816 script must previously have defined the location of that section. In
6817 the following example, @code{start_of_output_1}, @code{symbol_1} and
6818 @code{symbol_2} are assigned equivalent values, except that
6819 @code{symbol_1} will be relative to the @code{.output1} section while
6820 the other two will be absolute:
6821 @smallexample
6822 @group
6823 SECTIONS @{ @dots{}
6824 .output1 :
6825 @{
6826 start_of_output_1 = ABSOLUTE(.);
6827 @dots{}
6828 @}
6829 .output :
6830 @{
6831 symbol_1 = ADDR(.output1);
6832 symbol_2 = start_of_output_1;
6833 @}
6834 @dots{} @}
6835 @end group
6836 @end smallexample
6837
6838 @item ALIGN(@var{align})
6839 @itemx ALIGN(@var{exp},@var{align})
6840 @kindex ALIGN(@var{align})
6841 @kindex ALIGN(@var{exp},@var{align})
6842 @cindex round up location counter
6843 @cindex align location counter
6844 @cindex round up expression
6845 @cindex align expression
6846 Return the location counter (@code{.}) or arbitrary expression aligned
6847 to the next @var{align} boundary. The single operand @code{ALIGN}
6848 doesn't change the value of the location counter---it just does
6849 arithmetic on it. The two operand @code{ALIGN} allows an arbitrary
6850 expression to be aligned upwards (@code{ALIGN(@var{align})} is
6851 equivalent to @code{ALIGN(ABSOLUTE(.), @var{align})}).
6852
6853 Here is an example which aligns the output @code{.data} section to the
6854 next @code{0x2000} byte boundary after the preceding section and sets a
6855 variable within the section to the next @code{0x8000} boundary after the
6856 input sections:
6857 @smallexample
6858 @group
6859 SECTIONS @{ @dots{}
6860 .data ALIGN(0x2000): @{
6861 *(.data)
6862 variable = ALIGN(0x8000);
6863 @}
6864 @dots{} @}
6865 @end group
6866 @end smallexample
6867 @noindent
6868 The first use of @code{ALIGN} in this example specifies the location of
6869 a section because it is used as the optional @var{address} attribute of
6870 a section definition (@pxref{Output Section Address}). The second use
6871 of @code{ALIGN} is used to defines the value of a symbol.
6872
6873 The builtin function @code{NEXT} is closely related to @code{ALIGN}.
6874
6875 @item ALIGNOF(@var{section})
6876 @kindex ALIGNOF(@var{section})
6877 @cindex section alignment
6878 Return the alignment in bytes of the named @var{section}, if that section has
6879 been allocated. If the section has not been allocated when this is
6880 evaluated, the linker will report an error. In the following example,
6881 the alignment of the @code{.output} section is stored as the first
6882 value in that section.
6883 @smallexample
6884 @group
6885 SECTIONS@{ @dots{}
6886 .output @{
6887 LONG (ALIGNOF (.output))
6888 @dots{}
6889 @}
6890 @dots{} @}
6891 @end group
6892 @end smallexample
6893
6894 @item BLOCK(@var{exp})
6895 @kindex BLOCK(@var{exp})
6896 This is a synonym for @code{ALIGN}, for compatibility with older linker
6897 scripts. It is most often seen when setting the address of an output
6898 section.
6899
6900 @item DATA_SEGMENT_ALIGN(@var{maxpagesize}, @var{commonpagesize})
6901 @kindex DATA_SEGMENT_ALIGN(@var{maxpagesize}, @var{commonpagesize})
6902 This is equivalent to either
6903 @smallexample
6904 (ALIGN(@var{maxpagesize}) + (. & (@var{maxpagesize} - 1)))
6905 @end smallexample
6906 or
6907 @smallexample
6908 (ALIGN(@var{maxpagesize})
6909 + ((. + @var{commonpagesize} - 1) & (@var{maxpagesize} - @var{commonpagesize})))
6910 @end smallexample
6911 @noindent
6912 depending on whether the latter uses fewer @var{commonpagesize} sized pages
6913 for the data segment (area between the result of this expression and
6914 @code{DATA_SEGMENT_END}) than the former or not.
6915 If the latter form is used, it means @var{commonpagesize} bytes of runtime
6916 memory will be saved at the expense of up to @var{commonpagesize} wasted
6917 bytes in the on-disk file.
6918
6919 This expression can only be used directly in @code{SECTIONS} commands, not in
6920 any output section descriptions and only once in the linker script.
6921 @var{commonpagesize} should be less or equal to @var{maxpagesize} and should
6922 be the system page size the object wants to be optimized for while still
6923 running on system page sizes up to @var{maxpagesize}. Note however
6924 that @samp{-z relro} protection will not be effective if the system
6925 page size is larger than @var{commonpagesize}.
6926
6927 @noindent
6928 Example:
6929 @smallexample
6930 . = DATA_SEGMENT_ALIGN(0x10000, 0x2000);
6931 @end smallexample
6932
6933 @item DATA_SEGMENT_END(@var{exp})
6934 @kindex DATA_SEGMENT_END(@var{exp})
6935 This defines the end of data segment for @code{DATA_SEGMENT_ALIGN}
6936 evaluation purposes.
6937
6938 @smallexample
6939 . = DATA_SEGMENT_END(.);
6940 @end smallexample
6941
6942 @item DATA_SEGMENT_RELRO_END(@var{offset}, @var{exp})
6943 @kindex DATA_SEGMENT_RELRO_END(@var{offset}, @var{exp})
6944 This defines the end of the @code{PT_GNU_RELRO} segment when
6945 @samp{-z relro} option is used.
6946 When @samp{-z relro} option is not present, @code{DATA_SEGMENT_RELRO_END}
6947 does nothing, otherwise @code{DATA_SEGMENT_ALIGN} is padded so that
6948 @var{exp} + @var{offset} is aligned to the @var{commonpagesize}
6949 argument given to @code{DATA_SEGMENT_ALIGN}. If present in the linker
6950 script, it must be placed between @code{DATA_SEGMENT_ALIGN} and
6951 @code{DATA_SEGMENT_END}. Evaluates to the second argument plus any
6952 padding needed at the end of the @code{PT_GNU_RELRO} segment due to
6953 section alignment.
6954
6955 @smallexample
6956 . = DATA_SEGMENT_RELRO_END(24, .);
6957 @end smallexample
6958
6959 @item DEFINED(@var{symbol})
6960 @kindex DEFINED(@var{symbol})
6961 @cindex symbol defaults
6962 Return 1 if @var{symbol} is in the linker global symbol table and is
6963 defined before the statement using DEFINED in the script, otherwise
6964 return 0. You can use this function to provide
6965 default values for symbols. For example, the following script fragment
6966 shows how to set a global symbol @samp{begin} to the first location in
6967 the @samp{.text} section---but if a symbol called @samp{begin} already
6968 existed, its value is preserved:
6969
6970 @smallexample
6971 @group
6972 SECTIONS @{ @dots{}
6973 .text : @{
6974 begin = DEFINED(begin) ? begin : . ;
6975 @dots{}
6976 @}
6977 @dots{}
6978 @}
6979 @end group
6980 @end smallexample
6981
6982 @item LENGTH(@var{memory})
6983 @kindex LENGTH(@var{memory})
6984 Return the length of the memory region named @var{memory}.
6985
6986 @item LOADADDR(@var{section})
6987 @kindex LOADADDR(@var{section})
6988 @cindex section load address in expression
6989 Return the absolute LMA of the named @var{section}. (@pxref{Output
6990 Section LMA}).
6991
6992 @item LOG2CEIL(@var{exp})
6993 @kindex LOG2CEIL(@var{exp})
6994 Return the binary logarithm of @var{exp} rounded towards infinity.
6995 @code{LOG2CEIL(0)} returns 0.
6996
6997 @kindex MAX
6998 @item MAX(@var{exp1}, @var{exp2})
6999 Returns the maximum of @var{exp1} and @var{exp2}.
7000
7001 @kindex MIN
7002 @item MIN(@var{exp1}, @var{exp2})
7003 Returns the minimum of @var{exp1} and @var{exp2}.
7004
7005 @item NEXT(@var{exp})
7006 @kindex NEXT(@var{exp})
7007 @cindex unallocated address, next
7008 Return the next unallocated address that is a multiple of @var{exp}.
7009 This function is closely related to @code{ALIGN(@var{exp})}; unless you
7010 use the @code{MEMORY} command to define discontinuous memory for the
7011 output file, the two functions are equivalent.
7012
7013 @item ORIGIN(@var{memory})
7014 @kindex ORIGIN(@var{memory})
7015 Return the origin of the memory region named @var{memory}.
7016
7017 @item SEGMENT_START(@var{segment}, @var{default})
7018 @kindex SEGMENT_START(@var{segment}, @var{default})
7019 Return the base address of the named @var{segment}. If an explicit
7020 value has already been given for this segment (with a command-line
7021 @samp{-T} option) then that value will be returned otherwise the value
7022 will be @var{default}. At present, the @samp{-T} command-line option
7023 can only be used to set the base address for the ``text'', ``data'', and
7024 ``bss'' sections, but you can use @code{SEGMENT_START} with any segment
7025 name.
7026
7027 @item SIZEOF(@var{section})
7028 @kindex SIZEOF(@var{section})
7029 @cindex section size
7030 Return the size in bytes of the named @var{section}, if that section has
7031 been allocated. If the section has not been allocated when this is
7032 evaluated, the linker will report an error. In the following example,
7033 @code{symbol_1} and @code{symbol_2} are assigned identical values:
7034 @smallexample
7035 @group
7036 SECTIONS@{ @dots{}
7037 .output @{
7038 .start = . ;
7039 @dots{}
7040 .end = . ;
7041 @}
7042 symbol_1 = .end - .start ;
7043 symbol_2 = SIZEOF(.output);
7044 @dots{} @}
7045 @end group
7046 @end smallexample
7047
7048 @item SIZEOF_HEADERS
7049 @kindex SIZEOF_HEADERS
7050 @cindex header size
7051 Return the size in bytes of the output file's headers. This is
7052 information which appears at the start of the output file. You can use
7053 this number when setting the start address of the first section, if you
7054 choose, to facilitate paging.
7055
7056 @cindex not enough room for program headers
7057 @cindex program headers, not enough room
7058 When producing an ELF output file, if the linker script uses the
7059 @code{SIZEOF_HEADERS} builtin function, the linker must compute the
7060 number of program headers before it has determined all the section
7061 addresses and sizes. If the linker later discovers that it needs
7062 additional program headers, it will report an error @samp{not enough
7063 room for program headers}. To avoid this error, you must avoid using
7064 the @code{SIZEOF_HEADERS} function, or you must rework your linker
7065 script to avoid forcing the linker to use additional program headers, or
7066 you must define the program headers yourself using the @code{PHDRS}
7067 command (@pxref{PHDRS}).
7068 @end table
7069
7070 @node Implicit Linker Scripts
7071 @section Implicit Linker Scripts
7072 @cindex implicit linker scripts
7073 If you specify a linker input file which the linker can not recognize as
7074 an object file or an archive file, it will try to read the file as a
7075 linker script. If the file can not be parsed as a linker script, the
7076 linker will report an error.
7077
7078 An implicit linker script will not replace the default linker script.
7079
7080 Typically an implicit linker script would contain only symbol
7081 assignments, or the @code{INPUT}, @code{GROUP}, or @code{VERSION}
7082 commands.
7083
7084 Any input files read because of an implicit linker script will be read
7085 at the position in the command line where the implicit linker script was
7086 read. This can affect archive searching.
7087
7088 @node Plugins
7089 @chapter Linker Plugins
7090
7091 @cindex plugins
7092 @cindex linker plugins
7093 The linker can use dynamically loaded plugins to modify its behavior.
7094 For example, the link-time optimization feature that some compilers
7095 support is implemented with a linker plugin.
7096
7097 Currently there is only one plugin shipped by default, but more may
7098 be added here later.
7099
7100 @menu
7101 * libdep Plugin:: Static Library Dependencies Plugin
7102 @end menu
7103
7104 @node libdep Plugin
7105 @section Static Library Dependencies Plugin
7106 @cindex static library dependencies
7107 Originally, static libraries were contained in an archive file consisting
7108 just of a collection of relocatable object files. Later they evolved to
7109 optionally include a symbol table, to assist in finding the needed objects
7110 within a library. There their evolution ended, and dynamic libraries
7111 rose to ascendance.
7112
7113 One useful feature of dynamic libraries was that, more than just collecting
7114 multiple objects into a single file, they also included a list of their
7115 dependencies, such that one could specify just the name of a single dynamic
7116 library at link time, and all of its dependencies would be implicitly
7117 referenced as well. But static libraries lacked this feature, so if a
7118 link invocation was switched from using dynamic libraries to static
7119 libraries, the link command would usually fail unless it was rewritten to
7120 explicitly list the dependencies of the static library.
7121
7122 The GNU @command{ar} utility now supports a @option{--record-libdeps} option
7123 to embed dependency lists into static libraries as well, and the @file{libdep}
7124 plugin may be used to read this dependency information at link time. The
7125 dependency information is stored as a single string, carrying @option{-l}
7126 and @option{-L} arguments as they would normally appear in a linker
7127 command line. As such, the information can be written with any text
7128 utility and stored into any archive, even if GNU @command{ar} is not
7129 being used to create the archive. The information is stored in an
7130 archive member named @samp{__.LIBDEP}.
7131
7132 For example, given a library @file{libssl.a} that depends on another
7133 library @file{libcrypto.a} which may be found in @file{/usr/local/lib},
7134 the @samp{__.LIBDEP} member of @file{libssl.a} would contain
7135
7136 @smallexample
7137 -L/usr/local/lib -lcrypto
7138 @end smallexample
7139
7140 @ifset GENERIC
7141 @node Machine Dependent
7142 @chapter Machine Dependent Features
7143
7144 @cindex machine dependencies
7145 @command{ld} has additional features on some platforms; the following
7146 sections describe them. Machines where @command{ld} has no additional
7147 functionality are not listed.
7148
7149 @menu
7150 @ifset H8300
7151 * H8/300:: @command{ld} and the H8/300
7152 @end ifset
7153 @ifset M68HC11
7154 * M68HC11/68HC12:: @code{ld} and the Motorola 68HC11 and 68HC12 families
7155 @end ifset
7156 @ifset ARM
7157 * ARM:: @command{ld} and the ARM family
7158 @end ifset
7159 @ifset HPPA
7160 * HPPA ELF32:: @command{ld} and HPPA 32-bit ELF
7161 @end ifset
7162 @ifset M68K
7163 * M68K:: @command{ld} and the Motorola 68K family
7164 @end ifset
7165 @ifset MIPS
7166 * MIPS:: @command{ld} and the MIPS family
7167 @end ifset
7168 @ifset MMIX
7169 * MMIX:: @command{ld} and MMIX
7170 @end ifset
7171 @ifset MSP430
7172 * MSP430:: @command{ld} and MSP430
7173 @end ifset
7174 @ifset NDS32
7175 * NDS32:: @command{ld} and NDS32
7176 @end ifset
7177 @ifset NIOSII
7178 * Nios II:: @command{ld} and the Altera Nios II
7179 @end ifset
7180 @ifset POWERPC
7181 * PowerPC ELF32:: @command{ld} and PowerPC 32-bit ELF Support
7182 @end ifset
7183 @ifset POWERPC64
7184 * PowerPC64 ELF64:: @command{ld} and PowerPC64 64-bit ELF Support
7185 @end ifset
7186 @ifset S/390
7187 * S/390 ELF:: @command{ld} and S/390 ELF Support
7188 @end ifset
7189 @ifset SPU
7190 * SPU ELF:: @command{ld} and SPU ELF Support
7191 @end ifset
7192 @ifset TICOFF
7193 * TI COFF:: @command{ld} and TI COFF
7194 @end ifset
7195 @ifset WIN32
7196 * WIN32:: @command{ld} and WIN32 (cygwin/mingw)
7197 @end ifset
7198 @ifset XTENSA
7199 * Xtensa:: @command{ld} and Xtensa Processors
7200 @end ifset
7201 @end menu
7202 @end ifset
7203
7204 @ifset H8300
7205 @ifclear GENERIC
7206 @raisesections
7207 @end ifclear
7208
7209 @node H8/300
7210 @section @command{ld} and the H8/300
7211
7212 @cindex H8/300 support
7213 For the H8/300, @command{ld} can perform these global optimizations when
7214 you specify the @samp{--relax} command-line option.
7215
7216 @table @emph
7217 @cindex relaxing on H8/300
7218 @item relaxing address modes
7219 @command{ld} finds all @code{jsr} and @code{jmp} instructions whose
7220 targets are within eight bits, and turns them into eight-bit
7221 program-counter relative @code{bsr} and @code{bra} instructions,
7222 respectively.
7223
7224 @cindex synthesizing on H8/300
7225 @item synthesizing instructions
7226 @c FIXME: specifically mov.b, or any mov instructions really? -> mov.b only, at least on H8, H8H, H8S
7227 @command{ld} finds all @code{mov.b} instructions which use the
7228 sixteen-bit absolute address form, but refer to the top
7229 page of memory, and changes them to use the eight-bit address form.
7230 (That is: the linker turns @samp{mov.b @code{@@}@var{aa}:16} into
7231 @samp{mov.b @code{@@}@var{aa}:8} whenever the address @var{aa} is in the
7232 top page of memory).
7233
7234 @command{ld} finds all @code{mov} instructions which use the register
7235 indirect with 32-bit displacement addressing mode, but use a small
7236 displacement inside 16-bit displacement range, and changes them to use
7237 the 16-bit displacement form. (That is: the linker turns @samp{mov.b
7238 @code{@@}@var{d}:32,ERx} into @samp{mov.b @code{@@}@var{d}:16,ERx}
7239 whenever the displacement @var{d} is in the 16 bit signed integer
7240 range. Only implemented in ELF-format ld).
7241
7242 @item bit manipulation instructions
7243 @command{ld} finds all bit manipulation instructions like @code{band, bclr,
7244 biand, bild, bior, bist, bixor, bld, bnot, bor, bset, bst, btst, bxor}
7245 which use 32 bit and 16 bit absolute address form, but refer to the top
7246 page of memory, and changes them to use the 8 bit address form.
7247 (That is: the linker turns @samp{bset #xx:3,@code{@@}@var{aa}:32} into
7248 @samp{bset #xx:3,@code{@@}@var{aa}:8} whenever the address @var{aa} is in
7249 the top page of memory).
7250
7251 @item system control instructions
7252 @command{ld} finds all @code{ldc.w, stc.w} instructions which use the
7253 32 bit absolute address form, but refer to the top page of memory, and
7254 changes them to use 16 bit address form.
7255 (That is: the linker turns @samp{ldc.w @code{@@}@var{aa}:32,ccr} into
7256 @samp{ldc.w @code{@@}@var{aa}:16,ccr} whenever the address @var{aa} is in
7257 the top page of memory).
7258 @end table
7259
7260 @ifclear GENERIC
7261 @lowersections
7262 @end ifclear
7263 @end ifset
7264
7265 @ifclear GENERIC
7266 @ifset Renesas
7267 @c This stuff is pointless to say unless you're especially concerned
7268 @c with Renesas chips; don't enable it for generic case, please.
7269 @node Renesas
7270 @chapter @command{ld} and Other Renesas Chips
7271
7272 @command{ld} also supports the Renesas (formerly Hitachi) H8/300H,
7273 H8/500, and SH chips. No special features, commands, or command-line
7274 options are required for these chips.
7275 @end ifset
7276 @end ifclear
7277
7278 @ifset ARM
7279 @ifclear GENERIC
7280 @raisesections
7281 @end ifclear
7282
7283 @ifset M68HC11
7284 @ifclear GENERIC
7285 @raisesections
7286 @end ifclear
7287
7288 @node M68HC11/68HC12
7289 @section @command{ld} and the Motorola 68HC11 and 68HC12 families
7290
7291 @cindex M68HC11 and 68HC12 support
7292
7293 @subsection Linker Relaxation
7294
7295 For the Motorola 68HC11, @command{ld} can perform these global
7296 optimizations when you specify the @samp{--relax} command-line option.
7297
7298 @table @emph
7299 @cindex relaxing on M68HC11
7300 @item relaxing address modes
7301 @command{ld} finds all @code{jsr} and @code{jmp} instructions whose
7302 targets are within eight bits, and turns them into eight-bit
7303 program-counter relative @code{bsr} and @code{bra} instructions,
7304 respectively.
7305
7306 @command{ld} also looks at all 16-bit extended addressing modes and
7307 transforms them in a direct addressing mode when the address is in
7308 page 0 (between 0 and 0x0ff).
7309
7310 @item relaxing gcc instruction group
7311 When @command{gcc} is called with @option{-mrelax}, it can emit group
7312 of instructions that the linker can optimize to use a 68HC11 direct
7313 addressing mode. These instructions consists of @code{bclr} or
7314 @code{bset} instructions.
7315
7316 @end table
7317
7318 @subsection Trampoline Generation
7319
7320 @cindex trampoline generation on M68HC11
7321 @cindex trampoline generation on M68HC12
7322 For 68HC11 and 68HC12, @command{ld} can generate trampoline code to
7323 call a far function using a normal @code{jsr} instruction. The linker
7324 will also change the relocation to some far function to use the
7325 trampoline address instead of the function address. This is typically the
7326 case when a pointer to a function is taken. The pointer will in fact
7327 point to the function trampoline.
7328
7329 @ifclear GENERIC
7330 @lowersections
7331 @end ifclear
7332 @end ifset
7333
7334 @node ARM
7335 @section @command{ld} and the ARM family
7336
7337 @cindex ARM interworking support
7338 @kindex --support-old-code
7339 For the ARM, @command{ld} will generate code stubs to allow functions calls
7340 between ARM and Thumb code. These stubs only work with code that has
7341 been compiled and assembled with the @samp{-mthumb-interwork} command
7342 line option. If it is necessary to link with old ARM object files or
7343 libraries, which have not been compiled with the -mthumb-interwork
7344 option then the @samp{--support-old-code} command-line switch should be
7345 given to the linker. This will make it generate larger stub functions
7346 which will work with non-interworking aware ARM code. Note, however,
7347 the linker does not support generating stubs for function calls to
7348 non-interworking aware Thumb code.
7349
7350 @cindex thumb entry point
7351 @cindex entry point, thumb
7352 @kindex --thumb-entry=@var{entry}
7353 The @samp{--thumb-entry} switch is a duplicate of the generic
7354 @samp{--entry} switch, in that it sets the program's starting address.
7355 But it also sets the bottom bit of the address, so that it can be
7356 branched to using a BX instruction, and the program will start
7357 executing in Thumb mode straight away.
7358
7359 @cindex PE import table prefixing
7360 @kindex --use-nul-prefixed-import-tables
7361 The @samp{--use-nul-prefixed-import-tables} switch is specifying, that
7362 the import tables idata4 and idata5 have to be generated with a zero
7363 element prefix for import libraries. This is the old style to generate
7364 import tables. By default this option is turned off.
7365
7366 @cindex BE8
7367 @kindex --be8
7368 The @samp{--be8} switch instructs @command{ld} to generate BE8 format
7369 executables. This option is only valid when linking big-endian
7370 objects - ie ones which have been assembled with the @option{-EB}
7371 option. The resulting image will contain big-endian data and
7372 little-endian code.
7373
7374 @cindex TARGET1
7375 @kindex --target1-rel
7376 @kindex --target1-abs
7377 The @samp{R_ARM_TARGET1} relocation is typically used for entries in the
7378 @samp{.init_array} section. It is interpreted as either @samp{R_ARM_REL32}
7379 or @samp{R_ARM_ABS32}, depending on the target. The @samp{--target1-rel}
7380 and @samp{--target1-abs} switches override the default.
7381
7382 @cindex TARGET2
7383 @kindex --target2=@var{type}
7384 The @samp{--target2=type} switch overrides the default definition of the
7385 @samp{R_ARM_TARGET2} relocation. Valid values for @samp{type}, their
7386 meanings, and target defaults are as follows:
7387 @table @samp
7388 @item rel
7389 @samp{R_ARM_REL32} (arm*-*-elf, arm*-*-eabi)
7390 @item abs
7391 @samp{R_ARM_ABS32}
7392 @item got-rel
7393 @samp{R_ARM_GOT_PREL} (arm*-*-linux, arm*-*-*bsd)
7394 @end table
7395
7396 @cindex FIX_V4BX
7397 @kindex --fix-v4bx
7398 The @samp{R_ARM_V4BX} relocation (defined by the ARM AAELF
7399 specification) enables objects compiled for the ARMv4 architecture to be
7400 interworking-safe when linked with other objects compiled for ARMv4t, but
7401 also allows pure ARMv4 binaries to be built from the same ARMv4 objects.
7402
7403 In the latter case, the switch @option{--fix-v4bx} must be passed to the
7404 linker, which causes v4t @code{BX rM} instructions to be rewritten as
7405 @code{MOV PC,rM}, since v4 processors do not have a @code{BX} instruction.
7406
7407 In the former case, the switch should not be used, and @samp{R_ARM_V4BX}
7408 relocations are ignored.
7409
7410 @cindex FIX_V4BX_INTERWORKING
7411 @kindex --fix-v4bx-interworking
7412 Replace @code{BX rM} instructions identified by @samp{R_ARM_V4BX}
7413 relocations with a branch to the following veneer:
7414
7415 @smallexample
7416 TST rM, #1
7417 MOVEQ PC, rM
7418 BX Rn
7419 @end smallexample
7420
7421 This allows generation of libraries/applications that work on ARMv4 cores
7422 and are still interworking safe. Note that the above veneer clobbers the
7423 condition flags, so may cause incorrect program behavior in rare cases.
7424
7425 @cindex USE_BLX
7426 @kindex --use-blx
7427 The @samp{--use-blx} switch enables the linker to use ARM/Thumb
7428 BLX instructions (available on ARMv5t and above) in various
7429 situations. Currently it is used to perform calls via the PLT from Thumb
7430 code using BLX rather than using BX and a mode-switching stub before
7431 each PLT entry. This should lead to such calls executing slightly faster.
7432
7433 @cindex VFP11_DENORM_FIX
7434 @kindex --vfp11-denorm-fix
7435 The @samp{--vfp11-denorm-fix} switch enables a link-time workaround for a
7436 bug in certain VFP11 coprocessor hardware, which sometimes allows
7437 instructions with denorm operands (which must be handled by support code)
7438 to have those operands overwritten by subsequent instructions before
7439 the support code can read the intended values.
7440
7441 The bug may be avoided in scalar mode if you allow at least one
7442 intervening instruction between a VFP11 instruction which uses a register
7443 and another instruction which writes to the same register, or at least two
7444 intervening instructions if vector mode is in use. The bug only affects
7445 full-compliance floating-point mode: you do not need this workaround if
7446 you are using "runfast" mode. Please contact ARM for further details.
7447
7448 If you know you are using buggy VFP11 hardware, you can
7449 enable this workaround by specifying the linker option
7450 @samp{--vfp-denorm-fix=scalar} if you are using the VFP11 scalar
7451 mode only, or @samp{--vfp-denorm-fix=vector} if you are using
7452 vector mode (the latter also works for scalar code). The default is
7453 @samp{--vfp-denorm-fix=none}.
7454
7455 If the workaround is enabled, instructions are scanned for
7456 potentially-troublesome sequences, and a veneer is created for each
7457 such sequence which may trigger the erratum. The veneer consists of the
7458 first instruction of the sequence and a branch back to the subsequent
7459 instruction. The original instruction is then replaced with a branch to
7460 the veneer. The extra cycles required to call and return from the veneer
7461 are sufficient to avoid the erratum in both the scalar and vector cases.
7462
7463 @cindex ARM1176 erratum workaround
7464 @kindex --fix-arm1176
7465 @kindex --no-fix-arm1176
7466 The @samp{--fix-arm1176} switch enables a link-time workaround for an erratum
7467 in certain ARM1176 processors. The workaround is enabled by default if you
7468 are targeting ARM v6 (excluding ARM v6T2) or earlier. It can be disabled
7469 unconditionally by specifying @samp{--no-fix-arm1176}.
7470
7471 Further information is available in the ``ARM1176JZ-S and ARM1176JZF-S
7472 Programmer Advice Notice'' available on the ARM documentation website at:
7473 http://infocenter.arm.com/.
7474
7475 @cindex STM32L4xx erratum workaround
7476 @kindex --fix-stm32l4xx-629360
7477
7478 The @samp{--fix-stm32l4xx-629360} switch enables a link-time
7479 workaround for a bug in the bus matrix / memory controller for some of
7480 the STM32 Cortex-M4 based products (STM32L4xx). When accessing
7481 off-chip memory via the affected bus for bus reads of 9 words or more,
7482 the bus can generate corrupt data and/or abort. These are only
7483 core-initiated accesses (not DMA), and might affect any access:
7484 integer loads such as LDM, POP and floating-point loads such as VLDM,
7485 VPOP. Stores are not affected.
7486
7487 The bug can be avoided by splitting memory accesses into the
7488 necessary chunks to keep bus reads below 8 words.
7489
7490 The workaround is not enabled by default, this is equivalent to use
7491 @samp{--fix-stm32l4xx-629360=none}. If you know you are using buggy
7492 STM32L4xx hardware, you can enable the workaround by specifying the
7493 linker option @samp{--fix-stm32l4xx-629360}, or the equivalent
7494 @samp{--fix-stm32l4xx-629360=default}.
7495
7496 If the workaround is enabled, instructions are scanned for
7497 potentially-troublesome sequences, and a veneer is created for each
7498 such sequence which may trigger the erratum. The veneer consists in a
7499 replacement sequence emulating the behaviour of the original one and a
7500 branch back to the subsequent instruction. The original instruction is
7501 then replaced with a branch to the veneer.
7502
7503 The workaround does not always preserve the memory access order for
7504 the LDMDB instruction, when the instruction loads the PC.
7505
7506 The workaround is not able to handle problematic instructions when
7507 they are in the middle of an IT block, since a branch is not allowed
7508 there. In that case, the linker reports a warning and no replacement
7509 occurs.
7510
7511 The workaround is not able to replace problematic instructions with a
7512 PC-relative branch instruction if the @samp{.text} section is too
7513 large. In that case, when the branch that replaces the original code
7514 cannot be encoded, the linker reports a warning and no replacement
7515 occurs.
7516
7517 @cindex NO_ENUM_SIZE_WARNING
7518 @kindex --no-enum-size-warning
7519 The @option{--no-enum-size-warning} switch prevents the linker from
7520 warning when linking object files that specify incompatible EABI
7521 enumeration size attributes. For example, with this switch enabled,
7522 linking of an object file using 32-bit enumeration values with another
7523 using enumeration values fitted into the smallest possible space will
7524 not be diagnosed.
7525
7526 @cindex NO_WCHAR_SIZE_WARNING
7527 @kindex --no-wchar-size-warning
7528 The @option{--no-wchar-size-warning} switch prevents the linker from
7529 warning when linking object files that specify incompatible EABI
7530 @code{wchar_t} size attributes. For example, with this switch enabled,
7531 linking of an object file using 32-bit @code{wchar_t} values with another
7532 using 16-bit @code{wchar_t} values will not be diagnosed.
7533
7534 @cindex PIC_VENEER
7535 @kindex --pic-veneer
7536 The @samp{--pic-veneer} switch makes the linker use PIC sequences for
7537 ARM/Thumb interworking veneers, even if the rest of the binary
7538 is not PIC. This avoids problems on uClinux targets where
7539 @samp{--emit-relocs} is used to generate relocatable binaries.
7540
7541 @cindex STUB_GROUP_SIZE
7542 @kindex --stub-group-size=@var{N}
7543 The linker will automatically generate and insert small sequences of
7544 code into a linked ARM ELF executable whenever an attempt is made to
7545 perform a function call to a symbol that is too far away. The
7546 placement of these sequences of instructions - called stubs - is
7547 controlled by the command-line option @option{--stub-group-size=N}.
7548 The placement is important because a poor choice can create a need for
7549 duplicate stubs, increasing the code size. The linker will try to
7550 group stubs together in order to reduce interruptions to the flow of
7551 code, but it needs guidance as to how big these groups should be and
7552 where they should be placed.
7553
7554 The value of @samp{N}, the parameter to the
7555 @option{--stub-group-size=} option controls where the stub groups are
7556 placed. If it is negative then all stubs are placed after the first
7557 branch that needs them. If it is positive then the stubs can be
7558 placed either before or after the branches that need them. If the
7559 value of @samp{N} is 1 (either +1 or -1) then the linker will choose
7560 exactly where to place groups of stubs, using its built in heuristics.
7561 A value of @samp{N} greater than 1 (or smaller than -1) tells the
7562 linker that a single group of stubs can service at most @samp{N} bytes
7563 from the input sections.
7564
7565 The default, if @option{--stub-group-size=} is not specified, is
7566 @samp{N = +1}.
7567
7568 Farcalls stubs insertion is fully supported for the ARM-EABI target
7569 only, because it relies on object files properties not present
7570 otherwise.
7571
7572 @cindex Cortex-A8 erratum workaround
7573 @kindex --fix-cortex-a8
7574 @kindex --no-fix-cortex-a8
7575 The @samp{--fix-cortex-a8} switch enables a link-time workaround for an erratum in certain Cortex-A8 processors. The workaround is enabled by default if you are targeting the ARM v7-A architecture profile. It can be enabled otherwise by specifying @samp{--fix-cortex-a8}, or disabled unconditionally by specifying @samp{--no-fix-cortex-a8}.
7576
7577 The erratum only affects Thumb-2 code. Please contact ARM for further details.
7578
7579 @cindex Cortex-A53 erratum 835769 workaround
7580 @kindex --fix-cortex-a53-835769
7581 @kindex --no-fix-cortex-a53-835769
7582 The @samp{--fix-cortex-a53-835769} switch enables a link-time workaround for erratum 835769 present on certain early revisions of Cortex-A53 processors. The workaround is disabled by default. It can be enabled by specifying @samp{--fix-cortex-a53-835769}, or disabled unconditionally by specifying @samp{--no-fix-cortex-a53-835769}.
7583
7584 Please contact ARM for further details.
7585
7586 @kindex --merge-exidx-entries
7587 @kindex --no-merge-exidx-entries
7588 @cindex Merging exidx entries
7589 The @samp{--no-merge-exidx-entries} switch disables the merging of adjacent exidx entries in debuginfo.
7590
7591 @kindex --long-plt
7592 @cindex 32-bit PLT entries
7593 The @samp{--long-plt} option enables the use of 16 byte PLT entries
7594 which support up to 4Gb of code. The default is to use 12 byte PLT
7595 entries which only support 512Mb of code.
7596
7597 @kindex --no-apply-dynamic-relocs
7598 @cindex AArch64 rela addend
7599 The @samp{--no-apply-dynamic-relocs} option makes AArch64 linker do not apply
7600 link-time values for dynamic relocations.
7601
7602 @cindex Placement of SG veneers
7603 All SG veneers are placed in the special output section @code{.gnu.sgstubs}.
7604 Its start address must be set, either with the command-line option
7605 @samp{--section-start} or in a linker script, to indicate where to place these
7606 veneers in memory.
7607
7608 @kindex --cmse-implib
7609 @cindex Secure gateway import library
7610 The @samp{--cmse-implib} option requests that the import libraries
7611 specified by the @samp{--out-implib} and @samp{--in-implib} options are
7612 secure gateway import libraries, suitable for linking a non-secure
7613 executable against secure code as per ARMv8-M Security Extensions.
7614
7615 @kindex --in-implib=@var{file}
7616 @cindex Input import library
7617 The @samp{--in-implib=file} specifies an input import library whose symbols
7618 must keep the same address in the executable being produced. A warning is
7619 given if no @samp{--out-implib} is given but new symbols have been introduced
7620 in the executable that should be listed in its import library. Otherwise, if
7621 @samp{--out-implib} is specified, the symbols are added to the output import
7622 library. A warning is also given if some symbols present in the input import
7623 library have disappeared from the executable. This option is only effective
7624 for Secure Gateway import libraries, ie. when @samp{--cmse-implib} is
7625 specified.
7626
7627 @ifclear GENERIC
7628 @lowersections
7629 @end ifclear
7630 @end ifset
7631
7632 @ifset HPPA
7633 @ifclear GENERIC
7634 @raisesections
7635 @end ifclear
7636
7637 @node HPPA ELF32
7638 @section @command{ld} and HPPA 32-bit ELF Support
7639 @cindex HPPA multiple sub-space stubs
7640 @kindex --multi-subspace
7641 When generating a shared library, @command{ld} will by default generate
7642 import stubs suitable for use with a single sub-space application.
7643 The @samp{--multi-subspace} switch causes @command{ld} to generate export
7644 stubs, and different (larger) import stubs suitable for use with
7645 multiple sub-spaces.
7646
7647 @cindex HPPA stub grouping
7648 @kindex --stub-group-size=@var{N}
7649 Long branch stubs and import/export stubs are placed by @command{ld} in
7650 stub sections located between groups of input sections.
7651 @samp{--stub-group-size} specifies the maximum size of a group of input
7652 sections handled by one stub section. Since branch offsets are signed,
7653 a stub section may serve two groups of input sections, one group before
7654 the stub section, and one group after it. However, when using
7655 conditional branches that require stubs, it may be better (for branch
7656 prediction) that stub sections only serve one group of input sections.
7657 A negative value for @samp{N} chooses this scheme, ensuring that
7658 branches to stubs always use a negative offset. Two special values of
7659 @samp{N} are recognized, @samp{1} and @samp{-1}. These both instruct
7660 @command{ld} to automatically size input section groups for the branch types
7661 detected, with the same behaviour regarding stub placement as other
7662 positive or negative values of @samp{N} respectively.
7663
7664 Note that @samp{--stub-group-size} does not split input sections. A
7665 single input section larger than the group size specified will of course
7666 create a larger group (of one section). If input sections are too
7667 large, it may not be possible for a branch to reach its stub.
7668
7669 @ifclear GENERIC
7670 @lowersections
7671 @end ifclear
7672 @end ifset
7673
7674 @ifset M68K
7675 @ifclear GENERIC
7676 @raisesections
7677 @end ifclear
7678
7679 @node M68K
7680 @section @command{ld} and the Motorola 68K family
7681
7682 @cindex Motorola 68K GOT generation
7683 @kindex --got=@var{type}
7684 The @samp{--got=@var{type}} option lets you choose the GOT generation scheme.
7685 The choices are @samp{single}, @samp{negative}, @samp{multigot} and
7686 @samp{target}. When @samp{target} is selected the linker chooses
7687 the default GOT generation scheme for the current target.
7688 @samp{single} tells the linker to generate a single GOT with
7689 entries only at non-negative offsets.
7690 @samp{negative} instructs the linker to generate a single GOT with
7691 entries at both negative and positive offsets. Not all environments
7692 support such GOTs.
7693 @samp{multigot} allows the linker to generate several GOTs in the
7694 output file. All GOT references from a single input object
7695 file access the same GOT, but references from different input object
7696 files might access different GOTs. Not all environments support such GOTs.
7697
7698 @ifclear GENERIC
7699 @lowersections
7700 @end ifclear
7701 @end ifset
7702
7703 @ifset MIPS
7704 @ifclear GENERIC
7705 @raisesections
7706 @end ifclear
7707
7708 @node MIPS
7709 @section @command{ld} and the MIPS family
7710
7711 @cindex MIPS microMIPS instruction choice selection
7712 @kindex --insn32
7713 @kindex --no-insn32
7714 The @samp{--insn32} and @samp{--no-insn32} options control the choice of
7715 microMIPS instructions used in code generated by the linker, such as that
7716 in the PLT or lazy binding stubs, or in relaxation. If @samp{--insn32} is
7717 used, then the linker only uses 32-bit instruction encodings. By default
7718 or if @samp{--no-insn32} is used, all instruction encodings are used,
7719 including 16-bit ones where possible.
7720
7721 @cindex MIPS branch relocation check control
7722 @kindex --ignore-branch-isa
7723 @kindex --no-ignore-branch-isa
7724 The @samp{--ignore-branch-isa} and @samp{--no-ignore-branch-isa} options
7725 control branch relocation checks for invalid ISA mode transitions. If
7726 @samp{--ignore-branch-isa} is used, then the linker accepts any branch
7727 relocations and any ISA mode transition required is lost in relocation
7728 calculation, except for some cases of @code{BAL} instructions which meet
7729 relaxation conditions and are converted to equivalent @code{JALX}
7730 instructions as the associated relocation is calculated. By default
7731 or if @samp{--no-ignore-branch-isa} is used a check is made causing
7732 the loss of an ISA mode transition to produce an error.
7733
7734 @ifclear GENERIC
7735 @lowersections
7736 @end ifclear
7737 @end ifset
7738
7739 @ifset MMIX
7740 @ifclear GENERIC
7741 @raisesections
7742 @end ifclear
7743
7744 @node MMIX
7745 @section @code{ld} and MMIX
7746 For MMIX, there is a choice of generating @code{ELF} object files or
7747 @code{mmo} object files when linking. The simulator @code{mmix}
7748 understands the @code{mmo} format. The binutils @code{objcopy} utility
7749 can translate between the two formats.
7750
7751 There is one special section, the @samp{.MMIX.reg_contents} section.
7752 Contents in this section is assumed to correspond to that of global
7753 registers, and symbols referring to it are translated to special symbols,
7754 equal to registers. In a final link, the start address of the
7755 @samp{.MMIX.reg_contents} section corresponds to the first allocated
7756 global register multiplied by 8. Register @code{$255} is not included in
7757 this section; it is always set to the program entry, which is at the
7758 symbol @code{Main} for @code{mmo} files.
7759
7760 Global symbols with the prefix @code{__.MMIX.start.}, for example
7761 @code{__.MMIX.start..text} and @code{__.MMIX.start..data} are special.
7762 The default linker script uses these to set the default start address
7763 of a section.
7764
7765 Initial and trailing multiples of zero-valued 32-bit words in a section,
7766 are left out from an mmo file.
7767
7768 @ifclear GENERIC
7769 @lowersections
7770 @end ifclear
7771 @end ifset
7772
7773 @ifset MSP430
7774 @ifclear GENERIC
7775 @raisesections
7776 @end ifclear
7777
7778 @node MSP430
7779 @section @code{ld} and MSP430
7780 For the MSP430 it is possible to select the MPU architecture. The flag @samp{-m [mpu type]}
7781 will select an appropriate linker script for selected MPU type. (To get a list of known MPUs
7782 just pass @samp{-m help} option to the linker).
7783
7784 @cindex MSP430 extra sections
7785 The linker will recognize some extra sections which are MSP430 specific:
7786
7787 @table @code
7788 @item @samp{.vectors}
7789 Defines a portion of ROM where interrupt vectors located.
7790
7791 @item @samp{.bootloader}
7792 Defines the bootloader portion of the ROM (if applicable). Any code
7793 in this section will be uploaded to the MPU.
7794
7795 @item @samp{.infomem}
7796 Defines an information memory section (if applicable). Any code in
7797 this section will be uploaded to the MPU.
7798
7799 @item @samp{.infomemnobits}
7800 This is the same as the @samp{.infomem} section except that any code
7801 in this section will not be uploaded to the MPU.
7802
7803 @item @samp{.noinit}
7804 Denotes a portion of RAM located above @samp{.bss} section.
7805
7806 The last two sections are used by gcc.
7807 @end table
7808
7809 @table @option
7810 @cindex MSP430 Options
7811 @kindex --code-region
7812 @item --code-region=[either,lower,upper,none]
7813 This will transform .text* sections to [either,lower,upper].text* sections. The
7814 argument passed to GCC for -mcode-region is propagated to the linker
7815 using this option.
7816
7817 @kindex --data-region
7818 @item --data-region=[either,lower,upper,none]
7819 This will transform .data*, .bss* and .rodata* sections to
7820 [either,lower,upper].[data,bss,rodata]* sections. The argument passed to GCC
7821 for -mdata-region is propagated to the linker using this option.
7822
7823 @kindex --disable-sec-transformation
7824 @item --disable-sec-transformation
7825 Prevent the transformation of sections as specified by the @code{--code-region}
7826 and @code{--data-region} options.
7827 This is useful if you are compiling and linking using a single call to the GCC
7828 wrapper, and want to compile the source files using -m[code,data]-region but
7829 not transform the sections for prebuilt libraries and objects.
7830 @end table
7831
7832 @ifclear GENERIC
7833 @lowersections
7834 @end ifclear
7835 @end ifset
7836
7837 @ifset NDS32
7838 @ifclear GENERIC
7839 @raisesections
7840 @end ifclear
7841
7842 @node NDS32
7843 @section @code{ld} and NDS32
7844 @kindex relaxing on NDS32
7845 For NDS32, there are some options to select relaxation behavior. The linker
7846 relaxes objects according to these options.
7847
7848 @table @code
7849 @item @samp{--m[no-]fp-as-gp}
7850 Disable/enable fp-as-gp relaxation.
7851
7852 @item @samp{--mexport-symbols=FILE}
7853 Exporting symbols and their address into FILE as linker script.
7854
7855 @item @samp{--m[no-]ex9}
7856 Disable/enable link-time EX9 relaxation.
7857
7858 @item @samp{--mexport-ex9=FILE}
7859 Export the EX9 table after linking.
7860
7861 @item @samp{--mimport-ex9=FILE}
7862 Import the Ex9 table for EX9 relaxation.
7863
7864 @item @samp{--mupdate-ex9}
7865 Update the existing EX9 table.
7866
7867 @item @samp{--mex9-limit=NUM}
7868 Maximum number of entries in the ex9 table.
7869
7870 @item @samp{--mex9-loop-aware}
7871 Avoid generating the EX9 instruction inside the loop.
7872
7873 @item @samp{--m[no-]ifc}
7874 Disable/enable the link-time IFC optimization.
7875
7876 @item @samp{--mifc-loop-aware}
7877 Avoid generating the IFC instruction inside the loop.
7878 @end table
7879
7880 @ifclear GENERIC
7881 @lowersections
7882 @end ifclear
7883 @end ifset
7884
7885 @ifset NIOSII
7886 @ifclear GENERIC
7887 @raisesections
7888 @end ifclear
7889
7890 @node Nios II
7891 @section @command{ld} and the Altera Nios II
7892 @cindex Nios II call relaxation
7893 @kindex --relax on Nios II
7894
7895 Call and immediate jump instructions on Nios II processors are limited to
7896 transferring control to addresses in the same 256MB memory segment,
7897 which may result in @command{ld} giving
7898 @samp{relocation truncated to fit} errors with very large programs.
7899 The command-line option @option{--relax} enables the generation of
7900 trampolines that can access the entire 32-bit address space for calls
7901 outside the normal @code{call} and @code{jmpi} address range. These
7902 trampolines are inserted at section boundaries, so may not themselves
7903 be reachable if an input section and its associated call trampolines are
7904 larger than 256MB.
7905
7906 The @option{--relax} option is enabled by default unless @option{-r}
7907 is also specified. You can disable trampoline generation by using the
7908 @option{--no-relax} linker option. You can also disable this optimization
7909 locally by using the @samp{set .noat} directive in assembly-language
7910 source files, as the linker-inserted trampolines use the @code{at}
7911 register as a temporary.
7912
7913 Note that the linker @option{--relax} option is independent of assembler
7914 relaxation options, and that using the GNU assembler's @option{-relax-all}
7915 option interferes with the linker's more selective call instruction relaxation.
7916
7917 @ifclear GENERIC
7918 @lowersections
7919 @end ifclear
7920 @end ifset
7921
7922 @ifset POWERPC
7923 @ifclear GENERIC
7924 @raisesections
7925 @end ifclear
7926
7927 @node PowerPC ELF32
7928 @section @command{ld} and PowerPC 32-bit ELF Support
7929 @cindex PowerPC long branches
7930 @kindex --relax on PowerPC
7931 Branches on PowerPC processors are limited to a signed 26-bit
7932 displacement, which may result in @command{ld} giving
7933 @samp{relocation truncated to fit} errors with very large programs.
7934 @samp{--relax} enables the generation of trampolines that can access
7935 the entire 32-bit address space. These trampolines are inserted at
7936 section boundaries, so may not themselves be reachable if an input
7937 section exceeds 33M in size. You may combine @samp{-r} and
7938 @samp{--relax} to add trampolines in a partial link. In that case
7939 both branches to undefined symbols and inter-section branches are also
7940 considered potentially out of range, and trampolines inserted.
7941
7942 @cindex PowerPC ELF32 options
7943 @table @option
7944 @cindex PowerPC PLT
7945 @kindex --bss-plt
7946 @item --bss-plt
7947 Current PowerPC GCC accepts a @samp{-msecure-plt} option that
7948 generates code capable of using a newer PLT and GOT layout that has
7949 the security advantage of no executable section ever needing to be
7950 writable and no writable section ever being executable. PowerPC
7951 @command{ld} will generate this layout, including stubs to access the
7952 PLT, if all input files (including startup and static libraries) were
7953 compiled with @samp{-msecure-plt}. @samp{--bss-plt} forces the old
7954 BSS PLT (and GOT layout) which can give slightly better performance.
7955
7956 @kindex --secure-plt
7957 @item --secure-plt
7958 @command{ld} will use the new PLT and GOT layout if it is linking new
7959 @samp{-fpic} or @samp{-fPIC} code, but does not do so automatically
7960 when linking non-PIC code. This option requests the new PLT and GOT
7961 layout. A warning will be given if some object file requires the old
7962 style BSS PLT.
7963
7964 @cindex PowerPC GOT
7965 @kindex --sdata-got
7966 @item --sdata-got
7967 The new secure PLT and GOT are placed differently relative to other
7968 sections compared to older BSS PLT and GOT placement. The location of
7969 @code{.plt} must change because the new secure PLT is an initialized
7970 section while the old PLT is uninitialized. The reason for the
7971 @code{.got} change is more subtle: The new placement allows
7972 @code{.got} to be read-only in applications linked with
7973 @samp{-z relro -z now}. However, this placement means that
7974 @code{.sdata} cannot always be used in shared libraries, because the
7975 PowerPC ABI accesses @code{.sdata} in shared libraries from the GOT
7976 pointer. @samp{--sdata-got} forces the old GOT placement. PowerPC
7977 GCC doesn't use @code{.sdata} in shared libraries, so this option is
7978 really only useful for other compilers that may do so.
7979
7980 @cindex PowerPC stub symbols
7981 @kindex --emit-stub-syms
7982 @item --emit-stub-syms
7983 This option causes @command{ld} to label linker stubs with a local
7984 symbol that encodes the stub type and destination.
7985
7986 @cindex PowerPC TLS optimization
7987 @kindex --no-tls-optimize
7988 @item --no-tls-optimize
7989 PowerPC @command{ld} normally performs some optimization of code
7990 sequences used to access Thread-Local Storage. Use this option to
7991 disable the optimization.
7992 @end table
7993
7994 @ifclear GENERIC
7995 @lowersections
7996 @end ifclear
7997 @end ifset
7998
7999 @ifset POWERPC64
8000 @ifclear GENERIC
8001 @raisesections
8002 @end ifclear
8003
8004 @node PowerPC64 ELF64
8005 @section @command{ld} and PowerPC64 64-bit ELF Support
8006
8007 @cindex PowerPC64 ELF64 options
8008 @table @option
8009 @cindex PowerPC64 stub grouping
8010 @kindex --stub-group-size
8011 @item --stub-group-size
8012 Long branch stubs, PLT call stubs and TOC adjusting stubs are placed
8013 by @command{ld} in stub sections located between groups of input sections.
8014 @samp{--stub-group-size} specifies the maximum size of a group of input
8015 sections handled by one stub section. Since branch offsets are signed,
8016 a stub section may serve two groups of input sections, one group before
8017 the stub section, and one group after it. However, when using
8018 conditional branches that require stubs, it may be better (for branch
8019 prediction) that stub sections only serve one group of input sections.
8020 A negative value for @samp{N} chooses this scheme, ensuring that
8021 branches to stubs always use a negative offset. Two special values of
8022 @samp{N} are recognized, @samp{1} and @samp{-1}. These both instruct
8023 @command{ld} to automatically size input section groups for the branch types
8024 detected, with the same behaviour regarding stub placement as other
8025 positive or negative values of @samp{N} respectively.
8026
8027 Note that @samp{--stub-group-size} does not split input sections. A
8028 single input section larger than the group size specified will of course
8029 create a larger group (of one section). If input sections are too
8030 large, it may not be possible for a branch to reach its stub.
8031
8032 @cindex PowerPC64 stub symbols
8033 @kindex --emit-stub-syms
8034 @item --emit-stub-syms
8035 This option causes @command{ld} to label linker stubs with a local
8036 symbol that encodes the stub type and destination.
8037
8038 @cindex PowerPC64 dot symbols
8039 @kindex --dotsyms
8040 @kindex --no-dotsyms
8041 @item --dotsyms
8042 @itemx --no-dotsyms
8043 These two options control how @command{ld} interprets version patterns
8044 in a version script. Older PowerPC64 compilers emitted both a
8045 function descriptor symbol with the same name as the function, and a
8046 code entry symbol with the name prefixed by a dot (@samp{.}). To
8047 properly version a function @samp{foo}, the version script thus needs
8048 to control both @samp{foo} and @samp{.foo}. The option
8049 @samp{--dotsyms}, on by default, automatically adds the required
8050 dot-prefixed patterns. Use @samp{--no-dotsyms} to disable this
8051 feature.
8052
8053 @cindex PowerPC64 register save/restore functions
8054 @kindex --save-restore-funcs
8055 @kindex --no-save-restore-funcs
8056 @item --save-restore-funcs
8057 @itemx --no-save-restore-funcs
8058 These two options control whether PowerPC64 @command{ld} automatically
8059 provides out-of-line register save and restore functions used by
8060 @samp{-Os} code. The default is to provide any such referenced
8061 function for a normal final link, and to not do so for a relocatable
8062 link.
8063
8064 @cindex PowerPC64 TLS optimization
8065 @kindex --no-tls-optimize
8066 @item --no-tls-optimize
8067 PowerPC64 @command{ld} normally performs some optimization of code
8068 sequences used to access Thread-Local Storage. Use this option to
8069 disable the optimization.
8070
8071 @cindex PowerPC64 __tls_get_addr optimization
8072 @kindex --tls-get-addr-optimize
8073 @kindex --no-tls-get-addr-optimize
8074 @kindex --tls-get-addr-regsave
8075 @kindex --no-tls-get-addr-regsave
8076 @item --tls-get-addr-optimize
8077 @itemx --no-tls-get-addr-optimize
8078 These options control how PowerPC64 @command{ld} uses a special
8079 stub to call __tls_get_addr. PowerPC64 glibc 2.22 and later support
8080 an optimization that allows the second and subsequent calls to
8081 @code{__tls_get_addr} for a given symbol to be resolved by the special
8082 stub without calling in to glibc. By default the linker enables
8083 generation of the stub when glibc advertises the availability of
8084 __tls_get_addr_opt.
8085 Using @option{--tls-get-addr-optimize} with an older glibc won't do
8086 much besides slow down your applications, but may be useful if linking
8087 an application against an older glibc with the expectation that it
8088 will normally be used on systems having a newer glibc.
8089 @option{--tls-get-addr-regsave} forces generation of a stub that saves
8090 and restores volatile registers around the call into glibc. Normally,
8091 this is done when the linker detects a call to __tls_get_addr_desc.
8092 Such calls then go via the register saving stub to __tls_get_addr_opt.
8093 @option{--no-tls-get-addr-regsave} disables generation of the
8094 register saves.
8095
8096 @cindex PowerPC64 OPD optimization
8097 @kindex --no-opd-optimize
8098 @item --no-opd-optimize
8099 PowerPC64 @command{ld} normally removes @code{.opd} section entries
8100 corresponding to deleted link-once functions, or functions removed by
8101 the action of @samp{--gc-sections} or linker script @code{/DISCARD/}.
8102 Use this option to disable @code{.opd} optimization.
8103
8104 @cindex PowerPC64 OPD spacing
8105 @kindex --non-overlapping-opd
8106 @item --non-overlapping-opd
8107 Some PowerPC64 compilers have an option to generate compressed
8108 @code{.opd} entries spaced 16 bytes apart, overlapping the third word,
8109 the static chain pointer (unused in C) with the first word of the next
8110 entry. This option expands such entries to the full 24 bytes.
8111
8112 @cindex PowerPC64 TOC optimization
8113 @kindex --no-toc-optimize
8114 @item --no-toc-optimize
8115 PowerPC64 @command{ld} normally removes unused @code{.toc} section
8116 entries. Such entries are detected by examining relocations that
8117 reference the TOC in code sections. A reloc in a deleted code section
8118 marks a TOC word as unneeded, while a reloc in a kept code section
8119 marks a TOC word as needed. Since the TOC may reference itself, TOC
8120 relocs are also examined. TOC words marked as both needed and
8121 unneeded will of course be kept. TOC words without any referencing
8122 reloc are assumed to be part of a multi-word entry, and are kept or
8123 discarded as per the nearest marked preceding word. This works
8124 reliably for compiler generated code, but may be incorrect if assembly
8125 code is used to insert TOC entries. Use this option to disable the
8126 optimization.
8127
8128 @cindex PowerPC64 inline PLT call optimization
8129 @kindex --no-inline-optimize
8130 @item --no-inline-optimize
8131 PowerPC64 @command{ld} normally replaces inline PLT call sequences
8132 marked with @code{R_PPC64_PLTSEQ}, @code{R_PPC64_PLTCALL},
8133 @code{R_PPC64_PLT16_HA} and @code{R_PPC64_PLT16_LO_DS} relocations by
8134 a number of @code{nop}s and a direct call when the function is defined
8135 locally and can't be overridden by some other definition. This option
8136 disables that optimization.
8137
8138 @cindex PowerPC64 multi-TOC
8139 @kindex --no-multi-toc
8140 @item --no-multi-toc
8141 If given any toc option besides @code{-mcmodel=medium} or
8142 @code{-mcmodel=large}, PowerPC64 GCC generates code for a TOC model
8143 where TOC
8144 entries are accessed with a 16-bit offset from r2. This limits the
8145 total TOC size to 64K. PowerPC64 @command{ld} extends this limit by
8146 grouping code sections such that each group uses less than 64K for its
8147 TOC entries, then inserts r2 adjusting stubs between inter-group
8148 calls. @command{ld} does not split apart input sections, so cannot
8149 help if a single input file has a @code{.toc} section that exceeds
8150 64K, most likely from linking multiple files with @command{ld -r}.
8151 Use this option to turn off this feature.
8152
8153 @cindex PowerPC64 TOC sorting
8154 @kindex --no-toc-sort
8155 @item --no-toc-sort
8156 By default, @command{ld} sorts TOC sections so that those whose file
8157 happens to have a section called @code{.init} or @code{.fini} are
8158 placed first, followed by TOC sections referenced by code generated
8159 with PowerPC64 gcc's @code{-mcmodel=small}, and lastly TOC sections
8160 referenced only by code generated with PowerPC64 gcc's
8161 @code{-mcmodel=medium} or @code{-mcmodel=large} options. Doing this
8162 results in better TOC grouping for multi-TOC. Use this option to turn
8163 off this feature.
8164
8165 @cindex PowerPC64 PLT stub alignment
8166 @kindex --plt-align
8167 @kindex --no-plt-align
8168 @item --plt-align
8169 @itemx --no-plt-align
8170 Use these options to control whether individual PLT call stubs are
8171 aligned to a 32-byte boundary, or to the specified power of two
8172 boundary when using @code{--plt-align=}. A negative value may be
8173 specified to pad PLT call stubs so that they do not cross the
8174 specified power of two boundary (or the minimum number of boundaries
8175 if a PLT stub is so large that it must cross a boundary). By default
8176 PLT call stubs are aligned to 32-byte boundaries.
8177
8178 @cindex PowerPC64 PLT call stub static chain
8179 @kindex --plt-static-chain
8180 @kindex --no-plt-static-chain
8181 @item --plt-static-chain
8182 @itemx --no-plt-static-chain
8183 Use these options to control whether PLT call stubs load the static
8184 chain pointer (r11). @code{ld} defaults to not loading the static
8185 chain since there is never any need to do so on a PLT call.
8186
8187 @cindex PowerPC64 PLT call stub thread safety
8188 @kindex --plt-thread-safe
8189 @kindex --no-plt-thread-safe
8190 @item --plt-thread-safe
8191 @itemx --no-plt-thread-safe
8192 With power7's weakly ordered memory model, it is possible when using
8193 lazy binding for ld.so to update a plt entry in one thread and have
8194 another thread see the individual plt entry words update in the wrong
8195 order, despite ld.so carefully writing in the correct order and using
8196 memory write barriers. To avoid this we need some sort of read
8197 barrier in the call stub, or use LD_BIND_NOW=1. By default, @code{ld}
8198 looks for calls to commonly used functions that create threads, and if
8199 seen, adds the necessary barriers. Use these options to change the
8200 default behaviour.
8201
8202 @cindex PowerPC64 ELFv2 PLT localentry optimization
8203 @kindex --plt-localentry
8204 @kindex --no-plt-localentry
8205 @item --plt-localentry
8206 @itemx --no-localentry
8207 ELFv2 functions with localentry:0 are those with a single entry point,
8208 ie. global entry == local entry, and that have no requirement on r2
8209 (the TOC/GOT pointer) or r12, and guarantee r2 is unchanged on return.
8210 Such an external function can be called via the PLT without saving r2
8211 or restoring it on return, avoiding a common load-hit-store for small
8212 functions. The optimization is attractive, with up to 40% reduction
8213 in execution time for a small function, but can result in symbol
8214 interposition failures. Also, minor changes in a shared library,
8215 including system libraries, can cause a function that was localentry:0
8216 to become localentry:8. This will result in a dynamic loader
8217 complaint and failure to run. The option is experimental, use with
8218 care. @option{--no-plt-localentry} is the default.
8219
8220 @cindex PowerPC64 Power10 stubs
8221 @kindex --power10-stubs
8222 @kindex --no-power10-stubs
8223 @item --power10-stubs
8224 @itemx --no-power10-stubs
8225 When PowerPC64 @command{ld} links input object files containing
8226 relocations used on power10 prefixed instructions it normally creates
8227 linkage stubs (PLT call and long branch) using power10 instructions
8228 for @code{@@notoc} PLT calls where @code{r2} is not known. The
8229 power10 notoc stubs are smaller and faster, so are preferred for
8230 power10. @option{--power10-stubs} and @option{--no-power10-stubs}
8231 allow you to override the linker's selection of stub instructions.
8232 @option{--power10-stubs=auto} allows the user to select the default
8233 auto mode.
8234 @end table
8235
8236 @ifclear GENERIC
8237 @lowersections
8238 @end ifclear
8239 @end ifset
8240
8241 @ifset S/390
8242 @ifclear GENERIC
8243 @raisesections
8244 @end ifclear
8245
8246 @node S/390 ELF
8247 @section @command{ld} and S/390 ELF Support
8248
8249 @cindex S/390 ELF options
8250 @table @option
8251
8252 @cindex S/390
8253 @kindex --s390-pgste
8254 @item --s390-pgste
8255 This option marks the result file with a @code{PT_S390_PGSTE}
8256 segment. The Linux kernel is supposed to allocate 4k page tables for
8257 binaries marked that way.
8258 @end table
8259
8260 @ifclear GENERIC
8261 @lowersections
8262 @end ifclear
8263 @end ifset
8264
8265 @ifset SPU
8266 @ifclear GENERIC
8267 @raisesections
8268 @end ifclear
8269
8270 @node SPU ELF
8271 @section @command{ld} and SPU ELF Support
8272
8273 @cindex SPU ELF options
8274 @table @option
8275
8276 @cindex SPU plugins
8277 @kindex --plugin
8278 @item --plugin
8279 This option marks an executable as a PIC plugin module.
8280
8281 @cindex SPU overlays
8282 @kindex --no-overlays
8283 @item --no-overlays
8284 Normally, @command{ld} recognizes calls to functions within overlay
8285 regions, and redirects such calls to an overlay manager via a stub.
8286 @command{ld} also provides a built-in overlay manager. This option
8287 turns off all this special overlay handling.
8288
8289 @cindex SPU overlay stub symbols
8290 @kindex --emit-stub-syms
8291 @item --emit-stub-syms
8292 This option causes @command{ld} to label overlay stubs with a local
8293 symbol that encodes the stub type and destination.
8294
8295 @cindex SPU extra overlay stubs
8296 @kindex --extra-overlay-stubs
8297 @item --extra-overlay-stubs
8298 This option causes @command{ld} to add overlay call stubs on all
8299 function calls out of overlay regions. Normally stubs are not added
8300 on calls to non-overlay regions.
8301
8302 @cindex SPU local store size
8303 @kindex --local-store=lo:hi
8304 @item --local-store=lo:hi
8305 @command{ld} usually checks that a final executable for SPU fits in
8306 the address range 0 to 256k. This option may be used to change the
8307 range. Disable the check entirely with @option{--local-store=0:0}.
8308
8309 @cindex SPU
8310 @kindex --stack-analysis
8311 @item --stack-analysis
8312 SPU local store space is limited. Over-allocation of stack space
8313 unnecessarily limits space available for code and data, while
8314 under-allocation results in runtime failures. If given this option,
8315 @command{ld} will provide an estimate of maximum stack usage.
8316 @command{ld} does this by examining symbols in code sections to
8317 determine the extents of functions, and looking at function prologues
8318 for stack adjusting instructions. A call-graph is created by looking
8319 for relocations on branch instructions. The graph is then searched
8320 for the maximum stack usage path. Note that this analysis does not
8321 find calls made via function pointers, and does not handle recursion
8322 and other cycles in the call graph. Stack usage may be
8323 under-estimated if your code makes such calls. Also, stack usage for
8324 dynamic allocation, e.g. alloca, will not be detected. If a link map
8325 is requested, detailed information about each function's stack usage
8326 and calls will be given.
8327
8328 @cindex SPU
8329 @kindex --emit-stack-syms
8330 @item --emit-stack-syms
8331 This option, if given along with @option{--stack-analysis} will result
8332 in @command{ld} emitting stack sizing symbols for each function.
8333 These take the form @code{__stack_<function_name>} for global
8334 functions, and @code{__stack_<number>_<function_name>} for static
8335 functions. @code{<number>} is the section id in hex. The value of
8336 such symbols is the stack requirement for the corresponding function.
8337 The symbol size will be zero, type @code{STT_NOTYPE}, binding
8338 @code{STB_LOCAL}, and section @code{SHN_ABS}.
8339 @end table
8340
8341 @ifclear GENERIC
8342 @lowersections
8343 @end ifclear
8344 @end ifset
8345
8346 @ifset TICOFF
8347 @ifclear GENERIC
8348 @raisesections
8349 @end ifclear
8350
8351 @node TI COFF
8352 @section @command{ld}'s Support for Various TI COFF Versions
8353 @cindex TI COFF versions
8354 @kindex --format=@var{version}
8355 The @samp{--format} switch allows selection of one of the various
8356 TI COFF versions. The latest of this writing is 2; versions 0 and 1 are
8357 also supported. The TI COFF versions also vary in header byte-order
8358 format; @command{ld} will read any version or byte order, but the output
8359 header format depends on the default specified by the specific target.
8360
8361 @ifclear GENERIC
8362 @lowersections
8363 @end ifclear
8364 @end ifset
8365
8366 @ifset WIN32
8367 @ifclear GENERIC
8368 @raisesections
8369 @end ifclear
8370
8371 @node WIN32
8372 @section @command{ld} and WIN32 (cygwin/mingw)
8373
8374 This section describes some of the win32 specific @command{ld} issues.
8375 See @ref{Options,,Command-line Options} for detailed description of the
8376 command-line options mentioned here.
8377
8378 @table @emph
8379 @cindex import libraries
8380 @item import libraries
8381 The standard Windows linker creates and uses so-called import
8382 libraries, which contains information for linking to dll's. They are
8383 regular static archives and are handled as any other static
8384 archive. The cygwin and mingw ports of @command{ld} have specific
8385 support for creating such libraries provided with the
8386 @samp{--out-implib} command-line option.
8387
8388 @item exporting DLL symbols
8389 @cindex exporting DLL symbols
8390 The cygwin/mingw @command{ld} has several ways to export symbols for dll's.
8391
8392 @table @emph
8393 @item using auto-export functionality
8394 @cindex using auto-export functionality
8395 By default @command{ld} exports symbols with the auto-export functionality,
8396 which is controlled by the following command-line options:
8397
8398 @itemize
8399 @item --export-all-symbols [This is the default]
8400 @item --exclude-symbols
8401 @item --exclude-libs
8402 @item --exclude-modules-for-implib
8403 @item --version-script
8404 @end itemize
8405
8406 When auto-export is in operation, @command{ld} will export all the non-local
8407 (global and common) symbols it finds in a DLL, with the exception of a few
8408 symbols known to belong to the system's runtime and libraries. As it will
8409 often not be desirable to export all of a DLL's symbols, which may include
8410 private functions that are not part of any public interface, the command-line
8411 options listed above may be used to filter symbols out from the list for
8412 exporting. The @samp{--output-def} option can be used in order to see the
8413 final list of exported symbols with all exclusions taken into effect.
8414
8415 If @samp{--export-all-symbols} is not given explicitly on the
8416 command line, then the default auto-export behavior will be @emph{disabled}
8417 if either of the following are true:
8418
8419 @itemize
8420 @item A DEF file is used.
8421 @item Any symbol in any object file was marked with the __declspec(dllexport) attribute.
8422 @end itemize
8423
8424 @item using a DEF file
8425 @cindex using a DEF file
8426 Another way of exporting symbols is using a DEF file. A DEF file is
8427 an ASCII file containing definitions of symbols which should be
8428 exported when a dll is created. Usually it is named @samp{<dll
8429 name>.def} and is added as any other object file to the linker's
8430 command line. The file's name must end in @samp{.def} or @samp{.DEF}.
8431
8432 @example
8433 gcc -o <output> <objectfiles> <dll name>.def
8434 @end example
8435
8436 Using a DEF file turns off the normal auto-export behavior, unless the
8437 @samp{--export-all-symbols} option is also used.
8438
8439 Here is an example of a DEF file for a shared library called @samp{xyz.dll}:
8440
8441 @example
8442 LIBRARY "xyz.dll" BASE=0x20000000
8443
8444 EXPORTS
8445 foo
8446 bar
8447 _bar = bar
8448 another_foo = abc.dll.afoo
8449 var1 DATA
8450 doo = foo == foo2
8451 eoo DATA == var1
8452 @end example
8453
8454 This example defines a DLL with a non-default base address and seven
8455 symbols in the export table. The third exported symbol @code{_bar} is an
8456 alias for the second. The fourth symbol, @code{another_foo} is resolved
8457 by "forwarding" to another module and treating it as an alias for
8458 @code{afoo} exported from the DLL @samp{abc.dll}. The final symbol
8459 @code{var1} is declared to be a data object. The @samp{doo} symbol in
8460 export library is an alias of @samp{foo}, which gets the string name
8461 in export table @samp{foo2}. The @samp{eoo} symbol is an data export
8462 symbol, which gets in export table the name @samp{var1}.
8463
8464 The optional @code{LIBRARY <name>} command indicates the @emph{internal}
8465 name of the output DLL. If @samp{<name>} does not include a suffix,
8466 the default library suffix, @samp{.DLL} is appended.
8467
8468 When the .DEF file is used to build an application, rather than a
8469 library, the @code{NAME <name>} command should be used instead of
8470 @code{LIBRARY}. If @samp{<name>} does not include a suffix, the default
8471 executable suffix, @samp{.EXE} is appended.
8472
8473 With either @code{LIBRARY <name>} or @code{NAME <name>} the optional
8474 specification @code{BASE = <number>} may be used to specify a
8475 non-default base address for the image.
8476
8477 If neither @code{LIBRARY <name>} nor @code{NAME <name>} is specified,
8478 or they specify an empty string, the internal name is the same as the
8479 filename specified on the command line.
8480
8481 The complete specification of an export symbol is:
8482
8483 @example
8484 EXPORTS
8485 ( ( ( <name1> [ = <name2> ] )
8486 | ( <name1> = <module-name> . <external-name>))
8487 [ @@ <integer> ] [NONAME] [DATA] [CONSTANT] [PRIVATE] [== <name3>] ) *
8488 @end example
8489
8490 Declares @samp{<name1>} as an exported symbol from the DLL, or declares
8491 @samp{<name1>} as an exported alias for @samp{<name2>}; or declares
8492 @samp{<name1>} as a "forward" alias for the symbol
8493 @samp{<external-name>} in the DLL @samp{<module-name>}.
8494 Optionally, the symbol may be exported by the specified ordinal
8495 @samp{<integer>} alias. The optional @samp{<name3>} is the to be used
8496 string in import/export table for the symbol.
8497
8498 The optional keywords that follow the declaration indicate:
8499
8500 @code{NONAME}: Do not put the symbol name in the DLL's export table. It
8501 will still be exported by its ordinal alias (either the value specified
8502 by the .def specification or, otherwise, the value assigned by the
8503 linker). The symbol name, however, does remain visible in the import
8504 library (if any), unless @code{PRIVATE} is also specified.
8505
8506 @code{DATA}: The symbol is a variable or object, rather than a function.
8507 The import lib will export only an indirect reference to @code{foo} as
8508 the symbol @code{_imp__foo} (ie, @code{foo} must be resolved as
8509 @code{*_imp__foo}).
8510
8511 @code{CONSTANT}: Like @code{DATA}, but put the undecorated @code{foo} as
8512 well as @code{_imp__foo} into the import library. Both refer to the
8513 read-only import address table's pointer to the variable, not to the
8514 variable itself. This can be dangerous. If the user code fails to add
8515 the @code{dllimport} attribute and also fails to explicitly add the
8516 extra indirection that the use of the attribute enforces, the
8517 application will behave unexpectedly.
8518
8519 @code{PRIVATE}: Put the symbol in the DLL's export table, but do not put
8520 it into the static import library used to resolve imports at link time. The
8521 symbol can still be imported using the @code{LoadLibrary/GetProcAddress}
8522 API at runtime or by using the GNU ld extension of linking directly to
8523 the DLL without an import library.
8524
8525 See ld/deffilep.y in the binutils sources for the full specification of
8526 other DEF file statements
8527
8528 @cindex creating a DEF file
8529 While linking a shared dll, @command{ld} is able to create a DEF file
8530 with the @samp{--output-def <file>} command-line option.
8531
8532 @item Using decorations
8533 @cindex Using decorations
8534 Another way of marking symbols for export is to modify the source code
8535 itself, so that when building the DLL each symbol to be exported is
8536 declared as:
8537
8538 @example
8539 __declspec(dllexport) int a_variable
8540 __declspec(dllexport) void a_function(int with_args)
8541 @end example
8542
8543 All such symbols will be exported from the DLL. If, however,
8544 any of the object files in the DLL contain symbols decorated in
8545 this way, then the normal auto-export behavior is disabled, unless
8546 the @samp{--export-all-symbols} option is also used.
8547
8548 Note that object files that wish to access these symbols must @emph{not}
8549 decorate them with dllexport. Instead, they should use dllimport,
8550 instead:
8551
8552 @example
8553 __declspec(dllimport) int a_variable
8554 __declspec(dllimport) void a_function(int with_args)
8555 @end example
8556
8557 This complicates the structure of library header files, because
8558 when included by the library itself the header must declare the
8559 variables and functions as dllexport, but when included by client
8560 code the header must declare them as dllimport. There are a number
8561 of idioms that are typically used to do this; often client code can
8562 omit the __declspec() declaration completely. See
8563 @samp{--enable-auto-import} and @samp{automatic data imports} for more
8564 information.
8565 @end table
8566
8567 @cindex automatic data imports
8568 @item automatic data imports
8569 The standard Windows dll format supports data imports from dlls only
8570 by adding special decorations (dllimport/dllexport), which let the
8571 compiler produce specific assembler instructions to deal with this
8572 issue. This increases the effort necessary to port existing Un*x
8573 code to these platforms, especially for large
8574 c++ libraries and applications. The auto-import feature, which was
8575 initially provided by Paul Sokolovsky, allows one to omit the
8576 decorations to achieve a behavior that conforms to that on POSIX/Un*x
8577 platforms. This feature is enabled with the @samp{--enable-auto-import}
8578 command-line option, although it is enabled by default on cygwin/mingw.
8579 The @samp{--enable-auto-import} option itself now serves mainly to
8580 suppress any warnings that are ordinarily emitted when linked objects
8581 trigger the feature's use.
8582
8583 auto-import of variables does not always work flawlessly without
8584 additional assistance. Sometimes, you will see this message
8585
8586 "variable '<var>' can't be auto-imported. Please read the
8587 documentation for ld's @code{--enable-auto-import} for details."
8588
8589 The @samp{--enable-auto-import} documentation explains why this error
8590 occurs, and several methods that can be used to overcome this difficulty.
8591 One of these methods is the @emph{runtime pseudo-relocs} feature, described
8592 below.
8593
8594 @cindex runtime pseudo-relocation
8595 For complex variables imported from DLLs (such as structs or classes),
8596 object files typically contain a base address for the variable and an
8597 offset (@emph{addend}) within the variable--to specify a particular
8598 field or public member, for instance. Unfortunately, the runtime loader used
8599 in win32 environments is incapable of fixing these references at runtime
8600 without the additional information supplied by dllimport/dllexport decorations.
8601 The standard auto-import feature described above is unable to resolve these
8602 references.
8603
8604 The @samp{--enable-runtime-pseudo-relocs} switch allows these references to
8605 be resolved without error, while leaving the task of adjusting the references
8606 themselves (with their non-zero addends) to specialized code provided by the
8607 runtime environment. Recent versions of the cygwin and mingw environments and
8608 compilers provide this runtime support; older versions do not. However, the
8609 support is only necessary on the developer's platform; the compiled result will
8610 run without error on an older system.
8611
8612 @samp{--enable-runtime-pseudo-relocs} is not the default; it must be explicitly
8613 enabled as needed.
8614
8615 @cindex direct linking to a dll
8616 @item direct linking to a dll
8617 The cygwin/mingw ports of @command{ld} support the direct linking,
8618 including data symbols, to a dll without the usage of any import
8619 libraries. This is much faster and uses much less memory than does the
8620 traditional import library method, especially when linking large
8621 libraries or applications. When @command{ld} creates an import lib, each
8622 function or variable exported from the dll is stored in its own bfd, even
8623 though a single bfd could contain many exports. The overhead involved in
8624 storing, loading, and processing so many bfd's is quite large, and explains the
8625 tremendous time, memory, and storage needed to link against particularly
8626 large or complex libraries when using import libs.
8627
8628 Linking directly to a dll uses no extra command-line switches other than
8629 @samp{-L} and @samp{-l}, because @command{ld} already searches for a number
8630 of names to match each library. All that is needed from the developer's
8631 perspective is an understanding of this search, in order to force ld to
8632 select the dll instead of an import library.
8633
8634
8635 For instance, when ld is called with the argument @samp{-lxxx} it will attempt
8636 to find, in the first directory of its search path,
8637
8638 @example
8639 libxxx.dll.a
8640 xxx.dll.a
8641 libxxx.a
8642 xxx.lib
8643 libxxx.lib
8644 cygxxx.dll (*)
8645 libxxx.dll
8646 xxx.dll
8647 @end example
8648
8649 before moving on to the next directory in the search path.
8650
8651 (*) Actually, this is not @samp{cygxxx.dll} but in fact is @samp{<prefix>xxx.dll},
8652 where @samp{<prefix>} is set by the @command{ld} option
8653 @samp{--dll-search-prefix=<prefix>}. In the case of cygwin, the standard gcc spec
8654 file includes @samp{--dll-search-prefix=cyg}, so in effect we actually search for
8655 @samp{cygxxx.dll}.
8656
8657 Other win32-based unix environments, such as mingw or pw32, may use other
8658 @samp{<prefix>}es, although at present only cygwin makes use of this feature. It
8659 was originally intended to help avoid name conflicts among dll's built for the
8660 various win32/un*x environments, so that (for example) two versions of a zlib dll
8661 could coexist on the same machine.
8662
8663 The generic cygwin/mingw path layout uses a @samp{bin} directory for
8664 applications and dll's and a @samp{lib} directory for the import
8665 libraries (using cygwin nomenclature):
8666
8667 @example
8668 bin/
8669 cygxxx.dll
8670 lib/
8671 libxxx.dll.a (in case of dll's)
8672 libxxx.a (in case of static archive)
8673 @end example
8674
8675 Linking directly to a dll without using the import library can be
8676 done two ways:
8677
8678 1. Use the dll directly by adding the @samp{bin} path to the link line
8679 @example
8680 gcc -Wl,-verbose -o a.exe -L../bin/ -lxxx
8681 @end example
8682
8683 However, as the dll's often have version numbers appended to their names
8684 (@samp{cygncurses-5.dll}) this will often fail, unless one specifies
8685 @samp{-L../bin -lncurses-5} to include the version. Import libs are generally
8686 not versioned, and do not have this difficulty.
8687
8688 2. Create a symbolic link from the dll to a file in the @samp{lib}
8689 directory according to the above mentioned search pattern. This
8690 should be used to avoid unwanted changes in the tools needed for
8691 making the app/dll.
8692
8693 @example
8694 ln -s bin/cygxxx.dll lib/[cyg|lib|]xxx.dll[.a]
8695 @end example
8696
8697 Then you can link without any make environment changes.
8698
8699 @example
8700 gcc -Wl,-verbose -o a.exe -L../lib/ -lxxx
8701 @end example
8702
8703 This technique also avoids the version number problems, because the following is
8704 perfectly legal
8705
8706 @example
8707 bin/
8708 cygxxx-5.dll
8709 lib/
8710 libxxx.dll.a -> ../bin/cygxxx-5.dll
8711 @end example
8712
8713 Linking directly to a dll without using an import lib will work
8714 even when auto-import features are exercised, and even when
8715 @samp{--enable-runtime-pseudo-relocs} is used.
8716
8717 Given the improvements in speed and memory usage, one might justifiably
8718 wonder why import libraries are used at all. There are three reasons:
8719
8720 1. Until recently, the link-directly-to-dll functionality did @emph{not}
8721 work with auto-imported data.
8722
8723 2. Sometimes it is necessary to include pure static objects within the
8724 import library (which otherwise contains only bfd's for indirection
8725 symbols that point to the exports of a dll). Again, the import lib
8726 for the cygwin kernel makes use of this ability, and it is not
8727 possible to do this without an import lib.
8728
8729 3. Symbol aliases can only be resolved using an import lib. This is
8730 critical when linking against OS-supplied dll's (eg, the win32 API)
8731 in which symbols are usually exported as undecorated aliases of their
8732 stdcall-decorated assembly names.
8733
8734 So, import libs are not going away. But the ability to replace
8735 true import libs with a simple symbolic link to (or a copy of)
8736 a dll, in many cases, is a useful addition to the suite of tools
8737 binutils makes available to the win32 developer. Given the
8738 massive improvements in memory requirements during linking, storage
8739 requirements, and linking speed, we expect that many developers
8740 will soon begin to use this feature whenever possible.
8741
8742 @item symbol aliasing
8743 @table @emph
8744 @item adding additional names
8745 Sometimes, it is useful to export symbols with additional names.
8746 A symbol @samp{foo} will be exported as @samp{foo}, but it can also be
8747 exported as @samp{_foo} by using special directives in the DEF file
8748 when creating the dll. This will affect also the optional created
8749 import library. Consider the following DEF file:
8750
8751 @example
8752 LIBRARY "xyz.dll" BASE=0x61000000
8753
8754 EXPORTS
8755 foo
8756 _foo = foo
8757 @end example
8758
8759 The line @samp{_foo = foo} maps the symbol @samp{foo} to @samp{_foo}.
8760
8761 Another method for creating a symbol alias is to create it in the
8762 source code using the "weak" attribute:
8763
8764 @example
8765 void foo () @{ /* Do something. */; @}
8766 void _foo () __attribute__ ((weak, alias ("foo")));
8767 @end example
8768
8769 See the gcc manual for more information about attributes and weak
8770 symbols.
8771
8772 @item renaming symbols
8773 Sometimes it is useful to rename exports. For instance, the cygwin
8774 kernel does this regularly. A symbol @samp{_foo} can be exported as
8775 @samp{foo} but not as @samp{_foo} by using special directives in the
8776 DEF file. (This will also affect the import library, if it is
8777 created). In the following example:
8778
8779 @example
8780 LIBRARY "xyz.dll" BASE=0x61000000
8781
8782 EXPORTS
8783 _foo = foo
8784 @end example
8785
8786 The line @samp{_foo = foo} maps the exported symbol @samp{foo} to
8787 @samp{_foo}.
8788 @end table
8789
8790 Note: using a DEF file disables the default auto-export behavior,
8791 unless the @samp{--export-all-symbols} command-line option is used.
8792 If, however, you are trying to rename symbols, then you should list
8793 @emph{all} desired exports in the DEF file, including the symbols
8794 that are not being renamed, and do @emph{not} use the
8795 @samp{--export-all-symbols} option. If you list only the
8796 renamed symbols in the DEF file, and use @samp{--export-all-symbols}
8797 to handle the other symbols, then the both the new names @emph{and}
8798 the original names for the renamed symbols will be exported.
8799 In effect, you'd be aliasing those symbols, not renaming them,
8800 which is probably not what you wanted.
8801
8802 @cindex weak externals
8803 @item weak externals
8804 The Windows object format, PE, specifies a form of weak symbols called
8805 weak externals. When a weak symbol is linked and the symbol is not
8806 defined, the weak symbol becomes an alias for some other symbol. There
8807 are three variants of weak externals:
8808 @itemize
8809 @item Definition is searched for in objects and libraries, historically
8810 called lazy externals.
8811 @item Definition is searched for only in other objects, not in libraries.
8812 This form is not presently implemented.
8813 @item No search; the symbol is an alias. This form is not presently
8814 implemented.
8815 @end itemize
8816 As a GNU extension, weak symbols that do not specify an alternate symbol
8817 are supported. If the symbol is undefined when linking, the symbol
8818 uses a default value.
8819
8820 @cindex aligned common symbols
8821 @item aligned common symbols
8822 As a GNU extension to the PE file format, it is possible to specify the
8823 desired alignment for a common symbol. This information is conveyed from
8824 the assembler or compiler to the linker by means of GNU-specific commands
8825 carried in the object file's @samp{.drectve} section, which are recognized
8826 by @command{ld} and respected when laying out the common symbols. Native
8827 tools will be able to process object files employing this GNU extension,
8828 but will fail to respect the alignment instructions, and may issue noisy
8829 warnings about unknown linker directives.
8830
8831 @end table
8832
8833 @ifclear GENERIC
8834 @lowersections
8835 @end ifclear
8836 @end ifset
8837
8838 @ifset XTENSA
8839 @ifclear GENERIC
8840 @raisesections
8841 @end ifclear
8842
8843 @node Xtensa
8844 @section @code{ld} and Xtensa Processors
8845
8846 @cindex Xtensa processors
8847 The default @command{ld} behavior for Xtensa processors is to interpret
8848 @code{SECTIONS} commands so that lists of explicitly named sections in a
8849 specification with a wildcard file will be interleaved when necessary to
8850 keep literal pools within the range of PC-relative load offsets. For
8851 example, with the command:
8852
8853 @smallexample
8854 SECTIONS
8855 @{
8856 .text : @{
8857 *(.literal .text)
8858 @}
8859 @}
8860 @end smallexample
8861
8862 @noindent
8863 @command{ld} may interleave some of the @code{.literal}
8864 and @code{.text} sections from different object files to ensure that the
8865 literal pools are within the range of PC-relative load offsets. A valid
8866 interleaving might place the @code{.literal} sections from an initial
8867 group of files followed by the @code{.text} sections of that group of
8868 files. Then, the @code{.literal} sections from the rest of the files
8869 and the @code{.text} sections from the rest of the files would follow.
8870
8871 @cindex @option{--relax} on Xtensa
8872 @cindex relaxing on Xtensa
8873 Relaxation is enabled by default for the Xtensa version of @command{ld} and
8874 provides two important link-time optimizations. The first optimization
8875 is to combine identical literal values to reduce code size. A redundant
8876 literal will be removed and all the @code{L32R} instructions that use it
8877 will be changed to reference an identical literal, as long as the
8878 location of the replacement literal is within the offset range of all
8879 the @code{L32R} instructions. The second optimization is to remove
8880 unnecessary overhead from assembler-generated ``longcall'' sequences of
8881 @code{L32R}/@code{CALLX@var{n}} when the target functions are within
8882 range of direct @code{CALL@var{n}} instructions.
8883
8884 For each of these cases where an indirect call sequence can be optimized
8885 to a direct call, the linker will change the @code{CALLX@var{n}}
8886 instruction to a @code{CALL@var{n}} instruction, remove the @code{L32R}
8887 instruction, and remove the literal referenced by the @code{L32R}
8888 instruction if it is not used for anything else. Removing the
8889 @code{L32R} instruction always reduces code size but can potentially
8890 hurt performance by changing the alignment of subsequent branch targets.
8891 By default, the linker will always preserve alignments, either by
8892 switching some instructions between 24-bit encodings and the equivalent
8893 density instructions or by inserting a no-op in place of the @code{L32R}
8894 instruction that was removed. If code size is more important than
8895 performance, the @option{--size-opt} option can be used to prevent the
8896 linker from widening density instructions or inserting no-ops, except in
8897 a few cases where no-ops are required for correctness.
8898
8899 The following Xtensa-specific command-line options can be used to
8900 control the linker:
8901
8902 @cindex Xtensa options
8903 @table @option
8904 @item --size-opt
8905 When optimizing indirect calls to direct calls, optimize for code size
8906 more than performance. With this option, the linker will not insert
8907 no-ops or widen density instructions to preserve branch target
8908 alignment. There may still be some cases where no-ops are required to
8909 preserve the correctness of the code.
8910
8911 @item --abi-windowed
8912 @itemx --abi-call0
8913 Choose ABI for the output object and for the generated PLT code.
8914 PLT code inserted by the linker must match ABI of the output object
8915 because windowed and call0 ABI use incompatible function call
8916 conventions.
8917 Default ABI is chosen by the ABI tag in the @code{.xtensa.info} section
8918 of the first input object.
8919 A warning is issued if ABI tags of input objects do not match each other
8920 or the chosen output object ABI.
8921 @end table
8922
8923 @ifclear GENERIC
8924 @lowersections
8925 @end ifclear
8926 @end ifset
8927
8928 @ifclear SingleFormat
8929 @node BFD
8930 @chapter BFD
8931
8932 @cindex back end
8933 @cindex object file management
8934 @cindex object formats available
8935 @kindex objdump -i
8936 The linker accesses object and archive files using the BFD libraries.
8937 These libraries allow the linker to use the same routines to operate on
8938 object files whatever the object file format. A different object file
8939 format can be supported simply by creating a new BFD back end and adding
8940 it to the library. To conserve runtime memory, however, the linker and
8941 associated tools are usually configured to support only a subset of the
8942 object file formats available. You can use @code{objdump -i}
8943 (@pxref{objdump,,objdump,binutils.info,The GNU Binary Utilities}) to
8944 list all the formats available for your configuration.
8945
8946 @cindex BFD requirements
8947 @cindex requirements for BFD
8948 As with most implementations, BFD is a compromise between
8949 several conflicting requirements. The major factor influencing
8950 BFD design was efficiency: any time used converting between
8951 formats is time which would not have been spent had BFD not
8952 been involved. This is partly offset by abstraction payback; since
8953 BFD simplifies applications and back ends, more time and care
8954 may be spent optimizing algorithms for a greater speed.
8955
8956 One minor artifact of the BFD solution which you should bear in
8957 mind is the potential for information loss. There are two places where
8958 useful information can be lost using the BFD mechanism: during
8959 conversion and during output. @xref{BFD information loss}.
8960
8961 @menu
8962 * BFD outline:: How it works: an outline of BFD
8963 @end menu
8964
8965 @node BFD outline
8966 @section How It Works: An Outline of BFD
8967 @cindex opening object files
8968 @include bfdsumm.texi
8969 @end ifclear
8970
8971 @node Reporting Bugs
8972 @chapter Reporting Bugs
8973 @cindex bugs in @command{ld}
8974 @cindex reporting bugs in @command{ld}
8975
8976 Your bug reports play an essential role in making @command{ld} reliable.
8977
8978 Reporting a bug may help you by bringing a solution to your problem, or
8979 it may not. But in any case the principal function of a bug report is
8980 to help the entire community by making the next version of @command{ld}
8981 work better. Bug reports are your contribution to the maintenance of
8982 @command{ld}.
8983
8984 In order for a bug report to serve its purpose, you must include the
8985 information that enables us to fix the bug.
8986
8987 @menu
8988 * Bug Criteria:: Have you found a bug?
8989 * Bug Reporting:: How to report bugs
8990 @end menu
8991
8992 @node Bug Criteria
8993 @section Have You Found a Bug?
8994 @cindex bug criteria
8995
8996 If you are not sure whether you have found a bug, here are some guidelines:
8997
8998 @itemize @bullet
8999 @cindex fatal signal
9000 @cindex linker crash
9001 @cindex crash of linker
9002 @item
9003 If the linker gets a fatal signal, for any input whatever, that is a
9004 @command{ld} bug. Reliable linkers never crash.
9005
9006 @cindex error on valid input
9007 @item
9008 If @command{ld} produces an error message for valid input, that is a bug.
9009
9010 @cindex invalid input
9011 @item
9012 If @command{ld} does not produce an error message for invalid input, that
9013 may be a bug. In the general case, the linker can not verify that
9014 object files are correct.
9015
9016 @item
9017 If you are an experienced user of linkers, your suggestions for
9018 improvement of @command{ld} are welcome in any case.
9019 @end itemize
9020
9021 @node Bug Reporting
9022 @section How to Report Bugs
9023 @cindex bug reports
9024 @cindex @command{ld} bugs, reporting
9025
9026 A number of companies and individuals offer support for @sc{gnu}
9027 products. If you obtained @command{ld} from a support organization, we
9028 recommend you contact that organization first.
9029
9030 You can find contact information for many support companies and
9031 individuals in the file @file{etc/SERVICE} in the @sc{gnu} Emacs
9032 distribution.
9033
9034 @ifset BUGURL
9035 Otherwise, send bug reports for @command{ld} to
9036 @value{BUGURL}.
9037 @end ifset
9038
9039 The fundamental principle of reporting bugs usefully is this:
9040 @strong{report all the facts}. If you are not sure whether to state a
9041 fact or leave it out, state it!
9042
9043 Often people omit facts because they think they know what causes the
9044 problem and assume that some details do not matter. Thus, you might
9045 assume that the name of a symbol you use in an example does not
9046 matter. Well, probably it does not, but one cannot be sure. Perhaps
9047 the bug is a stray memory reference which happens to fetch from the
9048 location where that name is stored in memory; perhaps, if the name
9049 were different, the contents of that location would fool the linker
9050 into doing the right thing despite the bug. Play it safe and give a
9051 specific, complete example. That is the easiest thing for you to do,
9052 and the most helpful.
9053
9054 Keep in mind that the purpose of a bug report is to enable us to fix
9055 the bug if it is new to us. Therefore, always write your bug reports
9056 on the assumption that the bug has not been reported previously.
9057
9058 Sometimes people give a few sketchy facts and ask, ``Does this ring a
9059 bell?'' This cannot help us fix a bug, so it is basically useless. We
9060 respond by asking for enough details to enable us to investigate.
9061 You might as well expedite matters by sending them to begin with.
9062
9063 To enable us to fix the bug, you should include all these things:
9064
9065 @itemize @bullet
9066 @item
9067 The version of @command{ld}. @command{ld} announces it if you start it with
9068 the @samp{--version} argument.
9069
9070 Without this, we will not know whether there is any point in looking for
9071 the bug in the current version of @command{ld}.
9072
9073 @item
9074 Any patches you may have applied to the @command{ld} source, including any
9075 patches made to the @code{BFD} library.
9076
9077 @item
9078 The type of machine you are using, and the operating system name and
9079 version number.
9080
9081 @item
9082 What compiler (and its version) was used to compile @command{ld}---e.g.
9083 ``@code{gcc-2.7}''.
9084
9085 @item
9086 The command arguments you gave the linker to link your example and
9087 observe the bug. To guarantee you will not omit something important,
9088 list them all. A copy of the Makefile (or the output from make) is
9089 sufficient.
9090
9091 If we were to try to guess the arguments, we would probably guess wrong
9092 and then we might not encounter the bug.
9093
9094 @item
9095 A complete input file, or set of input files, that will reproduce the
9096 bug. It is generally most helpful to send the actual object files
9097 provided that they are reasonably small. Say no more than 10K. For
9098 bigger files you can either make them available by FTP or HTTP or else
9099 state that you are willing to send the object file(s) to whomever
9100 requests them. (Note - your email will be going to a mailing list, so
9101 we do not want to clog it up with large attachments). But small
9102 attachments are best.
9103
9104 If the source files were assembled using @code{gas} or compiled using
9105 @code{gcc}, then it may be OK to send the source files rather than the
9106 object files. In this case, be sure to say exactly what version of
9107 @code{gas} or @code{gcc} was used to produce the object files. Also say
9108 how @code{gas} or @code{gcc} were configured.
9109
9110 @item
9111 A description of what behavior you observe that you believe is
9112 incorrect. For example, ``It gets a fatal signal.''
9113
9114 Of course, if the bug is that @command{ld} gets a fatal signal, then we
9115 will certainly notice it. But if the bug is incorrect output, we might
9116 not notice unless it is glaringly wrong. You might as well not give us
9117 a chance to make a mistake.
9118
9119 Even if the problem you experience is a fatal signal, you should still
9120 say so explicitly. Suppose something strange is going on, such as, your
9121 copy of @command{ld} is out of sync, or you have encountered a bug in the
9122 C library on your system. (This has happened!) Your copy might crash
9123 and ours would not. If you told us to expect a crash, then when ours
9124 fails to crash, we would know that the bug was not happening for us. If
9125 you had not told us to expect a crash, then we would not be able to draw
9126 any conclusion from our observations.
9127
9128 @item
9129 If you wish to suggest changes to the @command{ld} source, send us context
9130 diffs, as generated by @code{diff} with the @samp{-u}, @samp{-c}, or
9131 @samp{-p} option. Always send diffs from the old file to the new file.
9132 If you even discuss something in the @command{ld} source, refer to it by
9133 context, not by line number.
9134
9135 The line numbers in our development sources will not match those in your
9136 sources. Your line numbers would convey no useful information to us.
9137 @end itemize
9138
9139 Here are some things that are not necessary:
9140
9141 @itemize @bullet
9142 @item
9143 A description of the envelope of the bug.
9144
9145 Often people who encounter a bug spend a lot of time investigating
9146 which changes to the input file will make the bug go away and which
9147 changes will not affect it.
9148
9149 This is often time consuming and not very useful, because the way we
9150 will find the bug is by running a single example under the debugger
9151 with breakpoints, not by pure deduction from a series of examples.
9152 We recommend that you save your time for something else.
9153
9154 Of course, if you can find a simpler example to report @emph{instead}
9155 of the original one, that is a convenience for us. Errors in the
9156 output will be easier to spot, running under the debugger will take
9157 less time, and so on.
9158
9159 However, simplification is not vital; if you do not want to do this,
9160 report the bug anyway and send us the entire test case you used.
9161
9162 @item
9163 A patch for the bug.
9164
9165 A patch for the bug does help us if it is a good one. But do not omit
9166 the necessary information, such as the test case, on the assumption that
9167 a patch is all we need. We might see problems with your patch and decide
9168 to fix the problem another way, or we might not understand it at all.
9169
9170 Sometimes with a program as complicated as @command{ld} it is very hard to
9171 construct an example that will make the program follow a certain path
9172 through the code. If you do not send us the example, we will not be
9173 able to construct one, so we will not be able to verify that the bug is
9174 fixed.
9175
9176 And if we cannot understand what bug you are trying to fix, or why your
9177 patch should be an improvement, we will not install it. A test case will
9178 help us to understand.
9179
9180 @item
9181 A guess about what the bug is or what it depends on.
9182
9183 Such guesses are usually wrong. Even we cannot guess right about such
9184 things without first using the debugger to find the facts.
9185 @end itemize
9186
9187 @node MRI
9188 @appendix MRI Compatible Script Files
9189 @cindex MRI compatibility
9190 To aid users making the transition to @sc{gnu} @command{ld} from the MRI
9191 linker, @command{ld} can use MRI compatible linker scripts as an
9192 alternative to the more general-purpose linker scripting language
9193 described in @ref{Scripts}. MRI compatible linker scripts have a much
9194 simpler command set than the scripting language otherwise used with
9195 @command{ld}. @sc{gnu} @command{ld} supports the most commonly used MRI
9196 linker commands; these commands are described here.
9197
9198 In general, MRI scripts aren't of much use with the @code{a.out} object
9199 file format, since it only has three sections and MRI scripts lack some
9200 features to make use of them.
9201
9202 You can specify a file containing an MRI-compatible script using the
9203 @samp{-c} command-line option.
9204
9205 Each command in an MRI-compatible script occupies its own line; each
9206 command line starts with the keyword that identifies the command (though
9207 blank lines are also allowed for punctuation). If a line of an
9208 MRI-compatible script begins with an unrecognized keyword, @command{ld}
9209 issues a warning message, but continues processing the script.
9210
9211 Lines beginning with @samp{*} are comments.
9212
9213 You can write these commands using all upper-case letters, or all
9214 lower case; for example, @samp{chip} is the same as @samp{CHIP}.
9215 The following list shows only the upper-case form of each command.
9216
9217 @table @code
9218 @cindex @code{ABSOLUTE} (MRI)
9219 @item ABSOLUTE @var{secname}
9220 @itemx ABSOLUTE @var{secname}, @var{secname}, @dots{} @var{secname}
9221 Normally, @command{ld} includes in the output file all sections from all
9222 the input files. However, in an MRI-compatible script, you can use the
9223 @code{ABSOLUTE} command to restrict the sections that will be present in
9224 your output program. If the @code{ABSOLUTE} command is used at all in a
9225 script, then only the sections named explicitly in @code{ABSOLUTE}
9226 commands will appear in the linker output. You can still use other
9227 input sections (whatever you select on the command line, or using
9228 @code{LOAD}) to resolve addresses in the output file.
9229
9230 @cindex @code{ALIAS} (MRI)
9231 @item ALIAS @var{out-secname}, @var{in-secname}
9232 Use this command to place the data from input section @var{in-secname}
9233 in a section called @var{out-secname} in the linker output file.
9234
9235 @var{in-secname} may be an integer.
9236
9237 @cindex @code{ALIGN} (MRI)
9238 @item ALIGN @var{secname} = @var{expression}
9239 Align the section called @var{secname} to @var{expression}. The
9240 @var{expression} should be a power of two.
9241
9242 @cindex @code{BASE} (MRI)
9243 @item BASE @var{expression}
9244 Use the value of @var{expression} as the lowest address (other than
9245 absolute addresses) in the output file.
9246
9247 @cindex @code{CHIP} (MRI)
9248 @item CHIP @var{expression}
9249 @itemx CHIP @var{expression}, @var{expression}
9250 This command does nothing; it is accepted only for compatibility.
9251
9252 @cindex @code{END} (MRI)
9253 @item END
9254 This command does nothing whatever; it's only accepted for compatibility.
9255
9256 @cindex @code{FORMAT} (MRI)
9257 @item FORMAT @var{output-format}
9258 Similar to the @code{OUTPUT_FORMAT} command in the more general linker
9259 language, but restricted to S-records, if @var{output-format} is @samp{S}
9260
9261 @cindex @code{LIST} (MRI)
9262 @item LIST @var{anything}@dots{}
9263 Print (to the standard output file) a link map, as produced by the
9264 @command{ld} command-line option @samp{-M}.
9265
9266 The keyword @code{LIST} may be followed by anything on the
9267 same line, with no change in its effect.
9268
9269 @cindex @code{LOAD} (MRI)
9270 @item LOAD @var{filename}
9271 @itemx LOAD @var{filename}, @var{filename}, @dots{} @var{filename}
9272 Include one or more object file @var{filename} in the link; this has the
9273 same effect as specifying @var{filename} directly on the @command{ld}
9274 command line.
9275
9276 @cindex @code{NAME} (MRI)
9277 @item NAME @var{output-name}
9278 @var{output-name} is the name for the program produced by @command{ld}; the
9279 MRI-compatible command @code{NAME} is equivalent to the command-line
9280 option @samp{-o} or the general script language command @code{OUTPUT}.
9281
9282 @cindex @code{ORDER} (MRI)
9283 @item ORDER @var{secname}, @var{secname}, @dots{} @var{secname}
9284 @itemx ORDER @var{secname} @var{secname} @var{secname}
9285 Normally, @command{ld} orders the sections in its output file in the
9286 order in which they first appear in the input files. In an MRI-compatible
9287 script, you can override this ordering with the @code{ORDER} command. The
9288 sections you list with @code{ORDER} will appear first in your output
9289 file, in the order specified.
9290
9291 @cindex @code{PUBLIC} (MRI)
9292 @item PUBLIC @var{name}=@var{expression}
9293 @itemx PUBLIC @var{name},@var{expression}
9294 @itemx PUBLIC @var{name} @var{expression}
9295 Supply a value (@var{expression}) for external symbol
9296 @var{name} used in the linker input files.
9297
9298 @cindex @code{SECT} (MRI)
9299 @item SECT @var{secname}, @var{expression}
9300 @itemx SECT @var{secname}=@var{expression}
9301 @itemx SECT @var{secname} @var{expression}
9302 You can use any of these three forms of the @code{SECT} command to
9303 specify the start address (@var{expression}) for section @var{secname}.
9304 If you have more than one @code{SECT} statement for the same
9305 @var{secname}, only the @emph{first} sets the start address.
9306 @end table
9307
9308 @node GNU Free Documentation License
9309 @appendix GNU Free Documentation License
9310 @include fdl.texi
9311
9312 @node LD Index
9313 @unnumbered LD Index
9314
9315 @printindex cp
9316
9317 @tex
9318 % I think something like @@colophon should be in texinfo. In the
9319 % meantime:
9320 \long\def\colophon{\hbox to0pt{}\vfill
9321 \centerline{The body of this manual is set in}
9322 \centerline{\fontname\tenrm,}
9323 \centerline{with headings in {\bf\fontname\tenbf}}
9324 \centerline{and examples in {\tt\fontname\tentt}.}
9325 \centerline{{\it\fontname\tenit\/} and}
9326 \centerline{{\sl\fontname\tensl\/}}
9327 \centerline{are used for emphasis.}\vfill}
9328 \page\colophon
9329 % Blame: doc@@cygnus.com, 28mar91.
9330 @end tex
9331
9332 @bye